Panasonic DMC GX80 GX 80 Operating Instructions For Advanced Features IM EN
User Manual: panasonic DMC-GX-80 - Operating Instructions for Advanced Features Free User Guide for Panasonic Camera, Manual - page2
Open the PDF directly: View PDF
.
Page Count: 338 [warning: Documents this large are best viewed by clicking the View PDF Link!]
- Finding the information you need
- How to use this manual
- Contents
- Contents by Function
- 1. Before Use
- 2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
- Attaching the Shoulder Strap
- Charging the Battery
- Inserting and Removing the Card (optional)
- Card Information
- Attaching/Removing the Lens
- Setting Date/Time (Clock Set)
- Basic Operations
- Adjust the angle of the monitor
- Using the Viewfinder
- Shutter button (Taking pictures)
- Motion picture button (Recording motion pictures)
- Mode dial (Selecting a Recording Mode)
- Front Dial/Rear Dial
- Cursor buttons/[MENU/SET] button
- [DISP.] button (Switching the displayed information)
- Touch screen (Touch operations)
- Taking Pictures Using the Touch Function
- Setting menu items
- Calling frequently-used menus instantly (Quick Menu)
- Assigning frequently used functions to the buttons (function buttons)
- Entering Text
- 3. Recording Modes
- Taking Pictures using the Automatic Function (Intelligent Auto Mode)
- Taking Pictures with Automatically Adjusted Aperture and Shutter Speed (Programme AE Mode)
- Taking Pictures by Specifying the Aperture/ Shutter Speed
- Taking panorama pictures (Panorama Shot Mode)
- Taking Pictures that match the Scene being recorded (Scene Guide Mode)
- Taking Pictures with different image effects (Creative Control Mode)
- Recording motion pictures with manually set aperture value/shutter speed (Creative Video Mode)
- Registering your preferred settings (Custom Mode)
- 4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
- 5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
- Recording 4K Photos
- Selecting pictures from 4K burst file and saving
- Selecting a focus point after recording ([Post Focus])
- Select a Drive Mode
- Taking Pictures While Adjusting a Setting Automatically (Bracket Recording)
- Taking Pictures Automatically at Set Intervals ([Time Lapse Shot])
- Creating Stop Motion Pictures ([Stop Motion Animation])
- 6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
- 7. Recording Motion Pictures
- 8. Playing Back and Editing Images
- 9. Using Menu Functions
- 10. Using the Wi-Fi function
- What you can do with the Wi-Fi function
- Wi-Fi function
- Controlling with a Smartphone/Tablet
- Installing the smartphone/tablet app “ Image App ”
- Connecting to a smartphone/tablet
- Taking images via a smartphone/tablet (remote recording)
- Playing back images in the camera
- Saving images stored in the camera
- Sending images in the camera to an SNS
- Adding location information to images stored in the camera from a smartphone/tablet
- Combining motion pictures recorded with Snap Movie according to your preference on a smartphone/tablet
- Displaying pictures on a TV
- Sending images
- Sending images to a smartphone/tablet
- Printing Wirelessly
- When sending images to AV device
- When sending images to PC
- Using Web services
- Registering to the “LUMIX CLUB”
- About Connections
- [Wi-Fi Setup] Menu
- 11. Connecting to other equipment
- 12. Others

Please read these instructions carefully before using this product,
and save this manual for future use.
Operating Instructions
for advanced features
Digital Camera
Model No. DMC-GX80
SQW0672
F0416CT0
until
2015/9/2
Message Display P316
Troubleshooting P318
Finding the information you need P2
Contents P4
Contents by Function P9
Menu list P187

2
Finding the information you need
In this “Operating Instructions for advanced features”, you can find the information you
need from the following pages.
By clicking a page number, you can jump to the linked page and quickly find the
information.
Search from “Contents”
Click this icon to jump to “Contents”.
P4
Search from the list of function names P9
Search from the list of buttons and dials P14
Search from the list of screens and icons P309
Search from “Message Display”P316
Search from “Menu list”
Click this icon to jump to “Menu list”.
P187
Search from “Troubleshooting”P318
Click this icon to jump to “Finding the information you need”.
Click this icon to return to the previously displayed page.
For details on how to use this manual, see the next page. P3
Wi-FiR function P251

3
How to use this manual
∫About the symbols in the text
•Click a cross reference in the text to jump to the corresponding page.
•Description in these operating instructions is based on the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032).
About the indication of the applicable mode
Applicable modes:
The icons indicate the modes available for a function.
•Black icons: Applicable modes
•Grey icons: Unavailable modes
[ ] indicates that available functions vary depending on the registered Recording
Mode.
: Indicates that the menu can be set by pressing [MENU/SET] button.
: Indicates that the Wi-Fi setting can be made by pressing [Wi-Fi] button.
: Tips for skilful use and points for recording.
: Conditions in which a particular function cannot be used.
: Continued to next page.
In these operating instructions, steps for setting a menu item are described as follows.
Example: In the [Rec] menu, change [Quality] from [A] to [›]
> [Rec] > [Quality] > [›]
MENU
Wi-Fi
MENU

4
Contents
Finding the information you need..............................................................................2
How to use this manual.............................................................................................3
Contents by Function ................................................................................................9
1. Before Use
Care of the camera .................................................................................................12
Standard Accessories .............................................................................................13
Names and Functions of Components....................................................................14
About the Lens........................................................................................................17
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Attaching the Shoulder Strap ..................................................................................18
Charging the Battery ...............................................................................................19
• Inserting the Battery .......................................................................................20
• Charging.........................................................................................................21
• Approximate operating time and number of recordable pictures....................24
Inserting and Removing the Card (optional) ...........................................................27
Card Information .....................................................................................................28
• Formatting the card (initialisation) ..................................................................29
• Approximate number of recordable pictures and available recording time ....30
Attaching/Removing the Lens .................................................................................32
Setting Date/Time (Clock Set).................................................................................35
• Re-adjusting the clock ....................................................................................36
Basic Operations.....................................................................................................37
• Tips for taking good pictures ..........................................................................37
• Extending/retracting the lens [when the interchangeable lens
(H-FS12032/H-FS35100) is attached]............................................................38
Adjust the angle of the monitor ...............................................................................39
• Using the Viewfinder.......................................................................................40
• Shutter button (Taking pictures) .....................................................................42
• Motion picture button (Recording motion pictures).........................................42
• Mode dial (Selecting a Recording Mode) .......................................................43
• Front Dial/Rear Dial........................................................................................44
• Cursor buttons/[MENU/SET] button ...............................................................47
• [DISP.] button (Switching the displayed information)......................................48
• Touch screen (Touch operations) ...................................................................51
• Taking Pictures Using the Touch Function .....................................................52
Setting menu items .................................................................................................54
Calling frequently-used menus instantly (Quick Menu)...........................................56
• Customising the Quick Menu settings ............................................................57
Assigning frequently used functions to the buttons (function buttons) ....................58
Entering Text ...........................................................................................................61

5
3. Recording Modes
Taking Pictures using the Automatic Function
(Intelligent Auto Mode)............................................................................................62
• Recording night scenes ([iHandheld Night Shot]) ..........................................65
• Combining pictures into a single picture with rich gradation ([iHDR]).............66
• Taking a picture with a blurred background (Defocus Control).......................67
• Recording images by changing the brightness or colour tone .......................68
Taking Pictures with Automatically Adjusted Aperture and Shutter Speed
(Programme AE Mode) ...........................................................................................69
Taking Pictures by Specifying the Aperture/Shutter Speed .....................................71
• Aperture-Priority AE Mode .............................................................................72
• Shutter-Priority AE Mode................................................................................72
• Manual Exposure Mode .................................................................................73
• Confirm the Effects of Aperture and Shutter Speed (Preview Mode) .............75
• Easily set aperture/shutter speed for suitable exposure (One Push AE) .......76
Taking panorama pictures (Panorama Shot Mode).................................................77
Taking Pictures that match the Scene being recorded (Scene Guide Mode)..........80
Taking Pictures with different image effects (Creative Control Mode).....................83
Recording motion pictures with manually set aperture value/shutter speed
(Creative Video Mode) ............................................................................................89
• Minimising operational sounds during motion picture recording ....................90
Registering your preferred settings (Custom Mode) ...............................................91
• Registering Personal Menu Settings (Registering custom settings) ..............91
• Recording using registered custom set ..........................................................92
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
Adjusting Focus Automatically ................................................................................93
• Focus Mode (AFS/AFF/AFC) .........................................................................95
• Auto Focus Mode ...........................................................................................97
• Setting up position of the AF area/changing size of the AF area .................102
• Setting the AF area position with the Touch Pad..........................................104
• Optimising the focus and brightness for a touched position .........................105
Adjusting Focus Manually .....................................................................................106
Fixing the Focus and the Exposure (AF/AE Lock) ................................................109
Compensating the Exposure.................................................................................110
Setting the Light Sensitivity................................................................................... 112
Adjusting the White Balance .................................................................................114
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
Recording 4K Photos ............................................................................................118
• Recording with [4K Burst].............................................................................121
• Recording with [4K Burst(S/S)].....................................................................121
• Recording with [4K Pre-Burst] ......................................................................122
• Notes on the 4K Photo function....................................................................123

6
Selecting pictures from 4K burst file and saving ...................................................126
Selecting a focus point after recording ([Post Focus]) ..........................................131
• Recording using [Post Focus] ......................................................................131
• Selecting the desired focus area and saving a picture .................................133
Select a Drive Mode..............................................................................................134
• Burst Mode ...................................................................................................135
• Self-timer ......................................................................................................137
Taking Pictures While Adjusting a Setting Automatically (Bracket Recording) .....138
• Exposure Bracket .........................................................................................139
• Aperture Bracket ..........................................................................................140
• Focus Bracket ..............................................................................................140
Taking Pictures Automatically at Set Intervals ([Time Lapse Shot])......................141
Creating Stop Motion Pictures ([Stop Motion Animation]) .....................................143
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Image Stabiliser.....................................................................................................146
Taking Pictures with the Zoom ..............................................................................150
• Raising the telescopic effect.........................................................................151
• Zooming using touch operations (Touch zoom) ...........................................155
Taking pictures by using the flash .........................................................................156
Setting the Flash Functions ..................................................................................158
• Changing the firing mode .............................................................................158
• Changing Flash Mode ..................................................................................159
• Setting to the 2nd Curtain Synchro...............................................................161
• Adjust the flash output..................................................................................162
• Synchronising the output of the flash to the Exposure Compensation .........162
Taking Pictures with Wireless Flashes..................................................................163
• Using other settings for wireless flash recording ..........................................165
7. Recording Motion Pictures
Recording Motion Picture/4K Motion Picture ........................................................166
• Setting the format, size and recording frame rate ........................................168
• How to set focus when recording a motion picture ([Continuous AF]) .........170
Recording Motion Pictures that Pan and Zoom
While Maintaining a Fixed Camera Position ([4K Live Cropping]) ........................171
Recording still pictures while recording motion pictures .......................................174
Recording Snap Movies ........................................................................................176
8. Playing Back and Editing Images
Playing Back Pictures ...........................................................................................179
Playing Back Motion Pictures................................................................................180
• Creating Still Pictures from a Motion Picture ................................................181
Switching the Playback Method ............................................................................182
• Using the Playback Zoom ............................................................................182
• Displaying multiple screens (Multi Playback) ...............................................183

7
• Displaying Pictures by Recording Date (Calendar Playback) ......................183
Playing Back Group Pictures ................................................................................184
Deleting Pictures...................................................................................................186
9. Using Menu Functions
Menu list................................................................................................................187
• [Rec] menu ...................................................................................................187
• [Motion Picture] menu ..................................................................................208
• [Custom] menu .............................................................................................210
• [Setup] menu ................................................................................................220
• [Playback] menu...........................................................................................228
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
What you can do with the Wi-FiR function.............................................................251
Wi-Fi function ........................................................................................................252
Controlling with a Smartphone/Tablet ...................................................................254
• Installing the smartphone/tablet app “Image App” .......................................254
• Connecting to a smartphone/tablet...............................................................255
• Taking images via a smartphone/tablet (remote recording)..........................259
• Playing back images in the camera..............................................................260
• Saving images stored in the camera ............................................................260
• Sending images in the camera to an SNS ...................................................261
• Adding location information to images stored in the camera
from a smartphone/tablet .............................................................................261
• Combining motion pictures recorded with Snap Movie according to your
preference on a smartphone/tablet ..............................................................263
Displaying pictures on a TV ..................................................................................264
Sending images ....................................................................................................265
Sending images to a smartphone/tablet................................................................269
Printing Wirelessly.................................................................................................270
When sending images to AV device......................................................................271
When sending images to PC ................................................................................272
Using Web services ..............................................................................................274
• When sending images to web service..........................................................274
• When sending images to [Cloud Sync. Service] ..........................................277
Registering to the “LUMIX CLUB”.........................................................................278
• About the [LUMIX CLUB] .............................................................................278
About Connections................................................................................................282
• Connecting via a wireless access point (via the network) ............................283
• Connecting the camera and another device directly (direct connection)......285
• Connecting quickly with the same settings as the previous ones
([Select a destination from History]/[Select a destination from Favorite]) ....286
[Wi-Fi Setup] Menu ...............................................................................................288

8
11. Connecting to other equipment
Watching 4K motion pictures on a TV/ Saving 4K motion pictures
on your PC or recorder .........................................................................................290
• Watching motion pictures in 4K....................................................................290
• Storing 4K motion pictures ...........................................................................291
Playing Back Pictures on a TV Screen .................................................................292
• Using VIERA Link (HDMI) ............................................................................294
Saving still pictures and motion pictures on your PC ............................................295
• Downloading software ..................................................................................296
• Transferring images to a PC.........................................................................298
Saving still pictures and motion pictures on a Recorder .......................................300
Printing the Pictures..............................................................................................301
Enjoying 3D pictures .............................................................................................304
12. Others
Optional accessories.............................................................................................307
Monitor Display/Viewfinder Display.......................................................................309
Message Display...................................................................................................316
Troubleshooting ....................................................................................................318
Cautions for Use ...................................................................................................328

9
Contents by Function
Recording
Recording Mode ..............................P43
[Preview]..........................................P75
Panorama Shot Mode .....................P77
[4K PHOTO] ..................................P118
[Post Focus] ..................................P131
Aperture Bracket ...........................P140
Focus Bracket ...............................P140
[Time Lapse Shot] .........................P141
[Stop Motion Animation] ................P143
[Multi Exp.].....................................P198
[Silent Mode] .................................P210
3D recording.................................. P304
Focus (AF/MF)
[Focus Mode]...................................P95
[AF Mode]........................................P97
Adjusting the AF area position ......P102
Manual Focus................................P106
[AF/AE Lock] .................................P109
Drive
[Drive Mode] ..................................P134
Maximum number of pictures that
can be taken continuously .............P135
[Self Timer] ....................................P137
Picture Quality and Colour Tone
[Sensitivity] ....................................P112
[White Balance] .............................P114
[Photo Style] .................................. P188
[Filter Settings] .............................. P190
[Picture Size] .................................P192
[Quality] .........................................P193
[Highlight Shadow] ........................P195
[i.Dynamic].....................................P196
[i.Resolution]..................................P196
[HDR]............................................. P197
[Long Shtr NR]...............................P202
[Shading Comp.]............................P202
[Diffraction Compensation] ............P203
[Color Space].................................P203
Exposure
[Touch AE] .......................................P53
[One Push AE] .................................P76
[AF/AE Lock]..................................P109
Exposure Compensation ...............P110
Exposure Bracket ..........................P139
[Metering Mode].............................P194
Stabiliser
Dual I.S. .........................................P146
5-Axis Hybrid Image Stabiliser.......P146
Flash
[Flash Mode] ..................................P159
2nd curtain synchro .......................P161
[Flash Adjust.] ................................P162
Wireless flash settings...................P163
Monitoring
HDMI output while recording .........P293
Recording

10
Motion Picture
Creative Video Mode ....................... P89
[Silent Operation].............................P90
[Rec Format]..................................P168
[Rec Quality]..................................P168
Motion pictures in 4K ..................... P166
[4K Live Cropping].........................P171
Recording still pictures while
recording motion pictures ..............P174
[Snap Movie]..................................P176
Audio
[Mic Level Adj.] ..............................P208
[Wind Noise Canceller] ..................P209
Screen settings
[Mic Level Disp.] ............................P208
[Zebra Pattern]...............................P216
[Monochrome Live View] ...............P217
Basic settings
[Format] ...........................................P29
[Clock Set] ....................................... P35
Display switching .............................P48
How to set menu items....................P54
[Q.MENU] ........................................P56
[Beep] ............................................P221
[Economy] .....................................P223
[Reset] (initialisation) .....................P226
[Sensor Cleaning] ..........................P227
Customisation
[CUSTOM] in the Quick Menu .........P57
Function buttons ..............................P58
Custom Mode ..................................P91
[Custom] menu ..............................P210
Playback
Picture playback ............................P179
Motion picture playback................. P180
Playback Zoom..............................P182
Multi Playback ...............................P183
Delete ............................................P186
[Auto Review] ................................P218
Playback/display settings
[Slide Show] ..................................P230
[Rotate]/[Rotate Disp.] ...................P246
Edit
[RAW Processing]..........................P234
[Light Composition] ........................P237
[Clear Retouch]..............................P239
[Resize]..........................................P244
[Cropping] ......................................P245
Adding information
[Location Logging] .........................P233
[Title Edit].......................................P240
[Text Stamp] ..................................P241
Image settings
[Favorite]........................................P247
[Print Set] .......................................P248
[Protect] .........................................P249
Motion Picture
Setup/Custom
Playback

11
Connect
“Image App” ..................................P254
[WPS (Push-Button)] .............P283, 285
Direct connection...........................P285
Image App
Remote recording..........................P259
Saving images ...............................P260
Sending images.....................P261, 269
Sending and adding location
information.....................................P261
Combining motion pictures
recorded with [Snap Movie] ...........P263
In combination with other devices
Playing back pictures on a TV .......P264
Printing images ..............................P270
Sending images to an AV
device ............................................P271
Sending images to a PC ................P272
Sending images to a web
service ...........................................P274
Using [Cloud Sync. Service] ..........P277
PC
“PHOTOfunSTUDIO” ....................P296
“SILKYPIX Developer Studio” ....... P297
Transferring images to a PC .........P272
TV
Playing Back Pictures on a TV
Screen ...........................................P292
[VIERA Link] ..................................P294
Recorder
Dubbing .........................................P300
Printer
PictBridge ......................................P301
Wi-Fi
Connections with other devices

12
1. Before Use
Care of the camera
Do not subject to strong vibration, shock, or pressure.
•The lens, monitor, or external case may be damaged if used in the following conditions.
It may also malfunction or image may not be recorded if you:
–Drop or hit the camera.
–Press hard on the lens or the monitor.
This camera is not dust/drip/water proof.
Avoid using the camera in places with a lot of dust, water, sand, etc.
•Liquid, sand and other foreign material may get into the space around the lens, buttons, etc. Be
particularly careful since it may not just cause malfunctions, but it may also become irreparable.
–Places with a lot of sand or dust.
–Places where water can come into contact with this unit, such as when using it on a rainy day
or at the beach.
If sand, dust, or liquids such as water droplets adhere to the monitor, wipe them off with a
dry soft cloth.
–Not doing so may cause the monitor to respond incorrectly to touch operations.
Do not place your hands inside the mount of the digital camera body. Since the
sensor unit is a precision apparatus, it may cause a malfunction or damage.
∫About Condensation (When the lens, the viewfinder or monitor is fogged up)
•Condensation occurs when the ambient temperature or humidity changes. Be careful of
condensation since it causes lens, viewfinder and monitor stains, fungus and camera
malfunction.
•If condensation occurs, turn the camera off and leave it for about 2 hours. The fog will
disappear naturally when the temperature of the camera becomes close to the ambient
temperature.
If you shake the camera while it is turned off, its sensors may move or a rattling sound
may be heard. The sound is caused by the In-Body Image Stabiliser, and this is not a
malfunction.

13
1. Before Use
Standard Accessories
Check that all the accessories are supplied before using the camera.
•The accessories and their shape will differ depending on the country or area where the camera
was purchased.
For details on the accessories, refer to “Basic Operating Instructions”.
•Battery Pack is indicated as battery pack or battery in the text.
•SD Memory Card, SDHC Memory Card and SDXC Memory Card are indicated as card in the
text.
•The card is optional.

1. Before Use
14
Names and Functions of Components
∫Camera body
4
14 1317 16
11
7
5
1
12
15
8 9 10
6
12
2 3
1Camera ON/OFF switch (P35)
2
Charging lamp (P22)/
Status indicator (P35)/
Wi-Fi® connection lamp (P252)
3Motion picture button (P166)
4Shutter button (P42)
5Mode dial (P43)
6Front dial (P44)
7Self-timer indicator (P137)/
AF Assist Lamp (P211)
8Flash (P156)
9
Hot shoe (Hot shoe cover) (P307)
•Keep the Hot Shoe Cover out of reach of
children to prevent swallowing.
10 Focus distance reference mark (P108)
11
Stereo microphone (P208)
•Be careful not to cover the microphone with
your finger. Doing so may make sound
difficult to record.
12 Shoulder strap eyelet (P18)
13 Lens release button (P32)
14 Lens lock pin
15 Mount
16 Sensor
17 Lens fitting mark (P32)

15
1. Before Use
18
29
30
24
40 3637
2219 20 21 23
25 26 27 28
33
34
39 35
31
32
38
∫About the function button ([Fn5] to
[Fn9])
•Function buttons ([Fn5] to [Fn9]) (P58) are
touch icons. Touch the [ ] tab on the
recording screen to display them.
18 Touch screen (P51)/monitor (P309)
19 Eyecup (P330)
20 Viewfinder (P40)
21 Eye sensor (P41)
22 Diopter adjustment dial (P40)
23 [LVF] button (P40)/
[Fn4] button (P58)
24 [ ] (4K photo mode) button (P118)/
[Fn3] button (P58)
25 Flash open button (P156)
26 [AF/AE LOCK] button (P109)
27 Rear dial (P44)
28 Speaker (P221)
29
Cursor buttons (P47)
3/[ ] (ISO sensitivity) (P112)
1/[ ] (White Balance) (P114)
2/[ ] (Auto Focus Mode) (P97)
4/[ ] (Drive mode) (P134)
30 [MENU/SET] button (P47, 54)
31 [HDMI] socket (P292)
32 [CHARGE] socket (P19, 298, 301)
33 [ ] (Post Focus) button (P131)/
[Fn1] button (P58)
34 [(] (Playback) button (P179)
35 [DISP.] button (P48, 50)
36 Release lever (P20)
37
DC coupler cover (P308)
•When using an AC adaptor, ensure that the
Panasonic DC coupler (optional) and AC
adaptor (optional) are used.
38 Card/Battery door (P20)
39
[ ] (Delete) button (P186)/
[ ] (Quick Menu/Return) button
(P56)/
[Fn2] button (P58)
40
Tripod mount (P334)
•It may not be possible to attach and securely
fasten a tripod with a screw length of 5.5 mm
(0.22 inch) or more to the camera. Doing so
may also damage the camera.

1. Before Use
16
∫Lens
1 Lens surface
2 Zoom ring (P150)
3 Contact point
4 Lens fitting mark (P32)
5 Focus ring (P107)
6 [O.I.S.] switch (P146)
•The interchangeable lens (H-FS12032) does not have a focus ring, but you can use manual
focus by operating the camera. (P106)
H-FS12032 H-FS35100
H-H020A H-FS14140
•The interchangeable lens (H-H020A) utilises a lens drive system to realize a compact and
bright F1.7 lens. As a result, sound and vibration may occur during focus operation, but this is
not a malfunction.
•Operating sounds will be recorded when auto focus is performed during motion picture
recording. It is recommended to record with [Continuous AF] (P170) set to [OFF], if the sound
of operation bothers you. (P166) Also, it is not possible to set the Focus Mode to [AFC] or
[AFF]. (P95)
2
34
1
512
34
15 34
1526 3 4

17
1. Before Use
About the Lens
This unit can use the dedicated lenses compatible with
the Micro Four ThirdsTM System lens mount specification
(Micro Four Thirds mount).
You can also use a lens of any of the following
standards by attaching a mount adaptor.
•When using a Leica lens mount adaptor, set [Shoot w/o Lens] (P219) to [ON].
Depending on the lens used, certain functions, such as Auto Focus, Image Stabiliser, and
zoom functions, may be disabled or operate differently.
For details on the lens used, refer to the website.
•The focal length noted on the lens in use is equivalent to double when converted to the 35 mm
film camera.
(It will be equivalent to 100 mm lens when a 50 mm lens is used.)
For smoother recording, we recommend updating the firmware of the interchangeable lens
to the latest version.
•To view the latest information on the firmware or to download the firmware, visit the
support site below:
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/
(This Site is English only.)
•To check the firmware version of the interchangeable lens, attach it to the camera body and
select [Version Disp.] in the [Setup] menu.
Lens Mount adaptor
Four Thirds™ mount specification
lens
Mount Adaptor (DMW-MA1: optional)
Leica M Mount interchangeable lens M Mount Adaptor (DMW-MA2M: optional)
Leica R Mount interchangeable lens R Mount Adaptor (DMW-MA3R: optional)
About the lens and functions
Refer to catalogues/Web pages for most current information regarding compatible
lenses.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/
(This Site is English only.)
About the firmware of your interchangeable lens

18
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Attaching the Shoulder Strap
•We recommend attaching the shoulder strap when using the camera to prevent it from
dropping.
1Pass the shoulder strap through the
shoulder strap eyelet on the camera body.
A: Shoulder strap eyelet
2Pass the end of the shoulder strap
through the ring in the direction of the arrow
and then pass it through the stopper.
3Pass the end of the shoulder strap
through the hole on the other side of the
stopper.
4Pull the shoulder strap and
then check that it will not
come out.
•Perform steps 1 to 4 and then
attach the other side of the
shoulder strap.
•Use the shoulder strap around your shoulder.
–Do not wrap the strap around your neck.
It may result in injury or accident.
•Do not leave the shoulder strap where an infant can reach it.
–It may result in an accident by mistakenly wrapping around the neck.
A

19
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Charging the Battery
Use the dedicated AC adaptor (supplied), USB connection cable (supplied) and battery.
•The battery is not charged when the camera is shipped. Charge the battery before use.
•Charge the battery only when it is inserted in the camera.
∫About batteries that you can use with this unit
Camera conditions Charge
Turned off ≤
Turne d on —
It has been found that counterfeit battery packs which look very similar to the
genuine product are made available for purchase in some markets. Some of
these battery packs are not adequately protected with internal protection to meet
the requirements of appropriate safety standards. There is a possibility that
these battery packs may lead to fire or explosion. Please be advised that we are
not liable for any accident or failure occurring as a result of use of a counterfeit
battery pack. To ensure that safe products are used, we recommend that a
genuine Panasonic battery pack is used.

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
20
11: Slide the release lever in the
direction of the arrow.
2: Open the card/battery door.
•Always use genuine Panasonic
batteries.
•If you use other batteries, we cannot
guarantee the quality of this product.
2Being careful about the battery
orientation, securely insert it all
the way in, and then check that it
is locked by the lever A.
To remove the battery, move the
lever A in the direction of the
arrow.
31: Close the card/battery door.
2: Slide the release lever in the
direction of the arrow.
•Before removing the battery, turn the camera off, and wait until the status indicator has gone off
completely.
(Otherwise, this unit may no longer operate normally and the card itself may be damaged or the
recorded pictures may be lost.)
Inserting the Battery

21
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
•Charge the battery in areas with an ambient temperature, between 10 oC and 30 oC (50 oF and
86 oF) (same as the battery temperature), is recommended.
(Charging from the power outlet)
Connect the AC adaptor (supplied) and this camera with the USB connection cable
(supplied), and insert the AC adaptor (supplied) into the power outlet.
(Charging from a computer)
Connect the computer and this camera with the USB connection cable (supplied).
•If the computer enters a suspended state while charging the battery, charging will stop.
•Connecting this camera to a notebook computer that is not connected to a power outlet will
cause the notebook computer battery to drain faster. Do not leave the camera connected for
extended periods of time.
•Be sure to always connect the camera to a computer USB terminal.
Do not connect the camera to a monitor, keyboard or printer USB terminal, or a USB hub.
Charging
Insert the battery into this unit.
Check that this unit is turned off.
AConnect the USB connection cable
(supplied) to the [CHARGE] socket.
•Place the camera in an upright position,
and find the terminal at the bottom.
BCharging lamp
CAC adaptor (supplied)
DTo power outlet
EPC (Turned on)
FUSB connection cable (supplied)
•Check the direction of the terminals and
plug in/out straight holding onto the plug.
(It may result in malfunction by the
deforming of the terminal if it is plugged in
obliquely or in wrong direction.)
Do not connect devices to incorrect
terminals. Doing so may cause
malfunction.

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
22
∫About the charging lamp
∫Charging time
When using the AC adaptor (supplied)
•The indicated charging time is for when the battery has been discharged completely.
The charging time may vary depending on how the battery has been used.
The charging time for the battery in hot/cold environments or a battery that has not been used
for a long time may be longer than normal.
•When power is supplied from a computer, the power supply capacity of the computer
determines the charging time.
∫Battery indication
•The indication turns red and blinks if the remaining battery power is exhausted.
(The status indicator also blinks)
Recharge the battery or replace it with a fully charged battery.
Lit red: Charging.
Off: Charging has completed.
(When charging is complete, disconnect the camera from the power outlet
or computer.)
Blinking red: Charging error. (P318)
Charging time Approx. 190 min
98
AFSAFS
L
4:3

23
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
•Do not leave any metal items (such as clips) near the contact areas of the power plug.
Otherwise, a fire and/or electric shocks may be caused by short-circuiting or the
resulting heat generated.
•Do not use any other USB connection cables except the supplied one.
This may cause malfunction.
•Do not use any other AC adaptors except the supplied one.
•Do not use a USB extension cable.
•The AC adaptor (supplied) and USB connection cable (supplied) are for this camera only. Do
not use them with other devices.
•Remove the battery after use.
(The battery will be exhausted if left for a long period of time after being charged.)
•The battery becomes warm after using it and during and after charging. The camera also
becomes warm during use. This is not a malfunction.
•The battery can be recharged even when it still has some charge left, but it is not
recommended that the battery charge be frequently topped up while the battery is fully
charged.
(Since characteristic swelling may occur.)
•If a problem occurs in the power outlet, such as a power outage, charging may not be
completed normally. If this happens, disconnect the USB connection cable (supplied) and
connect it again.
•When the charging lamp does not light even if you connect the camera to the AC adaptor
(supplied) or a PC, check if they are connected correctly.

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
24
By CIPA (Camera & Imaging Products Association) standard
When a Panasonic SDHC memory card and the supplied battery are used
∫Recording still pictures (when using the Monitor)
∫Recording still pictures (when using the Viewfinder)
Approximate operating time and number of recordable pictures
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032) is used
Number of recordable pictures Approx. 290 pictures
Recording time Approx. 145 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS35100) is used
Number of recordable pictures Approx. 290 pictures
Recording time Approx. 145 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-H020A) is used
Number of recordable pictures Approx. 280 pictures
Recording time Approx. 140 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS14140) is used
Number of recordable pictures Approx. 280 pictures
Recording time Approx. 140 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032) is used
Number of recordable pictures Approx. 270 pictures
Recording time Approx. 135 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS35100) is used
Number of recordable pictures Approx. 270 pictures
Recording time Approx. 135 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-H020A) is used
Number of recordable pictures Approx. 260 pictures
Recording time Approx. 130 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS14140) is used
Number of recordable pictures Approx. 260 pictures
Recording time Approx. 130 min

25
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
∫Recording motion pictures (when using the monitor)
[AVCHD] (Recording with picture quality set to [FHD/17M/50i])
[MP4] (Recording with picture quality set to [FHD/28M/50p])
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032) is used
Recordable time Approx. 100 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 50 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS35100) is used
Recordable time Approx. 100 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 50 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-H020A) is used
Recordable time Approx. 100 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 50 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS14140) is used
Recordable time Approx. 100 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 50 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032) is used
Recordable time Approx. 100 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 50 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS35100) is used
Recordable time Approx. 100 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 50 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-H020A) is used
Recordable time Approx. 100 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 50 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS14140) is used
Recordable time Approx. 100 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 50 min

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
26
[MP4] (Recording with picture quality set to [4K/100M/25p])
•Actual recordable time is the time available for recording when repeating actions such as
turning this unit on and off, starting/stopping recording, etc.
∫Playback (when using the monitor)
•The operating times and number of recordable pictures will differ according to the
environment and the operating conditions.
For example, in the following cases, the operating times shorten and the number of recordable
pictures is reduced.
–In low-temperature environments, such as on ski slopes.
–When flash is used repeatedly.
•When the operating time of the camera becomes extremely short even after properly charging
the battery, the life of the battery may have expired. Buy a new battery.
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032) is used
Recordable time Approx. 80 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 40 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS35100) is used
Recordable time Approx. 80 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 40 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-H020A) is used
Recordable time Approx. 80 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 40 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS14140) is used
Recordable time Approx. 80 min
Actual recordable time Approx. 40 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032) is used
Playback time Approx. 210 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS35100) is used
Playback time Approx. 210 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-H020A) is used
Playback time Approx. 190 min
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS14140) is used
Playback time Approx. 210 min

27
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Inserting and Removing the Card (optional)
•Check that this unit is turned off.
11: Slide the release lever in the
direction of the arrow.
2: Open the card/battery door.
•Always use genuine Panasonic
batteries.
•If you use other batteries, we cannot
guarantee the quality of this product.
2Push it securely all the way until
you hear a “click” while being
careful about the direction in
which you insert it.
To remove the card, push the card
until it clicks, then pull the card
out upright.
A: Do not touch the connection terminals of the card.
31: Close the card/battery door.
2: Slide the release lever in the
direction of the arrow.
•Before removing the card, turn the camera off, and wait until the status indicator has gone off
completely.
(Otherwise, this unit may no longer operate normally and the card itself may be damaged or the
recorded pictures may be lost.)

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
28
Card Information
The following cards which conform to the SD standard can be used with this unit.
(These cards are indicated as card in the text.)
∫About motion picture/4K photo recording and speed class ratings
According to the [Rec Format] (P168) and [Rec Quality] (P168) of a motion picture, the
required card differs. To record 4K photos, you need a card with a speed class rating that
supports 4K photo recording. Use a card that meets the following ratings of the SD Speed
Class or UHS Speed Class.
•SD Speed Class and UHS Speed Class are the speed standards regarding continuous writing.
To check the class, see the labelled side, etc. of the card.
•Please confirm the latest information on the following website.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/
(This Site is English only.)
SD Memory Card
(512 MB to 2 GB)
•This unit is compatible with UHS-I UHS Speed Class 3
standard SDHC/SDXC memory cards.
•Operation of the cards on the left has been confirmed with
Panasonic’s cards.
SDHC Memory Card
(4 GB to 32 GB)
SDXC Memory Card
(48 GB to 128 GB)
[Rec Format] [Rec Quality] Speed class Label example
[AVCHD] All Class 4 or higher
[MP4] FHD/HD/VGA
[MP4] 4K UHS Speed Class 3
When recording in 4K Photo /
[Post Focus] UHS Speed Class 3

29
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Access to the card
The access indication displays red when pictures are being recorded on
the card.
•During access (image writing, reading and deleting, formatting etc.), do
not turn this unit off, remove the battery, card or disconnect the AC
adaptor (optional). Furthermore, do not subject the camera to vibration, impact or static
electricity.
The card or the data on the card may be damaged, and this unit may no longer operate
normally.
If operation fails due to vibration, impact or static electricity, perform the operation
again.
•If you set the Write-Protect switch A to “LOCK”, you may not be able to write,
delete or format the data or display it by recording date.
•The data on the card may be damaged or lost due to electromagnetic waves,
static electricity or breakdown of the camera or the card. We recommend storing
important data on a PC etc.
•Keep the Memory Card out of reach of children to prevent swallowing.
Format the card before recording a picture with this unit.
Since data cannot be recovered after formatting, make sure to back up necessary
data in advance.
Select the menu. (P54)
•Use a battery with sufficient battery power or the AC adaptor (optional) when formatting. Do not
turn the camera off during formatting.
•If the card has been formatted on a PC or other equipment, format it on the camera again.
Formatting the card (initialisation)
> [Setup] > [Format]
MENU

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
30
∫Number of recordable pictures
•Aspect ratio [4:3], Quality [A]
•Aspect ratio [4:3], Quality [ ]
∫Available recording time (when recording motion pictures)
•“h” is an abbreviation for hour, “m” for minute and “s” for second.
•The recordable time is the total time of all the motion pictures which have been recorded.
•[AVCHD]
•[MP4]
Approximate number of recordable pictures and available recording
time
[Picture Size] 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB 128 GB
L (16M) 1810 3630 7260 14380
M (8M) 3310 6640 13000 25740
S (4M) 5670 11360 21480 42540
[Picture Size] 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB 128 GB
L (16M) 550 1110 2230 4420
M (8M) 640 1290 2580 5120
S (4M) 700 1410 2800 5550
[Rec Quality] 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB 128 GB
[FHD/28M/50p] 1h10m 2h30m 5h00m 9h55m
[FHD/17M/50i] 2h00m 4h5m 8h15m 16h25m
[FHD/24M/25p]/
[FHD/24M/24p] 1h25m 2h55m 5h50m 11h35m
[Rec Quality] 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB 128 GB
[4K/100M/25p]/
[4K/100M/24p] 20m00s 41m00s 1h20m 2h45m
[FHD/28M/50p] 1h10m 2h30m 5h00m 9h55m
[FHD/20M/25p] 1h35m 3h20m 6h40m 13h20m
[HD/10M/25p] 3h10m 6h20m 12h45m 25h25m
[VGA/4M/25p] 6h55m 14h05m 28h10m 55h55m

31
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
•Depending on the recording conditions and the type of card, the number of recordable pictures
and available recording time vary.
•AVCHD motion pictures:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds.
•MP4 motion pictures with a [Rec Quality] size of [FHD], [HD] or [VGA]:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds or
the file size exceeds 4 GB.
•MP4 motion pictures with a [Rec Quality] size of [4K]:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds.
–When using an SDHC memory card: You can continue recording without interruption even if
the file size exceeds 4 GB, but the motion picture file will be divided and recorded/played
back separately.
–When using an SDXC memory card: You can record a motion picture in a single file.
•The maximum available continuous recording time is displayed on the screen.

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
32
Attaching/Removing the Lens
By changing the lens, you will increase your picture taking-options and further your
enjoyment of the camera.
•Check that the camera is turned off.
•When attaching or detaching the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032/H-FS35100), retract the
lens barrel.
•Change lenses where there is not a lot of dirt or dust. Refer to P329 when dirt or dust gets on
the lens.
•Attach the lens cap.
While pressing on the lens release button A,
rotate the lens toward the arrow until it stops
and then remove.
•Hold the part around the base of the lens to rotate it.
•When the lens is removed from the camera body, make sure to attach the body cap to the
camera body and attach the lens rear cap to the lens.
•If the lens rear cap is fitted to the lens, remove it.
•If the body cap is fitted to the camera, remove it.
Align the lens fitting marks B and then rotate the lens in the direction of the arrow
until it clicks.
•Do not press the lens release button C when you attach a lens.
•Do not try to attach the lens when holding it at an angle to the camera body as the lens mount
may get scratched.
Detaching the lens
Attaching the lens

33
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
When using the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032/
H-FS35100/H-FS14140)
Rotate the zoom ring of the lens.
When recording into strong backlight, irregular reflection may occur within the lens. The
lens hood reduces the inclusion of unwanted light in the recorded images and lowers the
drop in contrast. The lens hood cuts off excess lighting and improves the picture quality.
•The interchangeable lens (H-FS12032/H-H020A) does not have a lens hood.
To attach the lens hood (flower shape) that came with the interchangeable lenses
(H-FS35100/H-FS14140)
Hold the lens hood by placing your fingers as
shown in the figure.
•Do not hold the lens hood in such a way that it will be
bent.
1Align the mark A ( ) on the lens hood with the
mark on the tip of the lens.
2Rotate the lens hood in the direction of the
arrow until it clicks and then align the mark B
( ) on the lens hood with the mark on the tip
of the lens.
Zoom operations
T side: Enlarges distant subject
W side: Widens angle of view
Attaching the Lens Hood
T
W

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
34
Temporarily Storing the Lens Hood
When using the interchangeable lens (H-FS35100)
1Turn the lens hood in the direction of the arrow to detach it.
2Align the mark C ( ) on the lens hood with the mark on the tip of the lens.
3Turn the lens hood in the direction of the arrow until it clicks into place.
When using the interchangeable lens (H-FS14140)
1Turn the lens hood in the direction of the arrow to detach it.
2Align the mark D ( ) on the lens hood with the mark on the tip of the lens.
3Turn the lens hood in the direction of the arrow until it clicks into place.

35
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Setting Date/Time (Clock Set)
•The clock is not set when the camera is shipped.
1Turn the camera on.
•When the camera is turned on, the status indicator 1
lights up green.
•If the language select screen is not displayed, proceed to
step 4.
2Press [MENU/SET].
3Press 3/4 to select the language, and press
[MENU/SET].
4Press [MENU/SET].
5Press 2/1 to select the items (year, month,
day, hour, minute), and press 3/4 to set.
A: Time at the home area
B: Time at the travel destination
To set the display order and the time display
format.
•To display the setting screen of the order/time, select
[Style] and then press [MENU/SET].
6Press [MENU/SET] to set.
:
:

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
36
7When [The clock setting has been completed.] is displayed, press
[MENU/SET].
8When [Please set the home area] is displayed, press [MENU/SET].
9Press 2/1 to select the home area, and then
press [MENU/SET].
•When an interchangeable lens (H-FS12032/H-FS35100)
is used and the lens barrel is retracted, recording is not
possible (a message will be displayed). Rotate the zoom
ring to extend the lens. (P38)
Select [Clock Set] in the [Setup] menu. (P54)
•The clock can be reset as shown in steps 5 and 6 on P35.
•The clock setting is maintained for 3 months using the built-in clock battery even
without the battery.
(Leave the charged battery in the unit for 24 hours to charge the built-in battery.)
•If the clock is not set, the correct date cannot be printed when you stamp the date on the
pictures with [Text Stamp] or order a photo studio to print the pictures.
Re-adjusting the clock

37
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Basic Operations
Hold the camera gently with both hands, keep your arms still at your side
and stand with your feet slightly apart.
•Do not cover the flash, AF Assist lamp A, microphone B, or speaker C with your
fingers or other objects.
•Make sure your footing is stable and there is no danger of colliding with another person or
object in the vicinity while taking pictures.
∫Detects orientation of camera (Direction Detection Function)
This function detects the vertical orientation when you record
with the camera vertically orientated.
When you play back the recording, the recording is
automatically displayed in vertical orientation.
(Only available when [Rotate Disp.] (P246) is set to [ON].)
•When the camera is held vertically and tilted significantly up or down to record, the Direction
Detection Function may not work correctly.
•Motion pictures, 4K burst files, and pictures taken with [Post Focus] cannot be displayed
vertically.
Tips for taking good pictures

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
38
Extending/retracting the lens [when the interchangeable lens
(H-FS12032/H-FS35100) is attached]
∫How to Extend the Lens
Rotate the zoom ring in the direction of arrow 1 from position
A (the lens is retracted) to position B [12 mm to 32 mm
(H-FS12032), 35 mm to 100 mm (H-FS35100)] to extend the
lens.
•When the lens barrel is retracted, images cannot be recorded.
C The lens is retracted
∫How to Retract the Lens
Rotate the zoom ring in the direction of arrow 2 from position
B [12 mm to 32 mm (H-FS12032), 35 mm to 100 mm
(H-FS35100)] to position A to retract the lens.
•The zoom ring will seem to click into the 12 mm position
(H-FS12032) or 35 mm position (H-FS35100), but continue to
rotate the lens until it reaches position A.
•When you are not recording images, we recommend that you
retract the lens.
D The lens is extended
Example: H-FS12032

39
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Adjust the angle of the monitor
•Be careful not to catch your finger, etc. in the monitor.
•When adjusting the angle of the monitor, be careful not to apply too much force, as this
may cause damage or malfunction.
•When not using this unit, close the monitor completely back to the original position.
∫Free angle shooting
The monitor can be rotated to suit your needs. This is convenient as it allows you to take
pictures from various angles by adjusting the monitor.
•Before attaching a tripod or unipod, close the monitor back to the original position.
•Depending on the tripod or unipod being used, the maximum angle to which the monitor can be
adjusted will be limited.
Taking pictures at a high angle Taking pictures at a low angle

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
40
Adjust the diopter to suit your vision so that you can see
the characters displayed in the viewfinder clearly.
Press [LVF] to switch between the Monitor and Viewfinder.
A[LVF] button
BEye sensor
•You can also use the button as a function button. (P58)
Press [LVF].
¢If [Eye Sensor AF] in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON], the camera automatically adjusts the
focus as the eye sensor is activated. The camera does not beep when focus is achieved with
[Eye Sensor AF].
Using the Viewfinder
Diopter adjustment
Switching the Monitor/Viewfinder
Automatic viewfinder/
monitor switching¢Viewfinder display¢Monitor display

41
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
∫Notes on automatic viewfinder/monitor switching
Automatic viewfinder/monitor switching enables the eye sensor to switch the display to the
viewfinder automatically when you bring your eye or an object near it.
•Eye sensor might not work properly depending on the shape of your eyeglasses, the way you
hold the camera, or bright light shining around the eyepiece. In that case, press [LVF] to switch
the display.
•During motion picture playback or a slide show, the camera does not automatically switch the
display to the Viewfinder with the eye sensor.
•The eye sensor does not work depending on the angle of the monitor.
Setting the eye sensor sensitivity and the automatic switching of the display
between the Monitor and Viewfinder
>[Custom] > [Eye Sensor]
[Sensitivity] This will set the sensitivity of the eye sensor.
[LVF/Monitor
Switch]
This will set the method for switching between the monitor and viewfinder.
[LVF/MON AUTO] (automatic switching between the monitor and
viewfinder)/
[LVF] (viewfinder)/[MON] (monitor)
•If you press [LVF] to switch the display, the [LVF/Monitor Switch] setting will
also switch.
MENU

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
42
The shutter button works in two steps. To take a picture, press it.
Press the shutter button halfway to focus.
AAperture value
BShutter speed
CFocus indication
•Aperture value and shutter speed are displayed.
(It will flash in red if the correct exposure is not achieved, except
when set to flash.)
•Once the subject is in focus, the focus indication is displayed.
(When the subject is not in focus, the indication flashes.)
Press the shutter button fully (push it in further),
and take the picture.
•When the image is correctly focused, the picture will be taken, since the [Focus/Release
Priority] (P212) is set initially to [FOCUS].
•Even during menu operation or image playback, if you press the shutter button halfway, you
can instantly set the camera ready for recording.
Start recording by pressing the motion picture
button.
•Release the motion picture button right after you press it.
Stop the recording by pressing the motion picture
button again.
Shutter button (Taking pictures)
Motion picture button (Recording motion pictures)
6060603.53.53.5
C
AB

43
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Select the mode by rotating the mode dial.
•Rotate the mode dial slowly to select the desired mode.
Mode dial (Selecting a Recording Mode)
Intelligent Auto Mode (P62)
Intelligent Auto Plus Mode (P63)
Programme AE Mode (P69)
Aperture-Priority AE Mode (P72)
Shutter-Priority AE Mode (P72)
Manual Exposure Mode (P73)
Creative Video Mode (P89)
Custom Mode (P91)
Panorama Shot Mode (P77)
Scene Guide Mode (P80)
Creative Control Mode (P83)

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
44
Front Dial
Rotating:
Selection of items or setting of values is performed during the various settings.
Rear Dial
Rotating:
Selection of items or setting of values is performed during the various settings.
Pressing:
Operations that are the same as [MENU/SET] button, such as determine settings, etc., are
performed during the various settings.
•These operating instructions describe operations of the front dial/rear dial as follows:
Allows you to set the aperture, shutter speed, and other settings when in ///
modes.
¢Pressing the rear dial enables you to set the exposure compensation.
•In [Dial Set.] in the [Custom] menu, you can change the operation methods of the front dial and
rear dial. (P46)
Front Dial/Rear Dial
e.g.: When rotating the
front dial to the left or right
e.g.: When rotating the
rear dial to the left or right
e.g.: When pressing the
rear dial
Mode dial Front dial Rear Dial
(P69) Programme Shift Programme Shift¢
(P72) Aperture value Aperture value¢
(P72) Shutter speed Shutter speed¢
(P73) Aperture value Shutter speed

45
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Temporarily changing the items assigned to the front/rear dials ([Dial Operation
Switch])
You can temporarily change the items assigned to the front/rear dials using the function
button to which [Dial Operation Switch] is assigned.
•You can set the items to be assigned temporarily to the front/rear dials in [Dial Operation Switch
Setup] in [Dial Set.] in the [Custom] menu. (P46)
1Set a function button to [Dial Operation Switch]. (P58)
•The following step is an example in which [Dial Operation Switch] is assigned to [Fn1].
2Press [Fn1].
•A guide will be displayed showing the items temporarily
assigned to the front/rear dials.
•If no operations are performed, the guide will disappear in
a few seconds.
3Rotate the front/rear dials while the guide is
displayed.
•The settings of the items assigned to the dials will change.
4Press [MENU/SET] and set.
•You can also complete this step by performing either of the operations below:
–Press the shutter button halfway
–Press the rear dial
–Press [Fn1]
•Items that are temporarily assigned to the front/rear dials can be used only while the guide
(step 2) or setting screen (step 3) is displayed.
989898
0
ISOISOISOISO
WBWBWBWB
WBWBWBWBWBWBWBWBWBWBWB
AWB
AWB
ISOISOISOISO

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
46
∫Setting the operation methods of the front dial and rear dial
> [Custom] > [Dial Set.]
[Assign Dial (F/SS)]
Assigns the operations of the aperture value and shutter speed
in Manual Exposure Mode.
[F SS]:
Assigns the aperture value to the front dial, and the shutter
speed to the rear dial.
[SS F]:
Assigns the shutter speed to the front dial, and the aperture
value to the rear dial.
[Rotation (F/SS)]
Changes the rotation direction of the dials for adjusting the
aperture value and shutter speed.
[]/[]
[Exposure Comp.]
Assigns the Exposure Compensation to the front dial or rear
dial so that you can directly adjust it.
[] (Front Dial)/[ ] (Rear Dial)/[OFF]
[Dial Operation Switch
Setup]
Sets the items to be assigned temporarily to the front/rear dials
when you press the function button to which [Dial Operation
Switch] is assigned.
[] ([Front Dial Operation])/[ ] ([Rear Dial Operation])
•Items that can be set are as follows.
–[4K Photo Mode] (P118)
–[Photo Style] (P188)
–[Filter Effect] (P83, 190)
–[Aspect Ratio] (P192)
–[AF Mode] (P97)
–[Focus Mode] (P95)
–[Highlight Shadow] (P195)
–[i.Dynamic] (P196)
–[i.Resolution] (P196)
–[Flash Mode] (P159)
–[Flash Adjust.] (P162)
–[Sensitivity] (P112)
–[White Balance] (P114)
–[Drive Mode] (P134)
•[Highlight Shadow] uses the two dials. It will be automatically
assigned to both of the dials when you assign it to either of
them.
MENU

47
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Pressing the cursor button:
Selection of items or setting of values etc., is performed.
Pressing [MENU/SET]:
Confirmation of setting contents, etc., is performed.
•These operating instructions expresses the up, down, left, and
right of the cursor button as 3/4/2/1.
•By assigning [Cursor Button Lock] to a function button, you can disable the cursor buttons and
the [MENU/SET] button. (P58)
Cursor buttons/[MENU/SET] button

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
48
Press [DISP.] to switch the information displayed on the
screen.
•If the information on the screen is not displayed any longer
because no operation was performed for some time, press the
[DISP.] button or touch the screen to display the information
again.
Switching the display method of the viewfinder/monitor
[ ] (viewfinder style): Scales down images slightly so that you can better review the
composition of the images.
[ ] (monitor style): Scales images to fill the entire screen so that you can see their
details.
∫[ ] Live View Finder style display layout (Example of viewfinder style display)
[DISP.] button (Switching the displayed information)
In Recording Mode
>[Custom] > [LVF Disp.Style]
>[Custom] > [Monitor Disp. Style]
With information
(detailed
information)
With information
With information
(detailed
information, tilt
sensor display)
With information
(tilt sensor
display)
MENU
MENU
98
0
AFS
AFS
50p
L
4:3
98
0
98
0
AFS
AFS
50p
L
4:3
98
0

49
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
∫[ ] Monitor style display layout (Example of monitor style display)
¢When the on-monitor recording information screen is displayed, you can touch the desired
item and change its setting directly.
•If you assign [LVF/Monitor Disp. Style] to [Fn Button Set] (P58) in the [Custom] menu, each
time you press the assigned function button, you can change the display style of the monitor or
viewfinder ([ ]/[ ]), whichever is currently in use.
∫About the tilt sensor display
With the tilt sensor displayed, it is easy to correct the tilt of the camera etc.
•When the tilt of the camera is little, the indicator changes to green.
•Even after correcting the tilt, there may still be an error of approximately n1°.
•When tilted significantly upwards or downwards to record, the tilt sensor display may not be
displayed correctly, and the Direction Detection Function (P37) may not work correctly.
With information Without
information
With information
(tilt sensor
display)
Without
information (tilt
sensor display)
Turned off
On-monitor
recording
information¢
AHorizontal direction: Correcting tilt to the left
BVertical direction: Correcting downward tilt
50p
989898
AFSAFS
L
4:3
0
50p
989898
AFSAFS
L
4:3
0
AFSAFS
98
AWB
0 0
0
Fn
ISO
AUTO
Wi-Fi
L
4:3

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
50
¢This is displayed if [Highlight] (P216) in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON].
•In certain situations, such as during motion picture playback, you can switch only between the
screen with information and the one without it.
In Playback Mode
With information
Detailed
information
display
Histogram
display
Without
information
(Highlight
display)¢
Without
information
60F3.5
0
AWBAWB
1/98981/98
2
00
L
4:3
100-0001
F3.5 60
P
sRGB
AFS
200
0
WBWB
ISOISO
AWB
STD.STD.STD.
L
4:3
10:00 1. DEC.2016
F3.5 60
1/98
ISO
200
0
100-0001

51
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Touch screen of this unit is capacitive. Touch the panel directly with your bare finger.
∫Touch
To touch and release the touch screen.
∫Drag
A movement without releasing the touch screen.
∫Pinch (enlarge/reduce)
Pinch the touch screen apart (enlarge) or together
(reduce) with two fingers.
•Touch the screen with the clean and dry finger.
•If you use a commercially available monitor protection sheet, please follow the instructions that
accompany the sheet.
(Some monitor protection sheets may impair visibility or operability.)
Not available in these cases:
•The touch screen may not function normally in the following cases.
–When touched by a gloved hand
–When the touch screen is wet
Touch screen (Touch operations)
Fn5
Fn6Fn6Fn7
Fn6
Fn8
Fn9
SNAP
AABBB
2.0X2.0X
2.0X
2.0X

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
52
Applicable modes:
Just by touching the subject you want as your point of focus, the camera will focus on the
subject and take the picture automatically.
∫To cancel the Touch Shutter function
Touch [ ].
•If shooting with the touch shutter fails, the AF area turns red and disappears.
Taking Pictures Using the Touch Function
Taking pictures using the Touch Shutter function
1Touch [ ].
2Touch [ ].
•Icon will change to [ ], and taking a picture with the
Touch Shutter function becomes possible.
3Touch the subject you wish to focus on, and
then take a picture.
•The picture is taken when the focus is achieved.
×
AE
AE

53
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Applicable modes:
You can easily optimise the brightness for a touched position. When the face of the subject
appears dark, you can brighten the screen according to the brightness of the face.
∫Cancelling the Touch AE function
Touch [ ].
•[Metering Mode] returns to the original setting, and the brightness optimisation position is
cancelled.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When using the Digital Zoom
–When [4K Live Cropping] is set
–When [Touch AF] in [Touch Settings] of the [Custom] menu has been set to [AF+AE] (P105)
Easily Optimising the Brightness for a Specified Area (Touch AE)
1Touch [ ].
2Touch [ ].
•The setting screen for the brightness optimisation
position is displayed.
•[Metering Mode] is set to [ ], which is used
exclusively for the Touch AE.
3Touch the subject you want to optimise the
brightness for.
•Touching [Reset] will bring the brightness optimisation
position back to the centre.
4Touch [Set].
AE
AE
AE
6HW
5HVHW
ュリヴヱハ

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
54
Setting menu items
You can either operate the buttons or touch the monitor to set menu items.
1Press [MENU/SET].
•The [Setup] menu contains some important settings relating to the camera’s clock and power.
Check the settings of this menu before proceeding to use the camera.
[Rec] (P187) This menu lets you set the aspect ratio, number of pixels, 4K Photo
and other aspects of the pictures you are recording.
[Motion Picture]
(P208)
This menu lets you set the [Rec Format], [Rec Quality], and other
aspects for motion picture recording.
[Custom] (P210) Operation of the unit, such as displaying of the screen and button
operations, can be set up according to your preferences.
[Setup] (P220)
This menu lets you perform the clock settings, select the operating
beep tone settings and set other settings which make it easier for
you to operate the camera.
You can also configure the settings of Wi-Fi related functions.
[Playback] (P228) This menu lets you set the Protection, Cropping or Print Settings,
etc. of recorded pictures.
2Press 3/4 of the cursor button to select
the menu item and press [MENU/SET].
•The menu item can also be selected by rotating the
rear dial.
•You can also move to the next screen by pressing
[DISP.].
(In touch operation)
Touch the menu item.
•The page can be changed by touching [ ]/[ ].

55
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
•There are functions that cannot be set or used depending on the modes or menu settings being
used on the camera.
3Press 3/4 of the cursor button to select
the setting and press [MENU/SET].
•The setting can also be made by selecting an option
by rotating the rear dial and then pressing the rear
dial.
•Depending on the menu item, its setting may not
appear or it may be displayed in a different way.
(In touch operation)
Touch the Setting to set.
∫Switching to other menus
1Press 2.
2Press 3/4 to select a menu selector icon, such as
[].
•You can also select the menu toggle icons by rotating
the front dial.
3Press [MENU/SET].
(In touch operation)
Touch a menu selector icon, such as [ ].
∫Close the menu
Press [ ] or press the shutter button halfway.
(In touch operation)
Touch [ ].

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
56
Calling frequently-used menus instantly
(Quick Menu)
By using the Quick Menu, some of the menu settings can be easily found.
•The features that can be adjusted using Quick Menu are determined by the mode or a display
style the camera is in.
1Press [ ] to display the Quick Menu.
•You can also use the button as a function button. (P58)
2Rotate the front dial to select the menu item.
3Rotate the rear dial to select the setting.
4Press [ ] to exit the menu once the
setting is complete.
•You can also set items by pressing the cursor buttons 3/4/2/1.
On-monitor recording information in [ ] (Monitor style)
(P48)
Press [ ], rotate the rear dial to select an item, and
then press the rear dial.
Rotate the rear dial to select the setting, and then press the
rear dial to set it.
•You can also set with 3/4/2/1 and [MENU/SET].
AFSAFS
AU
TO
603.5
AWB
50p
L
4:3
0
50p
AFSAFS
AU
TO
603.5
AWB
L
4:3
0
AFS
AFS
98
AWB
0 0
0
Fn
ISO
AUTO
Wi-Fi
L
4:3

57
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
When [Q.MENU] (P218) in the [Custom] menu is set to [CUSTOM], the Quick Menu can
be changed as desired.
Up to 15 items can be set to the Quick Menu.
1Press 4 to select [ ] and then press [MENU/SET].
2Press 3/4/2/1 to select the menu item in the top
row and then press [MENU/SET].
3Press 2/1 to select the empty space in the bottom
row and then press [MENU/SET].
AItems that can be set
BSet items
•You can also set the menu item by dragging it from the top
row to the bottom row.
•If there is no empty space in the bottom row, you can
replace an existing item with a new select item by selecting the existing item.
•To cancel the setting, move to the bottom row by pressing 4 and select an item to cancel,
and then press [MENU/SET].
4Press [ ].
•It will return to screen of step 1.
Press [MENU/SET] to switch to the recording screen.
Customising the Quick Menu settings
L
4:3
AFS
12345
L
4:3
AFS
A
B

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
58
Assigning frequently used functions to the
buttons (function buttons)
You can assign recording functions, etc. to specific buttons and icons.
•Some functions cannot be assigned depending on the function button.
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Press 3/4 to select the function button you want to
assign a function to and then press [MENU/SET].
3Press 3/4 to select the function you want to assign
and then press [MENU/SET].
•For details on the functions that can be assigned in [Setting
in REC mode], refer to P59.
•For details on the functions that can be assigned in [Setting
in PLAY mode], refer to P60.
•To restore the default function button settings, select [Restore to Default].
∫Configuring the function button settings from the on-monitor recording
information screen
Touching [Fn] on the on-monitor recording information screen (P48) also allows you to
display the screen in step 2.
∫Rapidly assigning functions
The assignment screen displayed in Step 3 above can be displayed by holding a function
button ([Fn1] to [Fn4]) for 2 seconds.
Recording mode:
The function assignment screen for [Setting in REC mode] is displayed
Playback mode:
The function assignment screen for [Setting in PLAY mode] is displayed
•In some cases the function assignment screen cannot be displayed depending on the mode or
display screen.
> [Custom] > [Fn Button Set]>
[Setting in REC mode]/[Setting in PLAY mode]
MENU

59
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
You can use assigned functions by pressing a function button when recording.
∫Using function buttons with touch operations
1Touch [ ].
2Touch [Fn5], [Fn6], [Fn7], [Fn8] or [Fn9].
∫Functions that can be assigned in [Setting in REC mode]
Using the function buttons during recording
[Rec] menu/Recording functions
–[4K Photo Mode] (P118): [Fn3]¢
–[Wi-Fi] (P252): [Fn5]¢
–[Q.MENU] (P56): [Fn2]¢
–[LVF/Monitor Switch] (P40): [Fn4]¢
–[LVF/Monitor Disp. Style] (P49)
–[AF/AE LOCK] (P109)
–[AF-ON] (P108, 109)
–[Preview] (P75): [Fn6]¢
–[One Push AE] (P76)
–[Touch AE] (P53)
–[Level Gauge] (P49): [Fn7]¢
–[Focus Area Set] (P60)
–[Zoom Control] (P150)
–[Cursor Button Lock] (P60)
–[Dial Operation Switch] (P45)
–[Photo Style] (P188)
–[Filter Effect] (P83, 190)
–[Aspect Ratio] (P192)
–[Picture Size] (P192)
–[Quality] (P193)
–[Metering Mode] (P194)
–[Bracket] (P138)
–[Focus Mode] (P95)
–[Highlight Shadow] (P195)
–[i.Dynamic] (P196)
–[i.Resolution] (P196)
–[Post Focus] (P131): [Fn1]¢
–[HDR] (P197)
–[Shutter Type] (P199)
–[Flash Mode] (P159)
–[Flash Adjust.] (P162)
–[Wireless Setup(Flash)] (P164)
–[Ex. Tele Conv.]
(still pictures/motion pictures) (P151)
–[Digital Zoom] (P153)
–[Stabilizer] (P146)
–[Sensitivity] (P112)
–[White Balance] (P114)
–[AF Mode/MF] (P97, 106)
–[Drive Mode] (P134)
–[Restore to Default]
[Motion Picture] menu
–[4K Live Cropping] (P171)
–[Snap Movie] (P176): [Fn9]¢
–[Motion Pic. Set]
([Rec Format] (P168)/[Rec Quality] (P168))
–[Picture Mode] (P174)
Fn5
Fn6
Fn6
Fn7
Fn6
Fn8
Fn9
SNAP

2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
60
¢Function button settings at the time of purchase.
•When set to [Focus Area Set], it is possible to display the position setting screen of either AF
area or MF Assist.
•Operations of the cursor button and [MENU/SET] are disabled when [Cursor Button Lock] is
set. Press the function button again to enable them.
Not available in these cases:
•[Fn1] is not available when recording with [ ] ([4K Burst(S/S)]) of 4K Photo.
•[Fn3] cannot be used in the following cases.
–When using [Multi Exp.]
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [4K Live Cropping]
•[Fn5], [Fn6], [Fn7], [Fn8], and [Fn9] cannot be used when the viewfinder is in use.
You can directly set an assigned function to a selected image by pressing the function
button during playback.
Example: When [Fn1] is set to [Favorite]
1Press 2/1 to select the picture.
2Press [Fn1], and then set the image as [Favorite].
∫Functions that can be assigned in [Setting in PLAY mode]
•The following functions can be assigned to the button [Fn1], [Fn3] or [Fn4].
¢Function button settings at the time of purchase.
[Custom] menu
–[Silent Mode] (P210)
–[Peaking] (P214)
–[Histogram] (P215): [Fn8]¢
–[Guide Line] (P215)
–[Zebra Pattern] (P216)
–[Monochrome Live View] (P217)
–[Rec Area] (P218)
–[Step Zoom] (P154)
–[Zoom Speed] (P154)
–[Touch Screen] (P219)
Using the function buttons during playback
[Playback] Menu/Playback functions
–[Wi-Fi] (P252): [Fn3]¢
–[LVF/Monitor Switch] (P40): [Fn4]¢
–[Favorite] (P247): [Fn1]¢
–[Print Set] (P248)
–[Protect] (P249)
–[Delete Single] (P186)
–[Off]
–[Restore to Default]
1/981/98
1/98
1/98

61
2. Getting Started/Basic Operations
Entering Text
1Press 3/4/2/1 to select text and then press
[MENU/SET] to register.
•Move the cursor to [ ] and then press [MENU/SET] to
switch text between [A] (capitals), [a] (lower case), [1]
(numbers) and [&] (special characters).
•To enter the same characters in a row, move the cursor
by rotating the rear dial to the right.
•The following operations can be performed by moving the cursor to the item and
pressing [MENU/SET]:
–[]]: Enter a blank
–[Delete]: Delete a character
–[ ]: Move the entry position cursor to the left
–[ ]: Move the entry position cursor to the right
•A maximum of 30 characters can be entered.
(Maximum of 9 characters when setting names in [Face Recog.])
•A maximum of 15 characters can be entered for [ ], [ ], [ ], [ ] and [ ].
(Maximum of 6 characters when setting names in [Face Recog.])
2Press 3/4/2/1 to move the cursor to [Set] and then press
[MENU/SET] to end text input.

62
3. Recording Modes
Taking Pictures using the Automatic Function
(Intelligent Auto Mode)
Recording Mode:
In this mode, the camera makes the optimal settings for the subject and scene, so we
recommend it when you wish to leave the settings to the camera and record without
thinking about them.
1Set the mode dial to [¦].
•The camera will switch to either the most recently used
of Intelligent Auto Plus Mode or Intelligent Auto Mode.
At the time of purchase, the mode is set to Intelligent
Auto Plus Mode.
2Align the screen with the subject.
•When the camera identifies the optimum scene, the icon
of the scene concerned is displayed in blue for 2 seconds,
after which its colour changes to the usual red. (Automatic
scene detection)

63
3. Recording Modes
The camera detects scenes automatically (Scene Detection)
( : When taking pictures, : When recording motion pictures)
∫Switching between Intelligent Auto Plus Mode and Intelligent Auto Mode
Select the [ ] or [ ] tab on the menu screen, press 1 to select [ ] or [ ], and
press [MENU/SET].
[i-Portrait] [i-Scenery] [i-Macro] [i-Night Portrait]¢1[i-Night Scenery]
[iHandheld Night
Shot]¢2[i-Food] [i-Baby]¢3[i-Sunset] [i-Low Light]
¢1 Only displayed when the built-in flash is open.
¢2 Only displayed when [iHandheld Night Shot] is set to [ON]. (P65)
¢3 When [Face Recog.] is set to [ON], [ ] will be displayed for
birthdays of registered faces already set only when the Face/Eye of
a person younger than 3 years old is detected.
•[¦] is set if none of the scenes are applicable, and the standard
settings are set.
•When recording 4K photos or when recording using [Post Focus],
Scene Detection works the same way as when recording motion
pictures.
¦
It is also possible to display the selection
screen by touching the Recording Mode
icon in recording screen.

3. Recording Modes
64
Intelligent Auto Plus Mode allows you to adjust some settings such as the brightness and
colour tone while also using Intelligent Auto Mode for other settings so that you can record
images more suited to your preferences. To record images with more ease, use Intelligent
Auto Mode.
(±: possible, —: not possible)
∫Auto Focus, Face/Eye Detection, and Face Recognition
The Auto Focus Mode is automatically set to [š]. If you touch the subject, the AF tracking
function will work. The AF tracking function (P99) will also work if you press 2 and then
press the shutter button halfway.
•When [Face Recog.] is set to [ON], and the face similar to the registered
face is detected, [R] is displayed in the top right of [ ], [ ] and [ ].
∫About the flash
When the flash is open, the camera automatically sets [ ], [ ] (AUTO/Red-Eye
Reduction), [ ] or [ ] to match the type of subject and brightness.
•Open the flash when the flash is to be used. (P156)
•When [ ] or [ ] is set, Red-Eye Removal is enabled.
•Shutter speed will be slower during [ ] or [ ].
∫Scene Detection
•If a tripod is used, for instance, and the camera has judged that camera shake is minimal when
the scene detection has been identified as [ ], the shutter speed will be slower than normal.
Take care not to move the camera while taking pictures.
•Depending on recording conditions, different scene types may be selected for the same
subject.
Intelligent Auto Plus Mode Intelligent Auto Mode
Setting the brightness ±—
Setting the colour tone ±—
Defocus Control ±±
Menus that can be set Many Few
The Backlight Compensation
•When there is a backlight, the subject appears darker and the camera will automatically
attempt to correct it by increasing the brightness of the picture.
In Intelligent Auto Plus Mode or Intelligent Auto Mode, backlight compensation works
automatically.

65
3. Recording Modes
Recording Mode:
When [ ] is detected while taking handheld night shots, pictures of the night scenery will
be taken at a high burst speed and composed into a single picture.
This mode is useful if you want to take stunning night shots with minimal jitter and noise,
without using a tripod.
•The angle of view will be slightly narrower.
•Do not move the camera during the continuous shooting after pressing the shutter button.
•Flash is fixed to [Œ] (forced flash off).
Not available in these cases:
•[iHandheld Night Shot] does not work for the pictures taken during a motion picture recording.
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When recording in Burst Mode
–When recording with the Bracket function
–When [Quality] is set to [ ], [ ] or [ ]
–When [Ex. Tele Conv.] in the [Rec] menu is set
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only when [Auto Shooting] is set)
Recording night scenes ([iHandheld Night Shot])
> [Rec] > [iHandheld Night Shot] > [ON]/[OFF]
MENU

3. Recording Modes
66
Recording Mode:
When there is, for example, strong contrast between the background and the subject,
multiple still pictures are recorded with differing exposures and combined to create a
single still picture rich in gradation.
[iHDR] works automatically as needed. When it does, [ ] is displayed on the screen.
•The angle of view will be slightly narrower.
•Do not move the camera during the continuous shooting after pressing the shutter button.
•You cannot take the next picture until the combination of pictures is complete.
•A moving subject may be recorded with unnatural blurs.
Not available in these cases:
•[iHDR] does not work for the pictures taken during a motion picture recording.
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When recording using the flash
–When recording in Burst Mode
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When recording with the Bracket function
–When [Quality] is set to [ ], [ ] or [ ]
–When [Ex. Tele Conv.] in the [Rec] menu is set
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only when [Auto Shooting] is set)
Combining pictures into a single picture with rich gradation ([iHDR])
> [Rec] > [iHDR] > [ON]/[OFF]
MENU

67
3. Recording Modes
Recording Mode:
1Press the rear dial to display the setting screen.
•Each time the rear dial is pressed in Intelligent Auto Plus Mode, the camera switches
between brightness setting operation (P68), Defocus Control operation, and normal
operation.
•Each time the rear dial is pressed in Intelligent Auto Mode, the camera switches between
Defocus Control operation and normal operation.
2Set the blurriness by rotating the rear dial.
•If you press [MENU/SET], you can return to the recording screen.
•Pressing [ ] on the blurriness setting screen will cancel the setting.
∫When operating the touch screen
1Touch [ ].
2Touch [ ] to display the setting screen.
3Drag the exposure meter to set the blurriness.
•If you press [MENU/SET], you can return to the recording
screen.
•Pressing [ ] on the blurriness setting screen will
cancel the setting.
•Auto Focus Mode is set to [ Ø].
The position of the AF area can be set by touching the screen. (Its size cannot be changed)
•Depending on the lens used, you may hear a sound from the lens when the Defocus Control is
used, but this is due to operation of the aperture of the lens and it is not a malfunction.
•Depending on the lens used, operational sound of the Defocus Control may be recorded during
the recording of a motion picture when the function is used.
Taking a picture with a blurred background (Defocus Control)
Strong defocus Weak defocus
SS
SS
SS
F
F
250500
4.0 5.6 8.0
3060125
AE

3. Recording Modes
68
Recording Mode:
∫Setting brightness
1Press the rear dial to display the setting screen.
•Each press of the rear dial switches among brightness setting, Defocus Control (P67) and
end operation.
2Rotate the rear dial to adjust brightness.
•You can adjust the Exposure Bracket setting by pressing
3/4 while the brightness setting screen is displayed.
(P139)
∫Setting colour
1Press 1 to display the setting screen.
2Rotate the rear dial to adjust colour.
•Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
∫Change the settings by using the touch screen
1Touch [ ].
2Touch the item you want to set.
[ ]: Colour tone
[ ]: Brightness
3Drag the slide bar to set.
•Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
•The colour setting will return to the default level (centre point) when this unit is turned off or the
camera is switched to another Recording Mode.
Recording images by changing the brightness or colour tone
+1+1 +2+2 +3+3 +4+4 +5+5
-
5
-
5
-
4
-
4
-
3
-
3
-
2
-
2
-
1
-
100
+1
+1
OFF
OFF
A
AB
B
B

69
3. Recording Modes
Taking Pictures with Automatically Adjusted
Aperture and Shutter Speed (Programme AE Mode)
Recording Mode:
The camera automatically sets the shutter speed and the aperture value according to the
brightness of the subject.
You can take pictures with greater freedom by changing various settings in the [Rec]
menu.
1Set the mode dial to [ ].
2Press the shutter button halfway and display
the aperture value and shutter speed value
on the screen.
AAperture value
BShutter speed
•If the exposure is not adequate when the shutter button is pressed halfway, the aperture
value and shutter speed turn red and blink.
98
98
9860
60
603.5
3.5
3.5
2
00
0
r98
r98
r98
BA

3. Recording Modes
70
In Programme AE Mode, you can change the preset aperture value and shutter speed
without changing the exposure. This is called Programme Shift.
You can make the background more blurred by decreasing the aperture value or record a
moving subject more dynamically by slowing the shutter speed when taking a picture in
Programme AE Mode.
1Press the shutter button halfway and display the aperture value and shutter
speed value on the screen.
2While the values are displayed (about 10 seconds),
perform Programme Shift by rotating the rear dial or
front dial.
AProgramme Shift indication
•It will switch between Programme Shift operation and
Exposure Compensation operation (P110) every time the rear dial is pressed while the
values are displayed.
•To cancel Programme Shift, turn off this unit or rotate the front/rear dial until the
Programme Shift indication disappears.
Programme Shift can easily be cancelled by setting a function button to [One Push AE].
(P76)
Not available in these cases:
•Programme Shift is not available in the following cases:
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When the ISO sensitivity is set to [ ]
Programme Shift
60
60
604.0
4.0
4.0
2
00
SS
SS
SS
F
F
0
98
98
98
250 15
4.0 5.6 8.0
3060125
A

71
3. Recording Modes
Taking Pictures by Specifying the Aperture/
Shutter Speed
Recording Mode:
•The effects of the set aperture value and shutter speed will not be visible on the recording
screen. To check on the recording screen, please use [Preview]. (P75)
•The brightness of the screen and the recorded pictures may differ. Check the pictures on the
playback screen.
•Rotate the front/rear dial to display the Exposure Meter. Unsuitable areas of the range are
displayed in red.
•If the exposure is not adequate, the aperture value and the shutter speed turn red and blink
when the shutter button is pressed halfway.
(Example: In Manual
Exposure Mode)
AExposure meter
BAperture value
CShutter speed
Aperture
value
Small
It becomes easier to
defocus the
background.
Large
It becomes easier to
maintain focus as far as
the background.
Shutter
speed
Slow
It becomes easier to
express movement.
Fast
It becomes easier to
freeze movement.
F
1258
5.64.0 8.0 11
603015
3030305.6
00
+3
SSSS
SSSS
A
CB

3. Recording Modes
72
When you set the aperture value, the camera automatically optimises the shutter speed
for the brightness of the subject.
1Set the mode dial to [ ].
2Set the aperture value by rotating the rear
dial or the front dial.
AAperture value
BExposure meter
•It will switch between aperture setting operation and
Exposure Compensation operation every time the rear
dial is pressed.
•When using a lens having an aperture ring, set the position of the aperture ring to [A] to activate
the front/rear dial settings. At positions other than [A], the ring setting takes priority.
When you set the shutter speed, the camera automatically optimises the aperture value
for the brightness of the subject.
1Set the mode dial to [ ].
2Set the shutter speed by rotating the rear dial
or the front dial.
AShutter speed
BExposure meter
•It will switch between shutter speed setting operation
and Exposure Compensation operation every time the
rear dial is pressed.
•When the flash is activated, the fastest shutter speed that can be selected is 1/160th of a
second. (P161)
Aperture-Priority AE Mode
Shutter-Priority AE Mode
8.0
8.0
8.0
60 4
4.0 5.6 8.0 11 16
81530
SS
SSS
SSS
F
F
B
A
F
F
60
8.0 5.6 4.0
250 500125
1
000
SS
SS
SSSS
250
250
250
AB

73
3. Recording Modes
Determine the exposure by manually setting the aperture value and the shutter speed.
1Set the mode dial to [ ].
2Rotate the rear dial to set the shutter speed,
and rotate the front dial to set the aperture
value.
AExposure meter
BAperture value
CShutter speed
DManual Exposure Assistance
Optimising the ISO sensitivity for the shutter speed and aperture value
When the ISO sensitivity is set to [AUTO], the camera sets the ISO sensitivity
automatically so that the exposure will be appropriate for the shutter speed and aperture
value.
•Depending on recording conditions, an appropriate exposure may not be set or the ISO
sensitivity may become higher.
Manual Exposure Assistance
•The Manual Exposure Assistance is an approximation. We recommend checking the pictures
on the playback screen.
•When you use a lens with an aperture ring, the aperture ring setting takes priority.
•When the flash is activated, the fastest shutter speed that can be selected is 1/160th of a
second. (P161)
Manual Exposure Mode
Available Shutter Speed (Sec.)
[T] (Time), 60 to 1/4000th (with the mechanical shutter)
1 to 1/16000th (with the electronic shutter)
The exposure is adequate.
Set to faster shutter speed or larger aperture value.
Set to slower shutter speed or smaller aperture value.
F
1258
5.64.0 8.0 11
603015
30
30
305.6
00
+3
SS
SS
SSSS
CB
A
D
000
++
30
+
30
000
−
3
−
3

3. Recording Modes
74
∫About [T] (Time)
If you set the shutter speed to [T] (Time) and fully press the shutter button, an exposure
starts. (Continues up to approximately 120 seconds.)
If you press the shutter button again, the exposure will end.
Use this when you want to keep the shutter open for a long time to take pictures of
fireworks, a night scene etc.
•It can only be used with Manual Exposure Mode.
•When taking pictures with the shutter speed set to [T], we recommend using a tripod
and taking pictures remotely by connecting the camera to a smartphone to prevent
camera shake. (P259)
•When you take pictures with the shutter speed set to [T], noise may become visible. To
avoid picture noise, we recommend setting [Long Shtr NR] in the [Rec] menu to [ON]
before taking pictures. (P202)

75
3. Recording Modes
Applicable modes:
The effects of aperture and shutter speed can be checked by using the Preview Mode.
•Confirm the effects of aperture: You can check the depth of field (effective focus range)
before taking a picture by closing the diaphragm blades to the aperture value you set.
•Confirm the effects of shutter speed: Movement can be confirmed by displaying the actual
picture that will be taken with that shutter speed.
1Set a function button to [Preview]. (P58)
•The following step is an example in which [Preview] is assigned to [Fn6].
2Touch [ ].
3Switch the effect preview screen by touching [Fn6].
•The screen switches each time [Fn6] is touched.
Depth of field properties
¢1 Recording conditions
¢2 Example: When you want to take a picture with a blurred background etc.
¢3 Example: When you want to take a picture with everything in focus including the background
etc.
•It is possible to record while in Preview Mode.
•Range for shutter speed effect check is 8 seconds to 1/16000th of a second.
Not available in these cases:
•Preview Mode is not available when recording with [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]) of the 4K Photo
function.
Confirm the Effects of Aperture and Shutter Speed (Preview Mode)
Normal recording screen
Aperture effect preview
screen
Aperture effect: ±
Shutter speed effect: —
Shutter speed effect
preview screen
Aperture effect: ±
Shutter speed effect: ±
¢1
Aperture value Small Large
Focus length of the lens Tele Wide
Distance to the subject Near Distant
Depth of field (effective focus range) Shallow (Narrow)¢2 Deep (Wide)¢3
Fn5
Fn6Fn6Fn7
Fn6
Fn8
Fn9
SNAP
Fn5
Fn6
Fn6
Fn7
Fn6
Fn8
Fn9
SNAP
6KWU6SHHG(IIHFWDGGHG
Fn6
3UHYLHZFRPSOHWHG
Fn6
Fn5
Fn6
Fn6
Fn7
Fn6
Fn8
Fn9
SNAP

3. Recording Modes
76
Applicable modes:
When the exposure setting is too bright or too dark, you can use one push AE to achieve a
suitable exposure setting.
1Set a function button to [One Push AE]. (P58)
2(When exposure is not adequate)
Press function button.
•The exposure meter is displayed, and the aperture and shutter speed are changed to give
a suitable exposure.
•In the following cases, suitable exposure cannot be set.
–When the subject is extremely dark and it is not possible to achieve adequate exposure
by changing the aperture value or shutter speed
–When recording using the flash
–In Preview Mode (P75)
–When using a lens that includes an aperture ring
Easily set aperture/shutter speed for suitable exposure (One Push AE)
How to tell if the exposure is not adequate
•If the aperture values and shutter speed blink red when the shutter button is pressed
halfway.
•If the Manual Exposure Assistance (P73) is anything other than when in Manual
Exposure mode.
Blink red The exposure is changed to give a
suitable exposure.
00
-
3
-
3
2
00
4000400040003.53.53.5
989898
2
00
15 250
4.0 5.6 8.0
1256030
60
60
603.5
0
SS
SSS
S
SS
F
F

77
3. Recording Modes
Taking panorama pictures (Panorama Shot Mode)
Recording Mode:
Consecutive photos taken while the camera is moved are combined to form a panorama.
1Set the mode dial to [ ].
•After the screen that asks you to check the recording direction is displayed, the
horizontal/vertical guidelines will be displayed.
2Press the shutter button halfway to focus.
3Press the shutter button fully and move the camera in a small circle
in the direction of the arrow on the screen.
4Press the shutter button once again to end the picture recording.
•Recording can also be ended by keeping the camera still while recording.
•Recording can also be ended by moving the camera to the end of the guide.
Recording from left to right
Image size: [STANDARD] Image size: [WIDE]
•Move the camera at a constant speed.
Pictures may not be able to be recorded properly if the
camera is moved too fast or slow.
ARecording direction and
panning (Guide)
A

3. Recording Modes
78
∫Changing the recording direction and angle of view (image size) of panorama
pictures
>
[Rec]>[Panorama Settings]
•The number of recording pixels in the horizontal and vertical directions of the panorama picture
varies depending on the image size, the recording direction and the number of combined
pictures.
The maximum number of pixels is shown below.
∫Technique for Panorama Shot Mode
[Direction] Sets the recording direction.
[Picture Size] Sets the angle of view (image size).
[STANDARD]/[WIDE]
Image size Recording direction Horizontal
Resolution Vertical Resolution
[STANDARD]
Horizontal 8176 pixels 1920 pixels
Vertical 2560 pixels 7680 pixels
[WIDE]
Horizontal 8176 pixels 960 pixels
Vertical 1280 pixels 7680 pixels
AMove the camera in the recording direction
without shaking it.
If the camera shakes too much, pictures
may not be able to be recorded, or the
recorded panorama picture may become
narrower (smaller).
BMove the camera towards the edge of the
range you wish to record.
(The edge of the range will not be
recorded in the last frame)
MENU

79
3. Recording Modes
∫About playback
Pressing 3 will start scrolling playback automatically in the
same direction as the recording.
•The following operations can be performed during scrolling
playback.
¢When the playback is paused, you can scroll forwards and backwards by dragging the
screen.
When the scroll bar is touched, the playback position jumps to the touched position.
•When the focal length is long, such as when a telephoto lens is attached, move the camera
slowly.
•The focus, White Balance, and exposure are fixed at the optimum values for the first picture. As
a result, if the focus or brightness changes substantially during recording, the entire panorama
picture may not be recorded at the suitable focus or brightness.
•When multiple pictures are combined to create a single panorama picture, the subject may
appear distorted or the connection points may be noticeable in some cases.
Not available in these cases:
•A panorama picture may not be able to be created, or the pictures may not be combined
properly when recording the following subjects or under the recording conditions below.
–Subjects with a single, uniform colour or repetitive pattern (such as the sky or a beach)
–Moving subjects (person, pet, car, waves, flowers blowing in the breeze, etc.)
–Subjects where the colour or patterns change in a short time (such as an image appearing on
a display)
–Dark places
–Locations with flickering light sources such as fluorescent lights or candles
3Start panorama playback/Pause¢
4Stop
1/981/981/981/98

3. Recording Modes
80
Taking Pictures that match the Scene being
recorded (Scene Guide Mode)
Recording Mode:
If you select a scene to suit the subject and recording conditions with reference to the
example images, the camera will set optimal exposure, colour, and focus, allowing you to
record in a manner appropriate to the scene.
1Set the mode dial to [ ].
2Press 2/1 to select the scene.
•The scene can also be selected by dragging an example
image or the slide bar.
3Press [MENU/SET].
•To change the Scene Guide Mode, select the [ ] tab on the menu screen, select [Scene
Switch], and then press [MENU/SET]. You can return to step 2 on P80.
•The following items cannot be set in Scene Guide Mode because the camera automatically
adjusts them to the optimal setting.
–Items other than the picture quality adjustment in [Photo Style]
–[Sensitivity]
–[Filter Settings]
–[Metering Mode]
–[Highlight Shadow]
–[HDR]
–[Multi Exp.]
–[Digital Zoom]
•Although White Balance is fixed to [AWB] for certain types of scene, you can fine tune the
White Balance (P116) or use White Balance bracketing (P117) by pressing the cursor button 1
on the recording screen.
•Depending on the scene, the recording screen may seem as if frames are missed.
•It is also possible to display the selection screen by touching the
Recording Mode icon in recording screen.
8

81
3. Recording Modes
Displaying the description of each scene and recording tips
Press [DISP.] while the scene selection screen is displayed.
•When it is set to the guide display, detailed explanations and tips for each scene are displayed.
Types of Scene Guide Mode
Normal display Guide display List display
[Clear Portrait] [Silky Skin]
•The smoothing effect is
applied to the part that has a
similar tone to the complexion
of a subject, as well.
•This mode may not be
effective under insufficient
lighting.
[Backlit Softness] [Clear in Backlight]
[Relaxing Tone] [Sweet Child's Face]
Touch the face.
•A still picture is recorded with
the focus and exposure set for
the touched location.
[Distinct Scenery] [Bright Blue Sky]
[Romantic Sunset Glow] [Vivid Sunset Glow]

3. Recording Modes
82
[Glistening Water]
•Star filter used in this mode
may cause glistening effects
on the objects other than
water surface.
[Clear Nightscape]
[Cool Night Sky] [Warm Glowing Nightscape]
[Artistic Nightscape] [Glittering Illuminations]
[Handheld Night Shot]
•Do not move the unit during
the continuous shooting after
pressing the shutter button.
•The angle of view will be
slightly narrower.
[Clear Night Portrait]
•We recommend using a tripod
and the self-timer.
•When [Clear Night Portrait] is
selected, keep the subject still
for about 1 second after taking
the picture.
[Soft Image of a Flower]
•For close-up recording, we
recommend that you close the
flash and avoid using it.
[Appetizing Food]
•For close-up recording, we
recommend that you close the
flash and avoid using it.
[Cute Dessert]
•For close-up recording, we
recommend that you close the
flash and avoid using it.
[Freeze Animal Motion]
•The initial setting for the AF
assist lamp is [OFF].
[Clear Sports Shot] [Monochrome]

83
3. Recording Modes
Taking Pictures with different image effects
(Creative Control Mode)
Recording Mode:
This mode records with additional image effects.
You can set the effects to add by selecting example images and checking them on the
screen.
1Set the mode dial to [ ].
2Press 3/4 to select the image effects
(filters).
Apreview display
•You can also select the image effects (filters) by touching
the example images.
3Press [MENU/SET].
•If you select the [ ] tab on the menu screen, you can select
the following menu items:
–[Filter Effect]: Displays the image effect (filter) selection
screen.
–[Simultaneous record w/o filter]: Allows you to set the camera
to take a picture with and without an image effect
simultaneously. (P191)
•White Balance will be fixed to [AWB], and [Sensitivity] will be fixed to [AUTO].
•Depending on the image effect, the recording screen may seem as if frames are missed.
•It is also possible to display the
selection screen by touching the
Recording Mode icon in recording
screen.
A
EXPS
EXPS

3. Recording Modes
84
Displaying the description of each image effect
Press [DISP.] while the image effect selection screen is displayed.
•When it is set to the guide display, explanations for each picture effect are displayed.
Types of image effects
Normal display Guide display List display
[Expressive] [Retro] [Old Days]
[High Key] [Low Key] [Sepia]
[Monochrome] [Dynamic
Monochrome]
[Rough
Monochrome]
[Silky
Monochrome]
[Impressive Art] [High Dynamic]
[Cross Process] [Toy Effect] [Toy Pop]
[Bleach Bypass] [Miniature Effect] [Soft Focus]
[Fantasy] [Star Filter] [One Point Color]
[Sunshine]

85
3. Recording Modes
∫Setting the type of defocus ([Miniature Effect])
1Press [Fn1] to display the setting screen.
•Setting screen can also be displayed by touching in order of [ ] then [ ].
2Press 3/4 or 2/1 to move the in-focus portion.
•You can also move the in-focus portion by touching the
screen on the recording screen.
•Touching [ ] allows you to set the recording orientation
(defocus orientation).
3Rotate the rear dial to change the size of in-focus
portion.
•The portion can also be enlarged/reduced by pinching out/pinching in (P51) the screen.
•Pressing [DISP.] will return the in-focus portion setting back to the default setting.
4Press [MENU/SET] to set.
•No sound is recorded in motion pictures.
•Approximately 1/8 of the time period is recorded.
(If you record for 8 minutes, the resulting motion picture recording will be approximately
1 minute long.)
The displayed available recording time is approximately 8 times.
•If you end motion picture recording after a short time, the camera may go on recording for a
certain period.
∫Set the colour to leave in ([One Point Color])
1Press [Fn1] to display the setting screen.
•Setting screen can also be displayed by touching in order of [ ] then [ ].
2Select the colour you want to leave by moving the
frame with 3/4/2/1.
•You can also select the colour you want to leave by
touching the screen.
•Pressing [DISP.] will return the frame back to the centre.
3Press [MENU/SET] to set.
•Depending on the subject, the set colour may not be left in.

3. Recording Modes
86
∫Setting the position and size of the light source ([Sunshine])
1Press [Fn1] to display the setting screen.
•Setting screen can also be displayed by touching in order of [ ] then [ ].
2Press 3
/
4
/
2
/
1 to move the centre position of the light source.
•The position of the light source can also be moved by touching the screen.
3Adjust the size of the light source by rotating the rear
dial.
•The display can also be enlarged/reduced by pinching out/pinching in.
•Pressing [DISP.] will return the light source setting back to the default setting.
4Press [MENU/SET] to set.
The strength and colours of the effects can be easily adjusted to fit your preferences.
1Press 1 to display the setting screen.
2Rotate the rear dial to set.
•Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
Point for when placing the centre of the light
source
A more natural appearance can be created by
placing the centre of the light source outside the
image.
Adjust the effect to fit your preferences
Image effect Items that can be set
[Expressive] Freshness Understated colours Pop colours
[Retro] Colour Yellow emphasised Red emphasised
[Old Days] Contrast Low contrast High contrast
[High Key] Colour Pink emphasised Aquamarine
emphasised
[Low Key] Colour Red emphasised Blue emphasised
[Sepia] Contrast Low contrast High contrast

87
3. Recording Modes
Image effect Items that can be set
[Monochrome] Colour Yellow
emphasised
Blue
emphasised
[Dynamic
Monochrome] Contrast Low contrast High contrast
[Rough
Monochrome] Grittiness Less gritty Grittier
[Silky
Monochrome] Extent of defocus Weak defocus Strong defocus
[Impressive Art] Freshness Black and white Pop colours
[High Dynamic] Freshness Black and white Pop colours
[Cross Process] Colour Green tone/Blue tone/Yellow tone/Red tone
[Toy Effect] Colour Orange emphasised Blue emphasised
[Toy Pop] Area with reduced
peripheral brightness Small Large
[Bleach Bypass] Contrast Low contrast High contrast
[Miniature Effect] Freshness Understated colours Pop colours
[Soft Focus] Extent of defocus Weak defocus Strong defocus
[Fantasy] Freshness Understated colours Pop colours
[Star Filter]
Length of the rays of light
Short Long
Number of the rays of light
Smaller Larger
Angle of the rays of light
Rotate to the left Rotate to the right
[One Point Color] Amount of colour left Small amount of
colour
Large amount of
colour
[Sunshine] Colour Yellow tone/Red tone/Blue tone/White tone

3. Recording Modes
88
1Press the rear dial to display the setting screen.
•Each press of the rear dial switches among brightness
setting, Defocus Control and end operation.
2Rotate the rear dial to set.
•If you press [MENU/SET], you can return to the recording
screen.
•Pressing [ ] on the blurriness setting screen will
cancel the setting.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following case:
–[Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode)
1Press the rear dial to display the setting screen.
•Each press of the rear dial switches among brightness
setting, Defocus Control and end operation.
2Rotate the rear dial to set.
•You can adjust the Exposure Bracket setting by pressing
3/4 while the brightness setting screen is displayed.
(P139)
∫Change the settings by using the touch screen
1Touch [ ].
2Touch the item you want to set.
[ ]: Adjusts an image effect
[ ]: Defocus level
[ ]: Brightness
3Drag the slide bar to set.
•Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
Taking a picture with a blurred background (Defocus Control)
Setting brightness
EXPS
SSSSSS
FF
250500
4.0 5.6 8.0
3060125
+1+1 +2+2 +3+3 +4+4 +5+5
-
5
-
5
-
4
-
4
-
3
-
3
-
2
-
2
-
1
-
100
+1
+1
OFF
OFF
EXPS
EXPS

89
3. Recording Modes
Recording motion pictures with manually set
aperture value/shutter speed (Creative Video Mode)
Recording Mode:
It is possible to manually change the aperture and shutter speed and record motion
pictures.
1Set the mode dial to [ ].
2Select the menu. (P54)
•The operation for changing the aperture value or shutter speed is the same as the
operation for setting the mode dial to , , or .
3Press the motion picture button (or shutter button) to start recording.
4Press the motion picture button (or shutter button) again to stop
recording.
•When [Exposure Mode] is set to [M], [AUTO] of the ISO sensitivity will switch to [200].
> [Motion Picture] > [Exposure Mode] > [P]/[A]/[S]/[M]
It is also possible to display the selection screen by touching the
Recording Mode icon in recording screen.
MENU
P

3. Recording Modes
90
The operational sound of the zoom or button operation may be recorded when it is
operated during the recording of a motion picture.
Using touch icons allows silent operation while recording motion pictures.
1Start recording.
2Touch [ ].
3Touch icon.
4Drag the slide bar to set.
•The speed of the operation varies depending on the
position you touch.
5Stop recording.
Minimising operational sounds during motion picture recording
Zoom
(When an interchangeable lens compatible with power zoom is used)
Aperture value
Shutter speed
Exposure Compensation
ISO sensitivity
Mic level adjustment
[ ]/[ ] Changes the setting slowly
[ ]/[ ] Changes the setting quickly
F
SS
ISO

91
3. Recording Modes
Registering your preferred settings (Custom Mode)
Recording Mode:
Up to 3 sets of current camera settings can be registered using [Cust.Set Mem.].
(, , )
•Initial setting of the Programme AE Mode is registered as the custom settings initially.
Preparations:
Set in advance the Recording Mode you wish to save and select the desired menu
settings on the camera.
Select the menu. (P54)
•The following menu items are not registered as custom settings.
Registering Personal Menu Settings (Registering custom settings)
> [Custom] > [Cust.Set Mem.] >
Custom set where you want to register settings
[Rec] menu [Setup] menu
–Data registered with [Face Recog.]
–The [Profile Setup] setting
–All menus
[Custom] menu [Playback] menu
–[Touch Scroll]
–[Menu Guide]
–[Rotate Disp.]
–[Picture Sort]
–[Delete Confirmation]
MENU

3. Recording Modes
92
You can easily call up the settings you have registered using [Cust.Set Mem.].
Set the mode dial to [ ].
•The custom set you used last time will be called up.
∫To change a custom set
1Set the mode dial to [ ].
2Press [MENU/SET] to display the menu.
3Press 2/1 to select the custom setting you want to use, and then press [MENU/
SET].
•Saving of the selected custom settings is displayed on the screen.
∫Changing the registered content
Registered contents do not change when the menu setting is changed temporarily with the
mode dial set to . To change the registered settings, overwrite the registered content
using [Cust.Set Mem.] on the custom settings menu.
Recording using registered custom set
It is also possible to display the selection screen by touching the
Recording Mode icon in recording screen.
C2C2C2
C2C 2C2

93
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and
Colour tone Settings
Adjusting Focus Automatically
By setting the optimum Focus Mode or Auto Focus Mode for the subject or recording
condition, you can let the camera automatically adjust focus in various scenes.
1Set the [Focus Mode] to [AFS], [AFF] or [AFC].
•The Focus Mode will be set. (P95)
2Press 2 ().
3Press 2/1 to select AF Mode and then press
[MENU/SET].
•The Auto Focus Mode will be set. (P97)
4Press the shutter button halfway.
•Auto Focus will be activated.
•The focus indication is displayed as [ ] in a dark environment, and focusing may take
longer than usual.
•If the camera detects stars in the night sky after displaying [ ], Starlight AF will be
activated. When focus is achieved, the focus indication [ ] and AF areas in focus are
displayed.
(Detection with Starlight AF works only for approximately 1/3 of the centre area of the
screen.)
Focus When the subject is
focused
When the subject is not
focused
Focus indication AOn Blinks
AF area BGreen —
Sound Beeps 2 times —
6060603.53.53.5
B
A
LOW
LOW
STAR

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
94
•If you zoom in/out after focusing on a subject, the focus may lose its accuracy. In that case,
re-adjust the focus.
•When the Focus Mode is set to [AFF] or [AFC].
–A beep will be emitted when focus is first achieved during the pressing halfway.
–If AF Mode is set to [Custom Multi], such as [ ] or [ ], the AF area is displayed for a
moment only when focus is achieved for the first time by pressing the shutter button halfway.
Subjects and recording conditions which are difficult to focus
•Fast-moving subjects, extremely bright subjects or subjects without contrast.
•When recording subjects through windows or near shiny objects.
•When it is dark or when jitter occurs.
•When the camera is too close to the subject or when taking a picture of both distant and near
subjects.

95
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
Applicable modes:
The method for achieving focus when the shutter button is pressed halfway is set.
Focus Mode (AFS/AFF/AFC)
> [Rec] > [Focus Mode]
Item Scene (recommended)
[AFS]
(Auto Focus
Single)
Subject is still
(Scenery, anniversary photograph, etc.)
“AFS” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus Single”.
Focus is set automatically when the shutter button is
pressed halfway. Focus will be fixed while it is pressed
halfway.
[AFF]
(Auto Focus
Flexible)
Movement cannot be predicted
(Children, pets, etc.)
“AFF” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus Flexible”.
In this mode, focusing is performed automatically when
the shutter button is pressed halfway.
If the subject moves while the shutter button is pressed halfway, the focus is
corrected to match the movement automatically.
[AFC]
(Auto Focus
Continuous)
Subject is moving
(Sport, trains, etc.)
“AFC” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus Continuous”.
In this mode, while the shutter button is pressed halfway,
focusing is constantly performed to match the
movement of the subject.
When the subject is moving, the focusing is performed by predicting the
subject position at the time of recording. (Movement prediction)
[MF] Set the focus manually. (P106)
MENU

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
96
•[AFF] and [AFC] are not available in the following situations. In this case, the display will
change to the yellow [AFS].
–Creative Video Mode
–When recording with [ ] ([4K Burst(S/S)]) of the 4K Photo function
–In low light situations
•In Panorama Shot Mode, [AFF] and [AFC] cannot be set.
•When the interchangeable lens (H-H020A) is used, [AFF] and [AFC] cannot be set.
•[AFF] is not available when recording 4K photos. [Continuous AF] works during recording.
•The Focus Mode cannot be set when recording using [Post Focus].
When recording using [AFF], [AFC]
•It may take time to focus on the subject when you operate the zoom from Wide to Tele or
suddenly change the subject from a distant one to a nearby one.
•Press the shutter button halfway again when it is difficult to focus on the subject.
•While the shutter button is pressed halfway, shake may be seen on the screen.

97
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
Applicable modes:
This allows the focusing method that suits the positions and number of the subjects to be
selected.
Auto Focus Mode
([Face/Eye
Detection])
The camera automatically detects the person’s face
and eyes.
An eye closer to the camera will be in focus, while
the exposure will be optimised for the face.
(When [Metering Mode] is set to [ ])
•Up to 15 faces can be detected. Eyes that can be
detected are only those of the face that is in focus.
•You can change the eye to be in focus. (P99)
•Position and size of the AF area can be changed. (P102)
([Tracking])
The camera focuses on the subject you specify.
The exposure will be optimised for the subject.
(When [Metering Mode] is set to [ ].)
Focus and exposure will keep on following the
subject even if it moves. (Dynamic tracking) (P99)
([49-Area])
Up to 49 AF areas can be focused.
This is effective when a subject is not in the centre
of the screen.
•You can select areas to be in focus. (P103)
, etc.
([Custom Multi])
From among 49 AF areas, you can freely set the
optimum shape of the AF area for the subject.
(P100)
([1-Area])
The camera focuses on the subject in the AF area
on the screen.
•Position and size of the AF area can be changed.
(P102)
([Pinpoint])
You can achieve a more precise focus on a point
that is smaller than [Ø].
If you press the shutter button halfway, the screen
that lets you check the focus will be enlarged.
•The focus position can be set on an enlarged
screen. (P103)

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
98
∫Restrictions on Auto Focus Mode
•The AF Mode is fixed to [Ø] in the following cases.
–When using the Digital Zoom
–[Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode)
•Setting cannot be made during recording in [Post Focus] or when [4K Live Cropping] is set.
([Face/Eye Detection])
•It cannot be set to [š] in the following cases.
–[Clear Nightscape]/[Cool Night Sky]/[Warm Glowing Nightscape]/[Artistic Nightscape]/
[Glittering Illuminations]/[Handheld Night Shot]/[Appetizing Food]/[Cute Dessert] (Scene
Guide Mode)
([Tracking])
•[ ] cannot be used with [Time Lapse Shot].
•In the following cases, [ ] operates as [Ø].
–[Glistening Water]/[Glittering Illuminations]/[Soft Image of a Flower]/[Monochrome] (Scene
Guide Mode)
–[Sepia]/[Monochrome]/[Dynamic Monochrome]/[Rough Monochrome]/[Silky Monochrome]/
[Soft Focus]/[Star Filter]/[Sunshine] (Creative Control Mode)
–[Monochrome]/[L.Monochrome] ([Photo Style])
([Pinpoint])
•In the following case, [ ] operates as [Ø].
–When recording motion pictures
–When recording 4K photos
•It cannot be set to [ ] in the following cases.
–[AFF]/[AFC] (focus mode)
Pressing the shutter button halfway to adjust the composition
When the subject is not in the centre of the composition in [Ø], you can bring the
subject into the AF area, fix the focus and exposure by pressing the shutter button
halfway, move the camera to the composition you want with the shutter button pressed
halfway, and then take the picture.
(Only when the focus mode is set to [AFS].)

99
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
When the camera detects a face, the AF area and the mark
indicating the eye to be in focus are displayed.
AThe eye to be in focus
Yellow:
When the shutter button is pressed halfway, the frame turns
green when the camera is focused.
White:
Displayed when more than one face is detected. Other faces
that are the same distance away as faces within the yellow AF areas are also focused.
∫Changing the eye to be in focus
Touch the eye to be in focus.
•Touch the eye in the yellow frame. If you touch any other
location, the AF area setting screen will be displayed. (P102)
•If you touch [ ] or press [MENU/SET], the eye focus setting
will be cancelled.
•The Eye Detection cannot be changed when [4K Live Cropping] is set.
•The camera may not detect faces in certain situations, such as when the subjects are moving
fast. In such situations, the camera performs the operation of [].
Aim the AF tracking frame over the subject, and press
the shutter button halfway.
AAF tracking frame
•AF area will turn green when the camera detects the subject.
•The AF area turns yellow when the shutter button is released.
•Lock is cancelled when [MENU/SET] is pressed.
Touch the subject.
•Perform the operation after cancelling the touch shutter function.
•The AF area turns yellow while the subject is locked.
•Lock is cancelled when [ ] is touched.
•If it fails to lock, AF area will flash in red, and disappear.
•In situations where AF Tracking does not work correctly due to certain recording conditions,
such as when the subject is small or the location is dark, the operation of [Ø] is performed.
About [š] ([Face/Eye Detection])
Locking the subject to be tracked ( [Tracking])
Button operation
Touch operation
A
A

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
100
Selecting from 49 AF areas, you can freely set the optimum shape of the AF area for the
subject.
1Press 2 ().
2Select a Custom Multi icon ([ ], etc.), and press 3.
3Press 2/1 to select a setting.
AThe current shape of the AF area
4Press 4.
•AF area setting screen is displayed.
5Select AF areas.
•The selected AF areas are displayed in yellow.
Setting the shape of the AF area ([Custom Multi])
([Horizontal
Pattern])
Horizontal line
This shape is
convenient for taking
panning shots or
similar shots.
([Vertical
Pattern])
Vertical line
This shape is
convenient for
recording objects,
such as buildings.
([Central
Pattern])
Cluster placed at the
centre
This shape is
convenient when you
want to bring the
centre area into focus.
//
([Custom1]/
[Custom2]/
[Custom3])
You can select a customised setting.
ヤピヤビヤヒ
A
ヤヒ
ヤビ
ヤピ

101
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
When selecting [ ]/[ ]/[ ]
When selecting [ ]/[ ]/[ ]
Drag your finger over the parts you want to set as AF
areas.
•If you touch one of the selected AF areas, the selection of
the area will be cancelled.
Press 3/4/2/1 to select the AF area, and then press [MENU/SET] to set (repeat).
•The setting is cancelled when [MENU/SET] is pressed again.
•If you press [DISP.], all the selections will be cancelled.
6Press [Fn1].
∫Registering the set AF area to [ ], [ ] or []
1On the screen in step 3 on P100, press 3.
2Press 3/4 to select a destination to which the setting will be registered, and
press [MENU/SET].
•Turning off this unit will return the setting adjusted with [ ]/[]/[] back to the default
setting.
Button operation Touch
operation
Description of
operation
3/4/2/1Touching Moves the
position
/Pinching in/out Changes the size
(3 levels)
[DISP.] [Reset] Restores the
default setting
Touch operation
Button operation
ヤヒ
ヤビ
ヤピ
ヤヒ ヤビ ヤピ

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
102
Applicable modes:
When [š], [ ], [Ø], or [ ] in Auto Focus Mode is selected, you can change the
position and size of the AF area.
•Perform the operation after cancelling the touch shutter function.
•You can also display the AF area setting screen by touching the recording screen. (When
[Touch AF] of [Touch Settings] in the [Custom] menu is set to [AF])
•The spot metering target can also be moved to match the AF area when the [Metering Mode]
(P194) is set to [ ].
Not available in these cases:
•When using digital zoom, the position and size of the AF area cannot be changed.
Position and size of the AF area can be changed.
1Press 2 ().
2Select [š] or [Ø] and press 4.
•AF area setting screen is displayed.
3Change the position and size of the AF area.
4Press [MENU/SET] to set.
•AF area with the same function as [Ø] is displayed in the touched position, when the [š]
is selected.
Setting of the AF area is cleared when [MENU/SET] is pressed or [ ] is touched.
Setting up position of the AF area/changing size of the AF area
When selecting [š], [Ø]
Button
operation
Touch
operation Description of operation
3/4/2/1Touching Moves the AF area.
Pinching out/in Enlarges/reduces the AF area in small steps.
sEnlarges/reduces the AF area in large steps.
[DISP.] [Reset]
Resets the AF area back to the centre.
•If you press the button again, the frame size will
be reset to the default setting.

103
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
You can set the focus position by selecting the group of AF areas.
The 49 AF areas are divided into groups, each consisting of 9
areas (on the edge of the screen, 6 or 4 areas).
1Press 2 ().
2Select [ ] and press 4.
•AF area setting screen is displayed.
3Press 3/4/2/1 to select an AF area group.
4Press [MENU/SET] to set.
•Only [i] display (centre point of selected group) will remain on
the screen.
•Setting of the AF area frame is cleared when [MENU/SET] is
pressed or [ ] is touched.
You can set the focus position precisely by enlarging the screen.
•The focus position cannot be set at the edge of the screen.
1Press 2 ().
2Select [ ] and press 4.
3Press 3/4/2/1 to set the focus position and then
press [MENU/SET].
•The assist screen for setting the focus position is displayed
in an enlarged size.
4Move [+] to the position to be in focus.
•When the picture is displayed in windowed mode, you can enlarge/reduce the picture by
approximately 3k to 6k; when the picture is displayed in full screen, you can enlarge/
reduce the picture by approximately 3k to 10k.
•On the assist screen, it is also possible to record a picture by touching [ ].
5Press [MENU/SET] to set.
When selecting [ ]
When selecting [ ]
Button
operation
Touch
operation Description of operation
3/4/2/1Touching Moves [+].
Pinching out/in Enlarges/reduces the screen in small steps.
sEnlarges/reduces the screen in large steps.
Switches the enlarged display (windowed/full screen)
[DISP.] [Reset] Resets [+] back to the centre.
Examples of group

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
104
Applicable modes:
You can move the AF area displayed on the viewfinder by
touching the monitor.
•Press the shutter button halfway to determine the focus position.
If you press [DISP.] before determining the focus position, the AF area frame returns to the
centre position.
•To cancel the AF area frame when the Auto Focus Mode (P97) is set to [š] ([Face/Eye
Detection]), [ ] ([Tracking]) or [ ] ([49-Area]), press [MENU/SET].
•The Touch Shutter function (P52) is disabled when using [Touch Pad AF].
Not available in these cases:
•The [Touch Pad AF] does not function in the following cases:
–When [4K Live Cropping] is set
–When [Pull Focus] in [Snap Movie] is set to [ON]
Setting the AF area position with the Touch Pad
>[Custom] > [Touch Settings] > [Touch Pad AF]
[EXACT]
Moves the AF area of the
Viewfinder by touching a
desired position on the Touch
Pad.
[OFFSET]
Moves the AF area of the
viewfinder according to the
distance you drag the touch
pad (P51).
[OFF] —
MENU

105
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
Applicable modes:
You can optimise the focus and brightness for the position you have touched.
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Touch the subject you want to optimise the
brightness for.
•AF area setting screen is displayed. (P102)
•The brightness optimisation position is displayed on the
centre of the AF area. The position follows the movement
of the AF area.
•[Metering Mode] is set to [ ], which is used exclusively for the Touch AE.
•Touching [Reset] returns the brightness optimisation position and the AF area to the
centre.
3Touch [Set].
•The AF area with the same function as [
Ø
] is displayed on the touched position.
•Touching [ ] ([ ] when [
Ø
] is selected) will cancel the [AF+AE] setting.
•When recording with the Touch Shutter, the focus and brightness are optimised for the touched
position before recording takes place.
•At the edge of the screen, the metering may be affected by the brightness around the touched
location.
Not available in these cases:
•[AF+AE], which optimises the focus and brightness, does not work in the following cases.
–When using the Digital Zoom
–When the AF area has been set by using the cursor button
–When [4K Live Cropping] is set
Optimising the focus and brightness for a touched position
> [Custom] > [Touch Settings] > [Touch AF] > [AF+AE]
When the background has become too bright, etc., the
brightness contrast with the background can be
adjusted by compensating the exposure.
MENU
5HVHW
ュリヴヱハ
6HW
AE

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
106
Adjusting Focus Manually
Applicable modes:
Use this function when you want to fix the focus or when the distance between the lens
and the subject is determined and you do not want to activate Auto Focus.
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Press 2 ().
3Press 3/4/2/1 to adjust the focus position, and press [MENU/SET].
•The assist screen is displayed, enlarging the area. (MF
Assist)
•You can also enlarge the area by rotating the focus ring,
moving the focus lever, or pinching out (P51) the screen
or touching the screen twice.
•You can also adjust the focus position by dragging (P51)
the screen.
•Pressing [DISP.] resets the focus position back to the centre.
4Adjust the focus.
> [Rec] > [Focus Mode]> [MF]
The operations used to focus manually differ depending on the lens.
When using an interchangeable lens (H-FS12032) with no focus ring
Press 1: Focuses on nearby subject
Press 2: Focuses on distant subjects
ASlide bar
•These operations are possible only on the focus
adjustment screen.
•Pressing and holding 2/1 will increase the
focus speed.
•Focus can also be adjusted by dragging the slide bar.
MENU
リヴヰ
ョㄏピ
AF
+
A

107
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
AMF Assist (enlarged screen)
BPeaking
CMF Guide
•The in-focus portions will be highlighted. (Peaking)
•You can check whether the point of focus is to the near
side or to the far side. (MF Guide)
You can perform the following operations:
¢When using an interchangeable lens with no focus ring, you can perform these
operations after pressing 4 to display the screen that lets you set the area to be
enlarged.
•When the picture is displayed in windowed mode, you can enlarge/reduce the picture by
approximately 3k to 6k; when the picture is displayed in full screen, you can enlarge/
reduce the picture by approximately 3k to 10k.
When using an interchangeable lens
(H-FS35100/H-H020A/H-FS14140) with a
focus ring
Rotate to A side:
Focuses on nearby
subject
Rotate to B side:
Focuses on distant
subjects
When using the interchangeable lens
having a focus lever
Move to C side:
Focuses on nearby
subject
Move to D side:
Focuses on distant
subjects
•The focusing speed varies depending on how
far you move the focus lever.
Button operation Touch operation Description of operation
3/4/2/1¢Dragging Moves the enlarged area.
Pinching out/in Enlarges/reduces the screen in small steps.
sEnlarges/reduces the screen in large steps.
Switches the enlarged display (windowed/full
screen).
[DISP.]¢[Reset]¢Resets the area to be enlarged back to the
centre.
A
B
C
D
AF
+
C
B
A

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
108
5Press the shutter button halfway.
•The assist screen will close. The recording screen will be displayed.
•You can also close the assist screen by pressing [MENU/SET].
•If you have enlarged the picture by rotating the focus ring or moving the focus lever, the
assist screen will close approximately 10 seconds after the operation.
•MF Assist or MF guide may not display depending on the lens used, but you can display MF
Assist by direct operation of the camera, using the touch screen or a button.
•The focus distance reference mark A is a mark used to measure the
focus distance.
Use this when taking pictures with Manual Focus or taking close-up
pictures.
Achieving focus quickly using Auto Focus
If [AF/AE LOCK] is pressed in Manual Focus, Auto Focus will work.
•Auto Focus works at the centre of the frame.
•If Auto Focus is used while the MF Assist screen is displayed,
the centre of the MF Assist screen will be focused.
•Auto Focus also works with the following operations.
–Pressing the function button to which [AF-ON] is assigned
–Touching [ ]
–Dragging the monitor and releasing your finger at the position
you want to focus on
•[AF-ON] is disabled when [4K Live Cropping] is set.
> [Custom] > [AF/AE Lock] > [AF-ON]
MENU
AF
AF

109
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
Fixing the Focus and the Exposure (AF/AE Lock)
Applicable modes:
This is useful when you want to take a picture of a subject outside the AF area or the
contrast is too strong and you cannot achieve appropriate exposure.
1Align the screen with the subject.
2Press and hold [AF/AE LOCK] to fix the focus
or exposure.
•If you release [AF/AE LOCK], AF/AE Lock is cancelled.
•Only the exposure is locked in the default setting.
3While pressing [AF/AE LOCK], move the
camera as you compose the picture and then
press shutter button fully.
AAE Lock indication
∫Setting the functions of [AF/AE LOCK]
•AF Lock only is effective when taking pictures in Manual Exposure Mode.
•AE Lock only is effective when taking pictures with Manual Focus.
•The subject can be focused again by pressing the shutter button halfway even when AE is
locked.
•Programme Shift can be set even when AE is locked.
> [Custom] > [AF/AE Lock]
[AE LOCK] Only the exposure is locked.
•When the exposure is set, [AEL] is displayed.
[AF LOCK] Only the focus is locked.
•When the subject is focused, [AFL] is displayed.
[AF/AE LOCK]
Both focus and exposure are locked.
•[AFL] and [AEL] are displayed when the focus and the exposure are
optimised.
[AF-ON] Auto Focus is performed.
2
0
0
60
3.5
AEL
AELAEL
AEL
0
0
A
MENU

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
110
Compensating the Exposure
Applicable modes:
Use this function when you cannot achieve appropriate exposure due to the difference in
brightness between the subject and the background.
1Press the rear dial to switch to Exposure
Compensation operation.
2Rotate the rear dial to compensate the
exposure.
AExposure Bracket
BExposure Compensation
C[Flash Adjust.]
•You can perform the operations below while the
exposure compensation screen is displayed.
•You can switch the functions between the rear dial and the front dial by pressing [DISP.].
3Press the rear dial to set.
Compensates the exposure
Adjusts the flash output (P162)
3/4Sets the exposure bracket (P139)
Underexposed Properly exposed Overexposed
Compensate the exposure
towards positive.
Compensate the exposure
towards negative.
+3+3
0
OFF
OFF
+
3
+3
+1+1 +2+2 +3+3
-
5
-
5
-
4
-
4
-
3
-
3
-
2
-
2
-
1
-
100
+1
+1
+5+5+4+4
A
B
C

111
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
•You can set the exposure compensation value in the range between j5 EV and i5 EV.
Settings can be made within a range of j3 EV to i3 EV while recording motion pictures,
recording 4K photos, or recording in [Post Focus].
•When [Auto Exposure Comp.] in [Flash] in the [Rec] menu is set to [ON], the brightness of the
flash will automatically be set to the level appropriate to the selected Exposure Compensation.
(P162)
•When the exposure value is out of the j3EV to i3 EV range, the brightness of the recording
screen will no longer change.
It is recommended to record by checking the actual brightness of the recorded image in the
Auto Review or playback screen.
•The set Exposure Compensation value is stored even if the camera is turned off. (When
[Exposure Comp. Reset] (P225) is set to [OFF])

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
112
Setting the Light Sensitivity
Applicable modes:
This allows the sensitivity to light (ISO sensitivity) to be set.
Setting to a higher figure enables pictures to be taken even in dark places without the
resulting pictures coming out dark.
1Press 3 ( ).
2Select the ISO sensitivity by rotating the rear
dial.
•You can switch the functions between the rear dial and
the front dial by pressing [DISP.].
AISO Limit Set
BISO sensitivity
3Rotate the front dial to set the upper limit of
ISO sensitivity.
•It will work when the [Sensitivity] is set to [AUTO] or
[].
4Press the rear dial to set.
•You can also press the shutter button halfway to set.
AUTO
AUTO
2
00
2
00
4040
ISO
ISO
ISOISOISO
ISOISOISOISOISOISOISO
AUTO
AUTO
ISO
ISO
LIMIT
LIMIT
OFF
OFF
B
A

113
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
¢1 When the [ISO Limit Set] (P201) of [Rec] menu is set to anything except [OFF], it is set
automatically within the value set in [ISO Limit Set].
¢2 Only available when [Extended ISO] is set.
•For information on the focus range of flash when [AUTO] is set, refer to P157.
•Cannot select [ ] in the following cases:
–Shutter-Priority AE Mode
–Manual Exposure Mode
•When [Multi Exp.] is set, the maximum setting is [ISO3200].
•You can use the following settings in the Creative Video Mode, when recording 4K photos, or
when recording with [Post Focus].
[AUTO]/[200] to [6400]
AUTO
The ISO sensitivity is automatically adjusted according to the
brightness.
•Maximum [ISO3200] (With the flash on [ISO1600])¢1
(Intelligent)
The camera detects movement of the subject and then
automatically sets the optimum ISO sensitivity and shutter
speed to suit the movement of the subject and brightness of
the scene to minimise the jitter of the subject.
•Maximum [ISO3200] (With the flash on [ISO1600])¢1
•The shutter speed is not fixed when the shutter button is
pressed halfway. It is continuously changing to match the
movement of the subject until the shutter button is pressed
fully.
L.100¢2, from 200 to 25600 The ISO sensitivity is fixed to various settings.
Characteristics of the ISO sensitivity
200 25600
Recording location
(recommended) When it is light (outdoors) When it is dark
Shutter speed Slow Fast
Noise Less Increased
Jitter of the subject Increased Less

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
114
Adjusting the White Balance
Applicable modes:
In sunlight, under incandescent lights or in other such conditions where the colour of white
takes on a reddish or bluish tinge, this item adjusts to the colour of white which is closest
to what is seen by the eye in accordance with the light source.
1Press 1 ( ).
2Rotate the rear dial or front dial to select the
White Balance.
¢The [AWB] setting is applied while recording motion pictures, recording 4K photos, or
recording in [Post Focus].
[AWB] Automatic adjustment
[V]When taking pictures outdoors under a clear sky
[Ð]When taking pictures outdoors under a cloudy sky
[î]When taking pictures outdoors in the shade
[Ñ]When taking pictures under incandescent lights
[]
¢When taking pictures with the flash only
[]/
[]/
[]/
[]
Set the White Balance value. Use to match the
condition when taking photographs.
1Press 3.
2Place a white object such as a piece of paper
within the frame at the centre of the screen, and press [MENU/
SET].
•This will set the White Balance and return you to the recording screen.
•The same operation can be performed by pressing the shutter button.
•White Balance may not be set when the subject is too bright or too dark.
Set the White Balance again after adjusting to appropriate brightness.
WB
WBWBWB
WBWBWBWBWBWBWB
AWB
AWB
1
2
3
4

115
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
3Press the rear dial to set.
•The White Balance is only calculated for subjects within the range of the camera’s flash. (P157)
•In Scene Guide Mode, changing the scene or Recording Mode will return White Balance
settings (including the White Balance fine adjustment setting) back to [AWB].
•In the Scene Guide Mode, settings suitable for each scene are made.
∫Auto White Balance
Depending on the conditions prevailing when pictures are taken, the pictures may take on
a reddish or bluish tinge. Furthermore, when a multiple number of light sources are being
used or there is nothing with a colour close to white, Auto White Balance may not function
properly. In a case like this, set the White Balance to a mode other than [AWB].
1 Auto White Balance will work within this range.
2 Blue sky
3 Cloudy sky (Rain)
4 Shade
5 Sunlight
6 White fluorescent light
7 Incandescent light bulb
8 Sunrise and sunset
9 Candlelight
KlKelvin Colour Temperature
[]
You can set the colour temperature manually for
taking natural pictures in different lighting
conditions.
1Press 3.
2Press 3/4 to select the colour temperature and
then press [MENU/SET].
•You can set a colour temperature from [2500K] to [10000K].
Under fluorescent lighting, LED lighting fixture etc., the appropriate White Balance
will vary depending on the lighting type, so use [AWB] or [ ], [ ], [ ], [ ].
6500K
1
2 3
4

4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
116
You can finely adjust the White Balance when you cannot acquire the desired hue by
setting the White Balance.
1Select the White Balance and then press 4.
2Press 3/4/2/1 to fine-adjust the White Balance.
•You can also make fine adjustments by touching the White
Balance graph.
•Pressing [DISP.] resets the position back to the centre.
3Press [MENU/SET].
•If you finely adjust the White Balance to [A] (amber), the White Balance icon on the screen will
change to orange.
If you finely adjust the White Balance to [B] (blue), the White Balance icon on the screen will
change to blue.
•If you finely adjust the White Balance to [G] (green) or [M] (magenta), [_] (green) or [`]
(magenta) appears beside the White Balance icon on the screen.
Finely adjusting the White Balance
2 : A (AMBER: ORANGE)
1 : B (BLUE: BLUISH)
3 : G (GREEN: GREENISH)
4 : M (MAGENTA: REDDISH)
GGGGGG
AAAAAABBBBBBB
MMMMMM

117
4. Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Colour tone Settings
Bracket setting is performed based on the adjustment values for the White Balance fine
adjustment, and 3 pictures with different colours are automatically recorded when the
shutter button is pressed once.
1Fine-adjust the White Balance in step 2 of “Finely
adjusting the White Balance” and then perform the
bracket setting by rotating the rear dial.
Rotating the rear dial to the right:
Horizontal ([A] to [B])
Rotating the rear dial to the left:
Vertical ([G] to [M])
•You can also set the bracket by touching [ ]/[ ].
2Press [MENU/SET].
•You can also set the White Balance Bracket in [Bracket] in the [Rec] menu. (P138)
Not available in these cases:
•The White Balance Bracket does not work in the following cases:
–Intelligent Auto Mode
–Intelligent Auto Plus Mode
–Panorama Shot Mode
–[Glistening Water]/[Glittering Illuminations]/[Handheld Night Shot]/[Soft Image of a Flower]
(Scene Guide Mode)
–Creative Control Mode
–When taking pictures while recording a motion picture
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When recording in Burst Mode
–When recording with the shutter speed set to [T] (Time)
–When [Quality] is set to [ ], [ ] or [ ]
–When using [Multi Exp.]
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only when [Auto Shooting] is set)
White Balance Bracket
GGGGGG
AAAAAABBBBBBB
MMMMMM

118
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
Recording 4K Photos
Applicable modes:
You can select the desired moment from a burst of pictures taken at 30 frames/second and
save that moment as a picture of 8 million pixels (approx.).
1Record a 4K photo.
2Select and save pictures.
3The picture is complete.
•Use a UHS Speed Class 3 card to record 4K photos. (P28)
•When recording 4K photos, the angle of view is narrower.
1Press [].
•The same operation can be performed by pressing the
[ ] button (4), using 2/1 to select a 4K photo icon
([ ], etc.), and pressing 3. (P134)
2Select the recording method with 2/1, and
then press [MENU/SET].
•You can also select the recording method in the [Rec
Method] of [4K PHOTO] in the [Rec] menu.

119
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
¢1 Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and
59 seconds.
–When using an SDHC memory card: You can continue recording without interruption
even if the file size exceeds 4 GB, but the motion picture file will be divided and
recorded/played back separately.
–When using an SDXC memory card: You can record a motion picture in a single file.
¢2 Audio is not played back when you perform playback with the camera.
[]
[4K Burst]¢1
For capturing the best shot of a
fast-moving subject (e.g., sports,
aeroplanes, trains)
Burst recording is performed while the
shutter button is pressed and held.
The shutter sound will be heard repeatedly.
APress and hold
BRecording is performed
Audio recording: Not available
[]
[4K Burst(S/S)]¢1
“S/S” is an
abbreviation of
“Start/Stop”.
For capturing unpredictable photo
opportunities (e.g., plants, animals,
children)
Burst recording starts when the
shutter button is pressed and stops
when pressed again. Start and stop
tones will be heard.
CStart (First)
DStop (Second)
ERecording is performed
Audio recording: Available¢2
[]
[4K Pre-Burst]
For recording as needed whenever
a photo opportunity arises (e.g., the
moment when a ball is thrown)
Burst recording is performed for
approximately 1 second before and
after the moment that the shutter
button is pressed. The shutter sound will be heard only once.
FApproximately 1 second
GRecording is performed
Recording length: Approximately
2 seconds Audio recording: Not available

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
120
3Press the shutter button to perform recording.
•The camera will perform burst recording of a 4K photo and saves it as a 4K burst file in
MP4 format.
•When [Auto Review] is enabled, the picture selection screen will be displayed
automatically. To continue recording, press the shutter button halfway to display the
recording screen.
•When using [Light Composition] (P237), it is recommended to use a tripod or use a
smartphone instead of the shutter and do remote recording (P259) to control camera
shaking.
∫Cancelling 4K Photo
In step 2, select [ ].
•The operation can be cancelled by pressing the [ ] button (4) and then selecting [ ]
([Single]) or [ ].
Recording with [ ] ([4K Burst]) (P121)
Recording with [ ] ([4K Burst(S/S)]) (P121)
Recording with [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]) (P122)
Battery drainage and camera temperature
•If the surrounding temperature is high, or 4K photos are recorded continuously, or the
temperature of the camera rises, [ ] may be displayed and recording may be stopped
halfway through to protect the camera. Wait until the camera cools down.
•When [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]) is set, the battery drains faster and the camera
temperature rises. Select [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]) only when recording.

121
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
1Select [ ] ([4K Burst]). (P118)
AAvailable recording time
2Press the shutter button halfway.
3Press and hold the shutter button fully for as long
as you want to perform recording.
•Press the button fully slightly in advance. Recording starts
approximately 0.5 seconds after it has been pressed fully.
•A 4K burst file will be recorded while the shutter button is
pressed and held.
•If you are using Auto Focus, [Continuous AF] will work during recording. Focus will be
adjusted continuously.
•For information on how to select and save pictures from recorded 4K burst files, refer to P126.
•If you remove your finger from the shutter button immediately after the start of recording, up to
a period of approximately 1.5 seconds after the moment that the finger has been removed may
be recorded.
1Select [ ] ([4K Burst(S/S)]). (P118)
AAvailable recording time
2Press the shutter button fully.
•Recording will start.
•If you are using Auto Focus, [Continuous AF] will work
during recording. Focus will be adjusted continuously.
3Press the shutter button fully again.
•Recording will stop.
•For information on how to select and save pictures from recorded 4K burst files, refer to P126.
Recording with [4K Burst]
Recording with [4K Burst(S/S)]
Recording tips
Adding markers to select and save pictures
You can add markers if you press [Fn1] during recording. (Up to 40 markers per
recording) When selecting and saving pictures from a 4K burst file, you can skip
to the positions where you added markers.
50p
AFSAFS
4K
4:3
0
R
5m0404s
R
5m04s
A
50p
AFSAFS
4K
4:3
0
R
5m0404s
R
5m04s
A

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
122
∫Setting Loop Recording
The camera performs recording while deleting the data of the preceding part so that you
can continue recording while waiting for a photo opportunity, without replacing the card.
•Once you start recording, the 4K burst file will be recorded and divided approximately every
2minutes.
Approximately the last 10 minutes (up to approximately 12 minutes) will be saved. The
preceding part will be deleted.
Select the menu. (P54)
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]
•We recommend that you use a sufficiently charged battery or an AC adaptor (optional).
•Up to 29 minutes and 59 seconds of continuous recording is possible.
•[ ] is displayed during recording.
•The available recording time and elapsed recording time are not displayed during recording.
•[Loop Recording] is not possible when there is insufficient free space on the card.
•[Loop Recording] is available only for [ ] ([4K Burst(S/S)]).
1Select [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]). (P118)
ANumber of recordings that can be made
•If you press the shutter button halfway, the aperture value
and shutter speed will be displayed.
2Press the shutter button fully.
•Recording of a 4K burst file will be performed for
approximately 1 second before and after the moment that
the shutter button is pressed.
•For information on how to select and save pictures from recorded 4K burst files, refer to P129.
•When recording with [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]), images may not be displayed as smoothly as when
recording with the normal recording screen.
>[Rec] > [4K PHOTO] > [Loop Recording]
Recording with [4K Pre-Burst]
Recording tips
Focus and exposure
Auto Focus adjusts focus continuously, and except in Manual Exposure Mode, it
also adjusts exposure continuously.
•In situations where you want to lock focus and exposure, such as when the subject
is not at the centre, use [AF/AE LOCK]. (P109)
MENU
50p
1200
1200
1200
AFS
AFS
4K
4:3
0
A

123
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
∫To change the aspect ratio
Selecting [Aspect Ratio] in the [Rec] menu allows you to change the aspect ratio for 4K
photos.
∫To record the subject with reduced blur
You can reduce the blur of the subject by setting a faster shutter speed.
1Set the mode dial to [ ].
2Set the shutter speed by rotating the rear dial or the front dial.
∫Shutter sound for 4K photo recording
When using [ ] (
[4K Burst]
) or [ ] (
[4K Pre-Burst]
), recording is performed with the
electronic shutter. You can change the electronic shutter sound settings in [E-Shutter Vol]
and [E-Shutter Tone].
(P221)
When recording with [ ] ([4K Burst(S/S)]), you can set the start/stop tone volume in
[Beep Volume].
•You can perform high speed burst recording quietly using the 4K Photo function in combination
with [Silent Mode].
∫Scenes not suitable for the 4K Photo function
Recording in extremely bright locations or indoors
When subjects are recorded in an extremely bright place or under fluorescent/LED
lighting, the colour tone or brightness of the image may change, or horizontal stripes may
appear on the screen.
Lowering the shutter speed may reduce the effect of the horizontal stripes.
Subjects that are moving fast in the horizontal direction
If you record a subject moving fast in the horizontal direction, the subject in the recorded
pictures may appear distorted.
Notes on the 4K Photo function
•Approximate shutter speed for outdoor recording in fine weather conditions:
1/1000 seconds or faster.
•If you increase the shutter speed, the ISO sensitivity becomes higher, which may
increase the noise on the screen.

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
124
∫Limitations on the 4K Photo function
To optimise settings for 4K photo recording, certain limitations apply to some recording
functions, menu items and other settings.
•The following items are fixed to the settings indicated below:
¢Settings in the [Motion Picture] menu are not applied to 4K photo recording.
•The following limitations apply to the recording functions indicated below:
[Picture Size]
[4K] (8M)
•Following picture sizes will be applied:
[4:3]: (3328k2496)
[16:9]: (3840k2160)
[3:2]: (3504k2336)
[1:1]: (2880k2880)
[Quality] [A]
[Shutter Type] [ESHTR]
[Rec Format]¢[MP4]
[Rec Quality]¢[4K/100M/30p]
[Continuous AF]¢[ON]
[ ] ([4K Burst])/
[ ] ([4K Burst(S/S)]) [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst])
Programme Shift s
Exposure Compensation j3EV to i3EV
Shutter speed 1/30th to1/16000th
Focus mode (AFF) s
[AF Mode] ( ) s
[MF Assist] ±s
White Balance () s
ISO sensitivity [AUTO], 200 to 6400
Flash s

125
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
•The following menu items are disabled:
Applicable to [ ] ([4K Burst])/[ ] ([4K Burst(S/S)])/[ ] ([4K Pre-Burst])
Only [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst])
•The following changes occur when recording 4K photos:
–The [i.Resolution] setting changes from [EXTENDED] to [LOW].
–[Destination] in [Travel Date] cannot be recorded.
–[Simultaneous record w/o filter] is not available.
–It is not possible to use the HDMI output.
•When recording with [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]), [Step Zoom] in [Power Zoom Lens] is disabled.
•Scene Detection in Intelligent Auto Mode works the same way as when recording motion
pictures.
•When the drive mode is set to 4K Photo, it is not possible to take pictures while recording
motion picture. (Only when [ ] ([Photo Priority]) is set)
Not available in these cases:
•The 4K Photo function is disabled when using the following settings:
–[Clear in Backlight]/[Glistening Water]/[Artistic Nightscape]/[Glittering Illuminations]/[Handheld
Night Shot]/[Clear Night Portrait]/[Soft Image of a Flower] (Scene Guide Mode)
–[Rough Monochrome]/[Silky Monochrome]/[Miniature Effect]/[Soft Focus]/[Star Filter]/
[Sunshine] (Creative Control Mode)
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When recording motion pictures
–When recording with the shutter speed set to [T] (Time)
–When using [Multi Exp.]
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation]
[Rec]
[Picture Size]/[Quality]/[Bracket]/[iHandheld Night Shot]/[iHDR]/[HDR]/
[Panorama Settings]/[Shutter Type]/[Shutter Delay]/[Flash]/[Extended ISO]/
[Long Shtr NR]/[Shading Comp.]/[Ex. Tele Conv.]/[Color Space]/[Face
Recog.]/[Profile Setup]
[Custom] [Rec Area]
[Setup] [Economy]

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
126
Selecting pictures from 4K burst file and saving
This section describes how to select pictures from a 4K burst file and save them.
For information on how to record 4K burst files, refer to P118.
•The picture will be saved in JPEG format.
•The picture will be saved with recording information (Exif information), including its shutter
speed, aperture and ISO sensitivity information.
1Select a 4K burst file on the playback screen, and
press 3.
•4K burst files are displayed with [ ].
•You can also perform the same operation by touching the
icon [ ].
•The slide view screen for selecting pictures will be
displayed.
2Drag the frames to select the frame you want to save
as a picture.
•
You can also perform the same operation by pressing
2
/
1
.
3Press [MENU/SET] to save the picture.
<Slide view screen>
Setting [Playback Mode] in the [Playback] menu to [4K PHOTO] enables you to play
back only 4K burst files and pictures created from them.
4K burst files recorded with [ ] ([4K Burst]) or [ ] ([4K Burst(S/S)])
When you select pictures from any 4K burst file
with long burst time, we recommend that you
make a rough selection of scenes using the 4K
burst playback screen, and then select the desired
frame which you want to save as a picture by
using the slide view screen.
•For details on how to operate, refer to P126, P128.
Fn1
Fn3
Position of the displayed
frame

127
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
•During marker operation, you can skip to the markers that you added or the beginning or end of
the 4K burst file. Press [Fn1] again to return to the original operation.
Button
operation
Touch
operation Description of operation
2/1Dragging
Selects a frame
•You can select a frame from 60 frames (continuous burst
time of approximately 2 seconds).
Select /
>
[MENU/SET]
/
Displays the previous or next frames in slide view
•The previous or next 45 frames (burst time of
approximately 1.5 seconds) will replace 45 of the frames
that are currently displayed in slide view.
•Pressing the same button again will display the frames
following the next ones or the ones preceding the previous
ones.
sTouching/
Dragging
Selects the frames to be displayed
•Frames preceding and following the selected frame will be
displayed in slide view.
Pinching out/in Enlarges/reduces the display
sSelects a frame while maintaining the enlarged display
(during enlarged display)
3/4/2/1Dragging Moves the enlarged area (during enlarged display)
[Fn3] Displays the 4K burst playback screen.
[Fn1] Switches to marker operation
s/ Adds/deletes a marker
s
In-focus portions are highlighted with colour. ([Peaking])
•Switches in order of [OFF]>[ON] ([LOW]) > [ON]
([HIGH]).
[DISP.] s
Each time you press the button, the information display
mode changes in the following order:
Display with information > Display without information
> Display with a histogram.
[MENU/SET] Saves the picture
Button operation Touch operation Description of operation
1Moves to the next marker.
2Moves to the previous marker.

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
128
<4K burst playback screen>
Button
operation
Touch
operation Description of operation
3Continuous playback
4
Continuous rewind
•Frames are rewound in approximately 0.5 second intervals
at a faster speed than that of continuous playback.
3/4Pause (during continuous playback/rewind)
1Fast forward
Frame-by-frame forward (during pause)
2Fast rewind
Frame-by-frame rewind (during pause)
sTouching/
Dragging
Selects the frames to be displayed (during pause)
Pinching out/in Enlarges/reduces the display (during pause)
sSelects a frame while maintaining the enlarged display
(during enlarged display)
3/4/2/1Dragging Moves the enlarged area (during enlarged display)
[Fn3] Displays the slide view screen (during pause)
[Fn1] Switches to marker operation
s/Adds/deletes a marker
s
In-focus portions are highlighted with colour. ([Peaking])
•Switches in order of [OFF]>[ON] ([LOW]) > [ON]
([HIGH]).
[DISP.] s
Each time you press the button, the information display
mode changes in the following order:
Display with information > Display without information
> Display with a histogram.
[MENU/SET] Saves the picture (during pause)
Fn1
Fn3
Fn1
During continuous playbackDuring pause

129
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
1Select a 4K burst file on the playback screen, and
press 3.
•4K burst files are displayed with [ ].
•You can also perform the same operation by touching the
icon [ ].
•The slide view screen for selecting pictures will be
displayed.
2Drag the frames to select the frame you want to save as a picture.
•You can also perform the same operation by pressing 2/1.
3Press [MENU/SET] to save the picture.
4K burst files recorded with [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst])
Button
operation
Touch
operation Description of operation
2/1Dragging Selects a frame
Pinching out/in Enlarges/reduces the display
sSelects a frame while maintaining the enlarged display
(during enlarged display)
3/4/2/1Dragging Moves the enlarged area (during enlarged display)
s
In-focus portions are highlighted with colour. ([Peaking])
•Switches in order of [OFF]>[ON] ([LOW]) > [ON]
([HIGH]).
[DISP.] s
Each time you press the button, the information display
mode changes in the following order:
Display with information > Display without information
> Display with a histogram.
[MENU/SET] Saves the picture

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
130
∫Selecting and saving pictures on the TV screen
•When connecting to a TV that does not support 4K motion picture, select [AUTO].
Connect the camera and a TV with an HDMI micro cable, and display the
playback screen. (P292)
•To select and save pictures when the camera is connected to a TV with an HDMI micro cable,
set [VIERA Link] in [TV Connection] to [OFF].
•If you connect the camera to a TV with an HDMI micro cable and display 4K burst files on the
TV, they will be displayed only on the 4K burst playback screen.
The 4K burst playback screen for playing back 4K burst files recorded with [ ] ([4K Burst]) or
[ ] ([4K Burst(S/S)]) is displayed, and the slide view screen is not displayed.
•Even if you insert the SD card to a 4K-compatible TV with an SD card slot, you cannot play
back 4K burst files recorded with [Aspect Ratio] set to an option other than [16:9].
To play them back, connect the camera and a 4K-compatible TV with an HDMI micro cable.
(As of April 2016)
•Depending on the TV to be connected, 4K burst files may not be played back correctly.
•You cannot play back 4K burst files while the currently retrieving information icon ([ ] or
[ ]) is displayed. Wait until the icon disappears.
•If you touch the slide view screen or 4K burst playback screen twice, the screen will be
enlarged. To return to the original display, touch the enlarged screen twice.
•To select and save pictures from 4K burst files on a PC, use the software
“PHOTOfunSTUDIO”. (P296)
Please note that it is not possible to edit a 4K burst file as a motion picture.
Preparation: Set [HDMI Mode (Play)] (P224) to [AUTO] or [4K].

131
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
Selecting a focus point after recording
([Post Focus])
Applicable modes:
The camera can perform Burst recording in the same picture quality as 4K photo recording
while automatically shifting the focus to different areas. After the recording, you can select
the desired area on the screen and save a picture in which the selected area is in focus.
This function is suited for recording still objects.
•Use a UHS Speed Class 3 card. (P28)
•When using [Post Focus], the angle of view is narrower.
1Press [ ].
2Press 2/1 to select [ON] and press [MENU/SET].
•It can also be set by going to the [Rec] menu and selecting [ON] for [Post Focus].
3Decide on the composition, and press the shutter
button halfway.
•Auto Focus will detect focus areas on the screen.
(Excluding the edges of the screen)
•If no areas on the screen can be brought into focus, the
focus display (A) will flash. Recording is not possible in
this case.
4Press the shutter button fully to start recording.
•The focus point changes automatically while recording.
When the icon (B) disappears, recording automatically
ends.
•A motion picture in MP4 format will be recorded. (Audio will not be recorded.)
•When [Auto Review] is enabled, a screen that lets you select the desired focus area will
be displayed. (P133)
4K burst recording while
automatically shifting the
focus.
Touch the desired focus
point.
A picture with the desired
focus point is made.
Recording using [Post Focus]
From the time you press the shutter button halfway until the end of recording:
•Maintain the same distance to the subject and the same composition.
•Do not operate the zoom. (Otherwise, recording will not be performed or will stop.)
5HFRUGLQJLQSRVWIRFXV
5
m
04
s
4K
4:3
残
5m04s
[Post Focus]: [ON] A
B

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
132
∫To cancel [Post Focus]
Select [OFF] in step 2 on P131.
∫Limitations in [Post Focus]
•Since recording is performed in the same image quality as 4K photos, certain limitations apply
to recording functions and menu settings. For details, refer to “Limitations on the 4K Photo
function” on P124.
•In addition to the limitations of the 4K Photo function, the following limitations apply to [Post
Focus] recording:
–Focus Mode is fixed to [AFS].
–Auto Focus Mode is disabled.
–Motion pictures cannot be recorded.
–Only [Single] and [Self Timer] ([ ] and [ ]) are available for the drive mode.
–[Digital Zoom] is disabled.
Not available in these cases:
•The [Post Focus] function is disabled when using the following settings:
–[Clear in Backlight]/[Glistening Water]/[Artistic Nightscape]/[Glittering Illuminations]/
[Handheld Night Shot]/[Clear Night Portrait]/[Soft Image of a Flower] (Scene Guide Mode)
–[Rough Monochrome]/[Silky Monochrome]/[Miniature Effect]/[Soft Focus]/[Star Filter]/
[Sunshine] (Creative Control Mode)
–When [Multi Exp.] is set
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation]
About camera temperature
•If the surrounding temperature is high, or [Post Focus] recording is performed continuously,
or the temperature of the camera rises, [ ] may be displayed and recording may be
stopped halfway through to protect the camera. Wait until the camera cools down.

133
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
1Select an image with the [ ] icon on the playback screen, and
press 3.
•You can also perform the same operation by touching the icon [ ].
2Select and touch a focus area.
•A picture in which the selected area is in focus will be
displayed.
•If a picture that is in focus is not available for the selected
area, a red frame will be displayed. You cannot save a
picture in this case.
•You cannot select the edges of the screen.
•You can fine-adjust the focus by dragging the slide bar
during enlarged display. (You can also perform the same
operation by pressing 2/1.)
3Touch [ ] to save the picture.
•The picture will be saved in JPEG format.
•After saving, return to step 2.
•You cannot choose and save the picture from a TV screen even if the camera is connected to a
TV through an HDMI micro cable.
•You can select [Post Focus] in [Playback Mode] or [Slide Show] in the [Playback] menu.
Selecting the desired focus area and saving a picture
Button operation Touch operation Description of operation
3/4/2/1/Touching
Selects a focus area.
•It cannot be selected during
enlarged display.
Enlarges the display.
Reduces the display (during
enlarged display).
[Fn1]
In-focus portions are highlighted
with colour. ([Peaking])
•Switches in order of [OFF]>[ON]
([LOW]) > [ON] ([HIGH]).
[MENU/SET] Saves the picture
Fn1
Fn1

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
134
Select a Drive Mode
Applicable modes:
You can change what the camera will do when you press the shutter button.
1Press 4 ().
2Press 2/1 to select the drive mode, and then
press [MENU/SET].
ADrive mode
3Focus on the subject and take a picture.
∫To cancel the drive mode
Select [ ] ([Single]) or [ ] in step 2.
•You can also cancel the self-timer by turning off the camera. (When [Self Timer Auto Off]
(P225) is set to [ON])
1[Single] When the shutter button is pressed, only one picture is
recorded.
2[Burst] (P135) Recordings are made in succession while the shutter
button is pressed.
3[4K PHOTO] (P118) When the shutter button is pressed, a 4K photo is
recorded.
4[Self Timer] (P137) When the shutter button is pressed, recording takes
place after the set time has elapsed.
H
1234
A

135
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
∫Setting the burst rate
After pressing 3 in step 2 on P134, press 2/1 to select the
burst rate, and press [MENU/SET].
¢1 Number of recordable pictures
¢2 When recording is performed under the test conditions specified by Panasonic.
The burst speed will become slower halfway. However, pictures can be taken until the
capacity of the card becomes full. Depending on recording conditions, the number of burst
pictures that can be taken will be reduced.
•The picture size will be fixed to [S] when [Burst Rate] is set to [SH].
•The burst speed may become slower depending on the following settings.
–[Picture Size] (P192)/[Quality] (P193)/[Sensitivity] (P112)/Focus Mode (P95)/[Focus/Release
Priority] (P212)
∫About the maximum number of pictures that can be taken continuously
When you press the shutter button halfway, the maximum number
of pictures you can take continuously will appear. You can check
the approximate number of pictures that can be taken before the
burst speed slows down.
Example: When 20 pictures can be taken: [r20]
•Once recording starts, the maximum number of pictures that can be taken continuously will
decrease. When [r0] appears, the burst speed will slow down.
•When [r99+] is displayed, you can take 100 or more pictures continuously.
Burst Mode
[SH]
(Super high
speed)
[H]
(High speed)
[M]
(Middle
speed)
[L]
(Low speed)
Burst speed
(pictures/
second)
Mechanical
shutter —8 (AFS)
6 (AFC) 62
Electronic Shutter 40 10 (AFS)
6 (AFC) 62
Live View during Burst Mode None None Available Available
¢1With RAW files — 40 or more¢2
Without RAW files Max. 120 100 or more¢2
SH
H M
LV L
LV
2020r20
0
2
00

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
136
Focusing in Burst Mode
The way focus is achieved varies according to the focus mode (P95) setting and the
[Focus/Release Priority] (P212) setting in the [Custom] menu.
¢1 When the subject is dark or the burst speed is set to [SH], the focus is fixed on the first
picture.
¢2 The burst speed may become slower because the camera is continuously focusing on the
subject.
¢3 Burst speed takes priority, and focus is estimated within possible range.
•Pictures taken with a burst speed of [SH] will be recorded as a single burst group (P184).
•When the burst speed is set to [SH] or [H] (when focus mode is [AFS] or [MF]), the exposure is
fixed at the settings used for the first picture for the subsequent pictures as well.
When the burst speed is set to [H] (when focus mode is [AFF] or [AFC]), [M] or [L], the
exposure is adjusted each time you take a picture.
•It may take time to save pictures taken in Burst Mode on the card. If you take pictures
continuously while saving, the maximum number of recordable pictures decreases. For
continuous shooting, use of a high speed memory card is recommended.
Not available in these cases:
•The Burst Mode is disabled in the following cases.
–[Glistening Water]/[Glittering Illuminations]/[Handheld Night Shot]/[Soft Image of a Flower]
(Scene Guide Mode)
–[Rough Monochrome]/[Silky Monochrome]/[Miniature Effect]/[Soft Focus]/[Star Filter]/
[Sunshine] (Creative Control Mode)
–When recording motion pictures
–When recording using the flash
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When recording with the shutter speed set to [T] (Time)
–When using [Multi Exp.]
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only when [Auto Shooting] is set)
•In the following cases, [SH] in Burst Mode cannot be used.
–When using [Stop Motion Animation]
–When using [Shutter Delay]
Focus mode [Focus/Release
Priority] Focus
[AFS] [FOCUS] At the first picture
[RELEASE]
[AFF]/[AFC]¢1[FOCUS] Normal focusing¢2
[RELEASE] Predicted focusing¢3
[MF] — Focus set with Manual Focus

137
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
∫Setting the self-timer
After pressing 3 in step 2 on P134, press 2/1 to select the
time, and press [MENU/SET].
•After the self-timer indicator flashes, recording starts.
•Focus and exposure will be set when the shutter button is
pressed halfway.
•We recommend using a tripod when recording with the
self-timer.
Not available in these cases:
•It cannot be set to [ ] in the following cases.
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When recording with the shutter speed set to [T] (Time)
–When [Simultaneous record w/o filter] of [Filter Settings] is set to [ON]
–When recording with the Bracket function
–When using [Multi Exp.]
•Self-timer is disabled in the following cases.
–When recording motion pictures
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only when [Auto Shooting] is set)
Self-timer
Picture is taken 10 seconds after shutter is pressed.
After 10 seconds the camera takes 3 pictures at about
2 seconds intervals.
Picture is taken 2 seconds after shutter is pressed.
•When using a tripod, etc., this setting is a convenient
way to avoid the jitter caused by pressing the shutter
button.
10 2
10

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
138
Taking Pictures While Adjusting a Setting
Automatically (Bracket Recording)
Applicable modes:
You can take multiple pictures while automatically adjusting a setting by pressing the
shutter button.
1Select the menu. (P54)
¢Available in Aperture-Priority AE Mode or when the ISO sensitivity is set to [AUTO] in
Manual Exposure Mode.
2Press 3/4 to select [More settings] and then press [MENU/SET].
•For information on [More settings], refer to the page that describes each function.
•Press the shutter button halfway to exit the menu.
3Focus on the subject and take a picture.
•When Exposure Bracket is selected, the bracket display flashes until all of the pictures
you have set are taken. If you change the bracket settings or turn off the camera before
all of the pictures you have set are taken, the camera restarts recording from the first
picture.
∫To cancel [Bracket Type]
Select [OFF] in step 1.
> [Rec] > [Bracket]> [Bracket Type]
(Exposure Bracket) Press the shutter button to perform recording while
adjusting the exposure. (P139)
(Aperture Bracket)¢Press the shutter button to perform recording while
adjusting the aperture. (P140)
(Focus Bracket) Press the shutter button to perform recording while
adjusting the focus position. (P140)
(White Balance Bracket)
Press the shutter button once to take three pictures
with different white balance settings automatically.
(P117)
MENU

139
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
Not available in these cases:
•Bracket recording is disabled in the following cases.
–[Glistening Water]/[Glittering Illuminations]/[Handheld Night Shot]/[Soft Image of a Flower]
(Scene Guide Mode)
–[Rough Monochrome]/[Silky Monochrome]/[Miniature Effect]/[Soft Focus]/[Star Filter]/
[Sunshine] (Creative Control Mode)
–When recording using the flash (except for White Balance Bracket)
–When recording motion pictures
–When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH]
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When recording with the shutter speed set to [T] (Time)
–When using [Multi Exp.]
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only when [Auto Shooting] is set)
∫About [More settings] (step 2 in P138)
¢Not available for burst recording. When using burst recording, if you press and hold the
shutter button, recording will be performed continuously until a specified number of pictures
are taken.
[Step]: [3•1/3], [Sequence]: [0/s/r]
•When taking pictures using Exposure Bracket after setting the Exposure Compensation value,
the pictures taken are based on the selected Exposure Compensation value.
Exposure Bracket
[Step]
Sets the number of pictures to be taken and the exposure
compensation range.
[3•1/3] (Takes three pictures with an interval of 1/3 EV) to [7•1]
(Takes seven pictures with an interval of 1 EV)
[Sequence] Sets the order in which pictures are taken.
[Single Shot Setting]¢
[ ]: Takes one picture each time you press the shutter button.
[ ]: Takes all the pictures set to be taken when you press the
shutter button once.
1st picture 2nd picture 3rd picture
d0EV j1/3 EV i1/3 EV

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
140
Recording Mode:
∫About [More settings] (step 2 in P138)
•When using burst recording, if you press and hold the shutter button, recording will be
performed until a specified number of pictures are taken.
The available aperture values vary depending on the lens.
Example: when using the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032)
When the initial position is set to F8.0:
1 first picture, 2 second picture, 3 third picture... 7 seventh picture
∫About [More settings] (step 2 in P138)
¢Not available for burst recording. When using burst recording, if you press and hold the
shutter button, recording will be performed continuously until a specified number of pictures
are taken.
Takes pictures with different focus positions within the range based on the initial focus
position.
AClose-up
BInfinity
1 first picture, 2 second picture... 5 fifth picture...
•Pictures taken with Focus Bracket are displayed as a set of group pictures. (P184)
Aperture Bracket
[Image Count]
[3], [5]: Takes a specified number of pictures with different
aperture values within the range based on the initial aperture
value.
[ALL]: Takes pictures using all aperture values.
Focus Bracket
[Step] Sets the interval between focus positions.
[Image Count]¢Sets the number of pictures to be taken.
4.0 5.6 8.0 11 16 22
・・・ ・・・

141
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
Taking Pictures Automatically at Set Intervals
([Time Lapse Shot])
Applicable modes:
The camera can automatically take pictures of subjects such as animals or plants as time
elapses and create a motion picture.
•Set the date and time settings in advance. (P35)
•Pictures taken with Time Lapse Shot are displayed as a set of group pictures. (P184)
1Select the menu. (P54)
•Recording may not be consistent with the set recording interval or the set number of
pictures depending on recording conditions.
2Press 3/4 to select [Start] and then press [MENU/SET].
3Press the shutter button fully.
•The recording starts automatically.
•During recording standby, the power will turn off automatically if no operation is performed
for a certain period. The Time Lapse Shot is continued even with the power turned off.
When the recording start time arrives, the power turns on automatically.
To turn on the power manually, press the shutter button halfway.
•Operations during recording standby (The camera is turned on)
> [Rec] > [Time Lapse Shot]
[Start Time]
[Now] Starts the recording by fully-pressing the shutter button.
[Start Time
Set]
Any time up to 23 hours 59 minutes ahead can be set.
Select the item (hour or minute) by pressing
2
/
1
,
set the start time by pressing
3
/
4
, and then
press [MENU/SET].
[Shooting
Interval]/
[Image Count]
The recording interval and the number of pictures can be set.
2/1: Select the item (minute/second/number of pictures)
3/4: Setting
[MENU/SET]: Set
Button
operation
Touch
operation Description of operation
[Fn3]
Displays a selection screen that lets you pause or stop
the recording
Displays a selection screen that lets you resume or
stop the recording (during pause)
MENU

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
142
4Select the methods for creating a motion picture.
•The recording format is set to [MP4].
5Select [OK] with 3/4, and then press [MENU/SET].
•Motion pictures can also be created from [Time Lapse Video] in the [Playback] menu.
(P243)
•This function is not for use in a security camera.
•[Time Lapse Shot] is paused in the following cases.
–When the charge on the battery runs out
–Turning the camera off
During [Time Lapse Shot], you can replace the battery and the card, and then restart by turning
on this unit. (Note that pictures taken after the restart will be saved as a separate set of group
pictures) Turn off this unit when replacing the battery or the card.
•When creating motion pictures with a [Rec Quality] setting of [4K/25p] or [4K/24p], recording
times are limited to 29 minutes and 59 seconds.
–When using an SDHC Memory Card, you cannot create motion pictures with a file size
exceeding 4 GB.
–When using an SDXC Memory Card, you can create motion pictures with a file size
exceeding 4 GB.
•A motion picture with a [Rec Quality] setting of [FHD/50p], [FHD/25p], [HD/25p], or [VGA/25p]
cannot be created if the recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds or the file size
exceeds 4 GB.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
–When [Simultaneous record w/o filter] of [Filter Settings] is set to [ON]
–When using [Multi Exp.]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation]
[Rec Quality] Sets the quality of a motion picture.
[Frame Rate] Sets the number of frames per second.
The larger the number is, the smoother the motion picture will be.
[Sequence]
[NORMAL]:
Splices pictures together in recording order.
[REVERSE]:
Splices pictures together in reverse recording order.

143
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
Creating Stop Motion Pictures ([Stop Motion
Animation])
Applicable modes:
A stop motion picture is created by splicing pictures together.
•Set the date and time settings in advance. (P35)
•Pictures taken with [Stop Motion Animation] are displayed as a set of group pictures. (P184)
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Press 3/4 to select [Start] and then press [MENU/SET].
3Press 3
/
4 to select [New] and then press [MENU/SET].
4Press the shutter button fully.
•Up to 9999 frames can be recorded.
5Move the subject to decide on the composition.
•Repeat recording in the same way.
•If this unit is turned off while recording, a message for
resuming the recording is displayed when the camera is
turned on. Selecting [Yes] allows you to continue the
recording from the interruption point.
> [Rec] > [Stop Motion Animation]
[Auto Shooting] [ON] Takes pictures automatically at a set recording interval.
[OFF] This is for taking pictures manually, frame by frame.
[Shooting Interval]
(Only when [Auto Shooting] is set to [ON])
Press 2/1 to select the recording interval (seconds),
press 3/4 to set it, and press [MENU/SET].
Recording materials skilfully
•The recording screen displays up to two pictures taken previously. Use them as
reference for the amount of movement.
•Pressing [(] allows you to check recorded pictures.
Unnecessary pictures can be deleted by pressing [ ].
Pressing [(] again will return you to the recording screen.
MENU

5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
144
6Touch [ ] to end the recording.
•It can also be ended by selecting [Stop Motion Animation]
from the [Rec] menu and then pressing [MENU/SET].
•When [Auto Shooting] is set to [ON], select [End] on the
confirmation screen.
(If [Pause] has been selected, press the shutter button
fully to resume the recording.)
7Select the methods for creating a motion picture.
•The recording format is set to [MP4].
8Press 3/4 to select [OK] and then press [MENU/SET].
•Motion pictures can also be created from [Stop Motion Video] in the [Playback] menu.
(P243)
∫Adding pictures to the Stop Motion Animation group
Selecting [Additional] in step 3 will display group pictures recorded with [Stop Motion
Animation].
Select a set of group pictures, and then press [MENU/SET].
[Rec Quality] Sets the quality of a motion picture.
[Frame Rate] Sets the number of frames per second.
The larger the number is, the smoother the motion picture will be.
[Sequence]
[NORMAL]:
Splices pictures together in recording order.
[REVERSE]:
Splices pictures together in reverse recording order.
30

145
5. 4K Photo and Drive Settings
•Automatic recording may not take place at set intervals because recording takes time under
certain recording conditions, such as when the flash is used for recording.
•When creating motion pictures with a [Rec Quality] setting of [4K/25p] or [4K/24p], recording
times are limited to 29 minutes and 59 seconds.
–When using an SDHC Memory Card, you cannot create motion pictures with a file size
exceeding 4 GB.
–When using an SDXC Memory Card, you can create motion pictures with a file size
exceeding 4 GB.
•A motion picture with a [Rec Quality] setting of [FHD/50p], [FHD/25p], [HD/25p], or [VGA/25p]
cannot be created if the recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds or the file size
exceeds 4 GB.
•A picture cannot be selected from [Additional] when it is the only one that was taken.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When [Simultaneous record w/o filter] of [Filter Settings] is set to [ON]
–When using [Multi Exp.]
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
•[Auto Shooting] in [Stop Motion Animation] is not available for the following functions:
–[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)

146
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Image Stabiliser
The camera can activate either the In-Lens Image Stabiliser or In-Body Image Stabiliser, or
it can activate both of them and reduce jitter even more effectively. (Dual I.S.)
For motion picture recording, you can use the 5-Axis Hybrid Image Stabiliser, which makes
use of the In-Lens Image Stabiliser, In-Body Image Stabiliser, and Electronic Image
Stabiliser.
•The image stabilisers to be activated differ depending on your lens. The icon for the currently
activated image stabiliser is displayed on the recording screen.
¢When [E-Stabilization (Video)] is set to [ON]
When taking pictures When recording
motion pictures
Panasonic lenses compatible with Dual I.S.
(Based on the Micro Four Thirds System
standard)
•For the latest information on compatible
lenses, please refer to our website. (P17)
•If [ ], [ ] or [ ] is not displayed even
when a compatible lens is used, update the
lens firmware to the latest version. (P17)
Lens + Body
(Dual I.S.) ( / )
Lens + Body
(Dual I.S.) ( ),
5-Axis Hybrid
()
¢
Lenses compatible with the image
stabiliser function
(Based on the Micro Four Thirds System
standard/Four Thirds System standard)
Lens or Body
(/)
Lens or Body
(),
5-Axis Hybrid
()
¢
Lenses not compatible with the image
stabiliser function
(Based on the Micro Four Thirds System
standard/Four Thirds System standard) Body ( / )
Body ( ),
5-Axis Hybrid
()
¢
When using a Leica lens mount adaptor
(optional) or mount adaptor made by
another manufacturer

147
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
•When using an interchangeable lens with O.I.S. switch (such as H-FS14140), stabiliser
function is activated if the O.I.S. switch of the lens is set to [ON]. ([ ] is set at the time of
purchase)
Select the menu. (P54)
Preventing jitter (camera shake)
When the jitter alert [ ] appears, use [Stabilizer], a tripod or the self-timer (P137).
•Shutter speed will be slower particularly in the following cases. Keep the camera still from the
moment the shutter button is pressed until the picture appears on the screen.
We recommend using a tripod.
–Slow Sync. –Slow Sync./Red-Eye Reduction
–[Clear Nightscape]/[Cool Night Sky]/[Warm Glowing Nightscape]/[Artistic Nightscape]/
[Glittering Illuminations]/[Clear Night Portrait] (Scene Guide Mode)
–When you set to a slow shutter speed
Applicable modes:
> [Rec] > [Stabilizer]
[Operation
Mode]
[]
([Normal])
Camera shake is corrected for up/down,
left/right, and rotational movements.
[]
([Panning])
Camera shake is corrected for up/down
movements.
This mode is ideal for panning (a method
of taking pictures which involves turning
the camera to track the movements of a
subject which continues to move in a fixed direction).
[OFF]
[Stabilizer] does not work. ([ ])
•When using a lens with an O.I.S. switch, set the switch to
[OFF].
[E-Stabilization
(Video)]
Jitter during motion picture recording is corrected along the vertical,
horizontal, roll, pitch, and yaw axes by making use of the In-Lens Image
Stabiliser, In-Body Image Stabiliser, and Electronic Image Stabiliser. (5-Axis
Hybrid Image Stabiliser)
[ON]/[OFF]
•When [ON] is selected, the angle of view of recorded motion pictures may
become narrower.
[Focal Length
Set]
If the focal length is not set automatically, you can set it manually. (P148)
•When a manually selected focal length is set, a confirmation screen asking
you to change the focal length setting is displayed after you turn on the
camera. Selecting [Yes] allows you to set [Focal Length Set] in [Stabilizer].
MENU

6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
148
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Select the focal length of your lens with 2
/
1.
•A focal length ranging from 8 mm to 1000 mm can be set.
•If the focal length setting for your lens is not found, select a
value close to the focal length of your lens.
3Press [MENU/SET].
∫Registering a focal length
1Perform step 2 in “Setting the focal length of a lens”.
2
Press
4
.
3Press 2
/
1 to select the focal length to be
overwritten and then press [DISP.].
•Up to 3 focal length settings can be registered.
∫Setting a registered focal length
1On the screen in step 2 of “Setting the focal length of a lens”, press 4.
2Press 2
/
1 to select the registered focal lengthand then press [MENU/SET].
Setting the focal length of a lens
>[Rec] > [Stabilizer] > [Focal Length Set]
MENU

149
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
•The Image Stabiliser may produce operational sound or cause vibration during its
operation, but these are not malfunctions.
•It is recommended to disable the Image Stabiliser when using a tripod.
•The stabiliser function may not be effective in the following cases.
Be careful of camera jitter when you press the shutter button.
–When there is a lot of jitter
–When the zoom magnification is high
–When using the Digital Zoom
–When taking pictures while following a moving subject
–When the shutter speed becomes slower to take pictures indoors or in dark places
•The panning effect in [ ] is more difficult to achieve in the following cases.
–In brightly lit places such as in broad daylight on a summer’s day
–When the shutter speed is faster than 1/100th of a second
–When you move the camera too slowly because the subject is moving slowly (The
background will not become a blur)
–When the camera does not keep up with the subject satisfactorily
Not available in these cases:
•[ ] is not available in Panorama Shot Mode.
•In the following cases, the [Stabilizer] will switch to [ ] (Normal), even if it is set to [ ]
(Panning):
–During motion picture recording
–When 4K Photo function has been set
–When recording using [Post Focus]
•The 5-Axis Hybrid Image Stabiliser function is not available in the following cases:
–When the MP4 motion picture size is set to [VGA] in [Rec Quality]
–When using the Digital Zoom

6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
150
Taking Pictures with the Zoom
Applicable modes:
You can zoom-in to make people and objects appear closer or zoom-out to record
landscapes, etc.
Optical zoom
T side: Enlarges distant subject
W side: Widens angle of view
Interchangeable lens
with a zoom ring
(H-FS12032/
H-FS35100/
H-FS14140)
Rotate the zoom ring.
Interchangeable lens
that supports the
power zoom
(electrically operated
zoom)
Move the zoom lever.
(The zoom speed varies depending on
how far you move the lever.)
•If you assign [Zoom Control] to a function
button, you can operate the optical zoom
slowly by pressing 2/1 or fast by
pressing 3/4.
For information on how to operate, refer to step 2 and the
subsequent steps on P152.
Interchangeable lens
that does not support
the zoom (H-H020A)
The optical zoom is not available.
T
W
T
W

151
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Applicable modes:
Extra Tele Conversion enables you to take pictures that are further enlarged without
deteriorating the picture quality.
•Set the picture size to [M]or [S] (picture sizes indicated with ), and set the quality to
[A] or [›].
Raising the telescopic effect
[Ex. Tele Conv.]
When taking pictures [Ex. Tele Conv.]
([Rec])
1.2k: [ M] ([16:9])
1.4k: [ M] ([4:3]/[3:2]/[1:1])
2.0k: [ S] ([4:3]/[3:2]/[16:9]/[1:1])
When recording motion
pictures
[Ex. Tele Conv.]
([Motion Picture])
2.4k (motion pictures size is set to
[FHD] in [Rec Quality])
3.6k (motion pictures size is set to
[HD] in [Rec Quality])
4.8k (motion pictures size is set to
[VGA] in [Rec Quality])

6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
152
∫Increasing the zoom magnification in steps
•This can be used only when recording pictures.
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Set a function button to [Zoom Control]. (P58)
3Press the function button.
4Press 2/1 or 3/4.
•The zoom operation is terminated when the function button is pressed again or a certain
amount of time passes.
AOptical Zoom range (Focal length)¢
BExtra Tele Conversion range for still picture recording
(Zoom magnification)
¢This zoom slider is displayed when using an
interchangeable lens that supports the power zoom.
•A constant zoom speed will be set.
•The indicated zoom magnification is an approximation.
∫Fixing the zoom magnification at the maximum level
Select the menu. (P54)
> [Rec] > [Ex. Tele Conv.] > [ZOOM]
3/1:Tele (Enlarges distant subject)
4/2:Wide (Widens angle of view)
> [Rec] > [Ex. Tele Conv.] > [TELE CONV.]
> [Motion Picture] > [Ex. Tele Conv.] > [ON]
[OFF] [TELE CONV.]/[ON]
MENU
EX1.0x EX2.0x
4:3 4:3
BA
MENU
MENU
4:3 4:3

153
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
•If you assign [Ex. Tele Conv.] to [Fn Button Set] (P58) in the [Custom] menu, you can display
the Extra Tele Conversion setting screen for both pictures and motion pictures by pressing the
assigned function button. While this screen is displayed, you can change the [Picture Size]
setting by pressing [DISP.].
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
–[Toy Effect]/[Toy Pop] (Creative Control Mode)
–When [Quality] is set to [ ], [ ] or [ ]
–When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH]
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When [HDR] is set to [ON]
–When using [Multi Exp.]
–When the MP4 motion picture size is set to [4K] in [Rec Quality]
–When [4K Live Cropping] is set
–When the image of the camera is output through the HDMI connection (except for Creative
Video Mode)
Applicable modes:
Although the image quality deteriorates every time you zoom in further, you can zoom in
up to four times the original zoom magnification.
(Continuous zooming is not possible.)
•When using the Digital Zoom, we recommend using a tripod and the self-timer (P137) for taking
pictures.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–[Toy Effect]/[Toy Pop]/[Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode)
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When using [Multi Exp.]
[Digital Zoom]
> [Rec] > [Digital Zoom] > [4t]/[2t]
MENU

6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
154
Applicable modes:
Sets the screen display and lens operations when using an interchangeable lens that is
compatible with power zoom (electrically operated zoom).
•This may only be selected when using a lens that is compatible with power zoom (electrically
operated zoom).
Changing the settings for a power zoom lens
> [Custom] > [Power Zoom Lens]
[Disp Focal
Length]
When you zoom, the focal distance is
displayed and you can confirm the zoom
position.
AFocal distance indication
BCurrent focal distance
[Step Zoom]
When you operate the zoom with this setting
[ON], the zoom will stop at positions
corresponding to predetermined distances.
CStep zoom indication
•This setting does not work when recording
motion pictures or 4K photos with [ ] ([4K
Pre-Burst]).
[Zoom Resume] When you turn this unit on, the zoom positions when you last turned this unit
off are automatically restored.
[Zoom Speed]
You can set the zoom speed for zoom operations.
•If you set [Step Zoom] to [ON], the zoom speed will not change.
[Photo]:
[H] (High speed)/[M] (Middle speed)/[L] (Low speed)
[Video]:
[H] (High speed)/[M] (Middle speed)/[L] (Low speed)
[Zoom Ring]
This may only be selected when a power zoom-compatible lens with a zoom
lever and zoom ring is attached.
When set to [OFF], the operations controlled by the zoom ring are disabled
to prevent accidental operation.
MENU
AB
C

155
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
(Optical Zoom and Extra Tele Conversion for still picture recording are operable)
•If you are using an interchangeable lens not supporting power zoom (H-FS12032/H-FS35100/
H-H020A/H-FS14140), you can only operate Extra Tele Conversion for pictures by setting [Ex.
Te le C onv.] (P151) to [ZOOM].
1Touch [ ] .
2Touch [ ] .
•The slide bar is displayed.
3Perform zoom operations by dragging the
slide bar.
•The zoom speed varies depending on the touched
position.
•Touch [ ] again to end touch zoom operations.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When recording 4K photos
Zooming using touch operations (Touch zoom)
[ ]/[ ] Zooms slowly
[ ]/[ ] Zooms quickly
AE

6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
156
Taking pictures by using the flash
Applicable modes:
∫Open/Close the built-in flash
Taking a picture using the flash becomes
possible by opening the built-in flash.
ATo open the flash
Press the flash open button.
BTo close the flash
Press the flash until it clicks.
•Forcibly closing the flash can damage the
camera.
•Be sure to close the built-in flash when not in
use.
•The flash setting is fixed to [Œ] while the
flash is closed.
•Be careful when opening the flash as the flash will jump out.
•Be careful not to catch a finger when closing the flash bulb.
In the following cases, the flash is fixed to [Œ] (forced flash off).
•When recording motion pictures
•When recording 4K photos
•When recording with [Post Focus]
•When using the electronic shutter
•When [HDR] is set to [ON]
•When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON]
•When an image effect in [Filter Effect] of [Filter Settings] is set
Using the flash skilfully
•When taking pictures with flash with the lens hood attached, the lower portion of the photo
may turn dark and the control of the flash may be disabled because the photo flash may be
obscured by the lens hood. We recommend detaching the lens hood.

157
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
∫The available flash range (approximation)
When you use certain lenses, light from the flash may be
blocked or fail to cover the lens field of view, causing dark
areas to appear in the resulting pictures.
The distance at which light from the flash is blocked by lens, and
the distance to which light from the flash is delivered vary
depending on the lens used. Check the distance to the subject
when taking a picture.
•These are the ranges when the ISO sensitivity is set to [AUTO] and [ISO Limit Set] (P201) is
set to [OFF].
•Do not bring the flash too close to objects or close the flash while it is activated. The objects
may be discoloured by its heat or lighting.
•Do not close the flash soon after the flash is activated prior to taking pictures due to Forced ON/
Red-Eye Reduction etc. It causes a malfunction.
•It may take time to charge the flash if you repeatedly take pictures. You must wait a moment to
take the next picture while the flash icon is blinking red indicating the flash is charging.
•When you attach an external flash, it takes priority over the built-in flash. Refer to P307 for the
external flash.
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032) is used
Wide Te le
0.4 m (1.3 feet) to 4.8 m (16 feet) 0.3 m (0.98 feet) to 3.0 m (9.8 feet)
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS35100) is used
Wide Te le
0.9 m (3.0 feet) to 4.2 m (14 feet) 0.9 m (3.0 feet) to 3.0 m (9.8 feet)
When the interchangeable lens (H-H020A) is used
0.5 m (1.6 feet) to 9.8 m (32 feet)
When the interchangeable lens (H-FS14140) is used
(When the aspect ratio is [4:3].)
Wide to 34 mm 35 mm Tele
Vignetting effect occurs due to
the light of the flash.
1.0 m (3.3 feet) to 3.7 m
(12 feet)
0.5 m (1.6 feet) to 3.0 m
(9.8 feet)

6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
158
Setting the Flash Functions
Applicable modes:
Select whether to set the flash output automatically or manually.
1Select the menu. (P54)
2(When [MANUAL] is selected)
Select the menu.
3Press 2/1 to select an item and then press [MENU/SET].
•You can set from [1/1] (full brightness) to [1/128] in steps of [1/3].
•This item is not available when an built-in flash is being used.
Changing the firing mode
>[Rec] > [Flash] > [Firing Mode]
[TTL] The camera automatically sets the flash output.
[MANUAL]
Set the luminosity ratio of the flash manually. In [TTL] you can shoot the
photograph you want even when shooting dark scenes that may
otherwise be too brightly lit by the flash.
•When [MANUAL] is set, the luminosity ratio ([1/1], etc.) is displayed on
the flash icon on the screen.
>[Rec] > [Flash] > [Manual Flash Adjust.]
MENU
MENU

159
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Applicable modes:
Set the flash to match the recording.
Select the menu. (P54)
¢It can be set only when [Wireless] in [Flash] is set to [OFF] and [Firing Mode] is set to [TTL].
•Some flash modes may not be available depending on the external flash’s settings.
The flash is activated twice.
The interval between the first and second flash is longer when [ ] or [ ] is
set. The subject should not move until the second flash is activated.
•The Red-Eye Reduction effect differs between people. Also, if the subject was far away from
the camera or was not looking at the first flash, the effect may not be evident.
Changing Flash Mode
>[Rec] > [Flash] > [Flash Mode]
‰([Forced Flash On])
([Forced On/
Red-Eye])¢
The flash is activated every time regardless
of the recording conditions.
•Use this when your subject is back-lit
or under fluorescent light.
([Slow Sync.])
([Slow Sync./
Red-Eye])¢
When taking pictures against a dark
background landscape, this feature will
slow the shutter speed when the flash is
activated. Dark background landscape will
appear brighter.
•Use this when you take pictures of
people in front of a dark background.
•Using a slower speed can cause motion blur. Using a tripod
can enhance your photos.
Œ([Forced Flash Off])
The flash is not activated in any recording conditions.
•Use this when you take pictures in places where the use of
flash is not permitted.
•This item is available only when using an external flash.
MENU

6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
160
∫Available flash settings by Recording Mode
The available flash settings depend on the Recording Mode.
(±: Available, —: Not available, ¥: Initial setting of Scene Guide Mode)
•In Intelligent Auto Mode ( or ), the flash will be set to [ ] or [Œ]. (P64)
•The Scene Guide Mode flash setting is returned to the initial value with each change of scene.
Recording Mode ‰ Œ
Programme AE Mode
Aperture-Priority AE Mode ±±±±±
Shutter-Priority AE Mode
Manual Exposure Mode ±±—— ±
Scene Guide
Mode
[Clear Portrait] ±¥—— ±
[Silky Skin] ±¥—— ±
[Backlit Softness] ————¥
[Clear in Backlight] ¥———±
[Relaxing Tone] ————¥
[Sweet Child's Face] ±¥—— ±
[Distinct Scenery] ————¥
[Bright Blue Sky] ————¥
[Romantic Sunset Glow] ————¥
[Vivid Sunset Glow] ————¥
[Glistening Water] ————¥
[Clear Nightscape] ————¥
[Cool Night Sky] ———— ¥
[Warm Glowing Nightscape] ————¥
[Artistic Nightscape] ————¥
[Glittering Illuminations] ————¥
[Handheld Night Shot] ————¥
[Clear Night Portrait] ———¥±
[Soft Image of a Flower] ¥———±
[Appetizing Food] ¥———±
[Cute Dessert] ¥———±
[Freeze Animal Motion] ¥———±
[Clear Sports Shot] ¥———±
[Monochrome] ¥±±±±

161
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
∫Shutter speed for each flash setting
¢
This becomes 60 seconds in Shutter-Priority AE Mode and T (Time) in the Manual Exposure
Mode.
•When the flash is activated the fastest shutter speed that can be selected is 1/160th of a
second.
•In Intelligent Auto ( or ) Mode, shutter speed changes depending on the identified
scene.
Applicable modes:
2nd curtain synchro activates the flash just before the shutter closes when taking pictures
of moving objects such as cars using a slow shutter speed.
Select the menu. (P54)
•[2nd] is displayed in the flash icon on the screen if you set [Flash Synchro] to [2ND].
•Only available when [Wireless] in [Flash] is set to [OFF]. (P164)
•The [Flash Synchro] settings also apply to an external flash. (P307)
•When a fast shutter speed is set, the effect of [Flash Synchro] may deteriorate.
•You cannot set [ ] or [ ] when [Flash Synchro] is set to [2ND].
Flash setting Shutter speed (Sec.) Flash setting Shutter speed (Sec.)
‰1/60th¢ to 1/160th 1 to 1/4000th
Setting to the 2nd Curtain Synchro
>[Rec] > [Flash] > [Flash Synchro]
[1ST]
1st curtain synchro
The normal method when taking pictures with the flash.
[2ND]
2nd curtain synchro
The light source appears behind the subject and picture
becomes dynamic.
MENU

6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
162
Applicable modes:
Adjust the flash brightness when pictures taken with the flash are over or underexposed.
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Press 2/1 to set the flash output and then press [MENU/SET].
•You can adjust from [j3 EV] to [i3 EV] in steps of 1/3 EV.
•Select [n0] to return to the original flash output.
•[i] or [j] is displayed on the flash icon in the screen when the flash level is adjusted.
•It can be set only when [Wireless] in [Flash] is set to [OFF] and [Firing Mode] is set to [TTL].
(P158, 164)
•The [Flash Adjust.] setting also applies to an external flash. (P307)
Applicable modes:
Select the menu. (P54)
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]
•For details on Exposure Compensation, refer to P110.
•The [Auto Exposure Comp.] setting also applies to an external flash. (P307)
Adjust the flash output
>[Rec] > [Flash] > [Flash Adjust.]
Synchronising the output of the flash to the Exposure Compensation
>[Rec] > [Flash] > [Auto Exposure Comp.]
MENU
MENU

163
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
Taking Pictures with Wireless Flashes
By using flashes that support the wireless control (DMW-FL200L, DMW-FL360L,
DMW-FL580L: optional), you can control firing of the flash attached to the hot shoe of this
unit and three flash groups separately.
•When an built-in flash is being used, you cannot control the firing of wireless flashes.
Preparations:
Attach the flash (DMW-FL200L/DMW-FL360L/DMW-FL580L: optional) to the camera.
1Set the wireless flashes to RC Mode and then place them.
•Set a channel and groups for the wireless flash.
Applicable modes:
∫Placing wireless flashes
Place the wireless flash with its wireless sensor facing toward the camera.
The following figure shows the estimated controllable range when you take pictures by
holding the camera horizontally. Controllable range differs depending on the surrounding
environment.
Placement range [when a flash
(DMW-FL360L: optional) is attached] Placement example
•In this placement example, flash C is placed to erase the shadow of the subject that flashes A
and B will create.
•The recommended number of wireless flashes for each group is three or less.
•If the subject is too close, signal flashing may affect the exposure.
If you set [Communication Light] to [LOW] or lower the output with a diffuser or similar product,
the effect will be reduced.
5m
5m 7m
7m(23 feet)
(23 feet)
(16 feet)
(16 feet)
50°50°
50°50°
30°30°
30°30°
A
B
C

6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
164
2Select the menu. (P54)
3Press 3/4 to select an item and then press [MENU/SET].
•Press [DISP.] to fire a test-flash.
AFiring Mode
BFlash output
CLuminosity ratio
¢1 Not available when [Wireless FP] is set to [ON].
¢2 This option is not displayed when the flash (DMW-FL200L: optional) is attached to the
camera.
>[Rec] > [Flash]
[Wireless] Select [ON].
[Wireless Channel] Select the channel you have set for the wireless flashes in
step 1.
[Wireless Setup] Proceed to step 3.
[External
Flash]¢1
[Firing Mode]
[TTL]: The camera automatically sets the output.
[AUTO]¢2:Flash output is set by the external flash.
[MANUAL]: Set the luminosity ratio of the external flash manually.
[OFF]: The flash on the camera side emits only communication light.
[Flash Adjust.]
Set the flash output of the camera manually when [Firing Mode] is set to [TTL].
[Manual Flash Adjust.]
Set the luminosity ratio of the external flash when [Firing Mode] is set to
[MANUAL].
•You can set from [1/1] (full brightness) to [1/128] in steps of 1/3.
[A Group]/
[B Group]/
[C Group]
[Firing Mode]
[TTL]: The camera automatically sets the output.
[AUTO]¢1:The wireless flashes automatically set the output.
[MANUAL]: Set the luminosity ratio of the wireless flashes manually.
[OFF]: The wireless flashes of the specified group will not fire.
[Flash Adjust.]
Adjust the output of the wireless flashes manually when [Firing Mode] is set to
[TTL].
[Manual Flash Adjust.]
Set the luminosity ratio of the wireless flashes when [Firing Mode] is set to
[MANUAL].
•You can set from [1/1] (full brightness) to [1/128] in steps of 1/3.
MENU
B
C
A

165
6. Stabiliser, Zoom and Flash
During wireless recording, an external flash fires an FP flash (high speed repetition of flash
firing). This firing allows recording with the flash at a fast shutter speed.
Select the menu. (P54)
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]
Select the menu. (P54)
Settings: [HIGH]/[STANDARD]/[LOW]
Using other settings for wireless flash recording
Enabling FP firing for the wireless flashes
>[Rec] > [Flash] > [Wireless FP]
Setting the output of communication light
>[Rec] > [Flash] > [Communication Light]
MENU
MENU

166
7. Recording Motion Pictures
Recording Motion Picture/4K Motion Picture
Applicable modes:
This camera can record full high definition motion pictures compatible with the AVCHD
format or motion pictures recorded in MP4.
In addition, the camera can record 4K motion pictures in MP4. (P168)
Audio will be recorded in stereo.
1Start recording by pressing the motion
picture button.
A Elapsed recording time
B Available recording time
•Recording of motion picture appropriate for each mode is
possible.
•The recording state indicator (red) C will flash while
recording motion pictures.
•Release the motion picture button right after you press it.
•m: minute, s: second
2Stop the recording by pressing the motion
picture button again.
About the operation sound that is produced when you stop recording
If the operation sound of the motion picture button pressed to end recording bothers
you, try the following:
– Record the motion picture about three seconds longer, and then divide the last part
of the motion picture using [Video Divide] (P242) in the [Playback] menu.
3
s
3
s
3
s
R1m
37
37s
R1m37s
C
B
A

167
7. Recording Motion Pictures
•When the ambient temperature is high or motion picture is recorded continuously, the camera
may display [ ] and stop the recording to protect itself. Wait until the camera cools down.
•The operational sound of the zoom or button operation may be recorded when it is operated
during the recording of a motion picture.
•Depending on the type of the card, the card access indication may appear for a while after
recording motion pictures. This is not a malfunction.
•When the aspect ratio setting is different in still and motion pictures, the angle of view changes
at the start of motion picture recording.
When [Rec Area] is set to [ ], angle of view during motion picture recording is displayed.
•The [Sensitivity] will be set to [AUTO] (for motion pictures) when recording motion pictures.
•The functions available when recording motion pictures differ according to the lens you are
using, and the operational sound of the lens may be recorded.
•It will be recorded in the following categories for certain Recording Modes.
Not available in these cases:
•Motion pictures cannot be recorded in the following cases.
–[Glistening Water]/[Glittering Illuminations]/[Soft Image of a Flower] (Scene Guide Mode)
–[Rough Monochrome]/[Silky Monochrome]/[Miniature Effect]¢/[Soft Focus]/[Star Filter]/
[Sunshine] (Creative Control Mode)
¢When recording motion pictures with [Rec Quality] of [4K]
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation]
Selected Recording Mode Recording Mode while
recording motion picture
–[Clear in Backlight] (Scene Guide Mode) Portrait Mode
–[Clear Nightscape]/[Artistic Nightscape]/[Handheld Night
Shot]/[Clear Night Portrait] (Scene Guide Mode) Low Light Mode

7. Recording Motion Pictures
168
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Press 3/4 to select [Rec Quality] and then press [MENU/SET].
When [AVCHD] is selected
¢1 AVCHD Progressive
When [MP4] is selected
¢2 4K motion picture
Setting the format, size and recording frame rate
> [Motion Picture] > [Rec Format]
[AVCHD] This data format is suitable for when playing back on a high-definition
TV, etc.
[MP4] This data format is suitable for when playing back on a PC, etc.
Item Size Recording frame rate Sensor output Bit rate
[FHD/28M/50p]¢11920k1080 50p 50 frames/second 28 Mbps
[FHD/17M/50i] 1920k1080 50i 50 frames/second 17 Mbps
[FHD/24M/25p] 1920k1080 50i 25 frames/second 24 Mbps
[FHD/24M/24p] 1920k1080 24p 24 frames/second 24 Mbps
Item Size Recording frame rate Sensor output Bit rate
[4K/100M/25p]¢23840k2160 25p 25 frames/second 100 Mbps
[4K/100M/24p]¢23840k2160 24p 24 frames/second 100 Mbps
[FHD/28M/50p] 1920k1080 50p 50 frames/second 28 Mbps
[FHD/20M/25p] 1920k1080
25p 25 frames/second
20 Mbps
[HD/10M/25p] 1280k720 10 Mbps
[VGA/4M/25p] 640k480 4 Mbps
MENU

169
7. Recording Motion Pictures
• The higher the “Bit rate” value is, the higher the picture quality becomes. Since the
camera employs the “VBR” recording method, the bit rate is changed automatically
depending on the subject to record. As a result, the recording time is shortened when a
fast-moving subject is recorded.
•When recording motion pictures in 4K, use a card rated as UHS Speed Class 3. (P28)
•The angle of view of motion pictures in 4K is narrower than those of motion pictures in other
sizes.
•To ensure highly accurate focus, 4K motion pictures are recorded at reduced Auto Focus
speeds. It may be difficult to focus on the subject with Auto Focus, but this is not a malfunction.
∫About the compatibility of the recorded motion pictures
Even when a compatible device is used, recorded motion pictures may be played back
with reduced picture and sound quality, or they may not be played back.
Also, recording information may not be displayed correctly. Use this unit to playback in
such case.
•To play back motion pictures recorded with [FHD/28M/50p], [FHD/24M/25p] or [FHD/24M/24p]
in [AVCHD] with another device, or to transfer them to another device, you need a compatible
Blu-ray disc recorder or a PC on which the software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (P296) is installed.
•For motion pictures recorded with [MP4] set to [4K/100M/25p] or [4K/100M/24p], refer to
“Watching 4K motion pictures on a TV/ Saving 4K motion pictures on your PC or recorder” on
P290.

7. Recording Motion Pictures
170
Applicable modes:
Focusing changes depending on the Focus Mode setting (P95) and the [Continuous AF]
setting in the [Motion Picture] menu.
•The interchangeable lens (H-H020A) utilises a lens drive system to realize a compact and
bright F1.7 lens. As a result, sound and vibration may occur during focus operation, but this is
not a malfunction.
•When the focus mode is set to [AFS], [AFF] or [AFC], if you press the shutter button halfway
while recording a motion picture, the camera will re-adjust the focus.
•Depending on the recording conditions or lens used, operational sound may be recorded when
the Auto Focus is operated while recording a motion picture.
It is recommended to record with [Continuous AF] in the [Motion Picture] menu set to [OFF], if
the sound of operation bothers you to avoid recording the lens noise.
•When operating the zoom while recording motion pictures, it may take time to come into focus.
How to set focus when recording a motion picture ([Continuous AF])
Focus mode [Continuous AF] Description of settings
[AFS]/[AFF]/
[AFC]
[ON] The camera automatically keeps focusing on subjects
during recording.
[OFF] The camera maintains the focus position at the start of
recording.
[MF] [ON]/[OFF] You can focus manually. (P106)

171
7. Recording Motion Pictures
Recording Motion Pictures that Pan and Zoom
While Maintaining a Fixed Camera Position
([4K Live Cropping])
Recording Mode:
By cropping your motion picture down from the 4K angle of view to Full High Definition,
you can record a motion picture that pans and zooms in/out while leaving the camera in a
fixed position.
•Hold the camera firmly in place while recording.
•A motion picture will be recorded at [FHD/20M/25p] under [MP4].
•When you want to zoom in/out, set different angles of view for the cropping start and end
frames. For example, to zoom in, set a larger angle of view for the start frame and a smaller
angle of view for the end frame.
1Set mode dial to [ ].
2Select the menu. (P54)
•The angle of view narrows.
Pan Zoom in
> [Motion Picture] > [4K Live Cropping] > [40SEC]/[20SEC]
MENU

7. Recording Motion Pictures
172
3Set the cropping start frame.
ACropping start frame
•When making settings for the first time, a cropping start
frame of size 1920k1080 is displayed. (After setting the
cropping start frame and end frame, the start frame and
end frame that you set immediately before will be
displayed.)
•The camera will remember the frame position and size
even when the camera is turned off.
4Repeat step 3, and then set the cropping end
frame.
BCropping end frame
•The setting of the Auto Focus Mode switches to [š].
(The eye to be in focus is not indicated.)
Button operation Touch operation Description of operation
3/4/2/1Touching Moves the frame
Pinch out/
Pinch in
Enlarges/reduces the frame
(The range of settings allowed is
from 1920k1080 to 3840k2160.)
[DISP.] [Reset]
Returns the position of the frame to
the centre and its size to the
default setting.
[MENU/SET] [Set] Decides the position and size of
the frame
5HVHW
ュリヴヱハ
6HW
A
5HVHW
ュリヴヱハ
6HW
B

173
7. Recording Motion Pictures
5Press the motion picture button (or shutter
button) to start recording.
AElapsed recording time
BSet operating time
•Immediately release the motion picture button (or the
shutter button) after pressing it.
•When the set operating time has elapsed, recording
automatically ends.
To end recording midway, press the motion picture
button (or the shutter button) again.
∫Changing the position and size of a crop frame
Press [Fn3] while the recording screen is displayed, and perform steps 3 and 4.
∫To cancel [4K Live Cropping] recording
Set [OFF] in step 2.
•Brightness is measured and focus is done in the cropping start frame. During motion picture
recording, they are done in the crop frame. To lock the focus position, set [Continuous AF] to
[OFF], or set the Focus Mode to [MF].
•[Metering Mode] will be [ ] (Multiple).
7
s
7
s
7
s
20
s
20
s
20
s
A
B

7. Recording Motion Pictures
174
Recording still pictures while recording motion
pictures
Applicable modes:
You can record still pictures while recording a motion picture. (Simultaneous recording)
∫Setting the motion picture priority or still picture priority mode
Applicable modes:
Select the menu. (P54)
During motion picture recording, press the
shutter button fully to record a still picture.
•Simultaneous recording indicator is displayed while recording
still pictures.
•Recording with the Touch Shutter function (P52) is also
available.
> [Motion Picture] > [Picture Mode]
[]
([Video Priority])
•Pictures will be recorded with a picture size of [S] (2 M).
The picture quality may be different to [S] (2 M) of standard pictures.
•Only JPEG images are recorded when [Quality] is set to [ ], [ ] or
[].
(When set to [ ], still pictures will be recorded in [Quality] of [A].)
•Up to 40 still pictures can be recorded during recording of the motion
picture.
(An MP4 motion picture with a [Rec Quality] size of [4K]: up to 10 pictures)
[]
([Photo Priority])
•Pictures will be recorded with the set picture size and quality.
•The screen will go dark while recording pictures. A still picture will be
recorded in the motion picture during that period, and audio is not recorded.
•Up to 10 still pictures can be recorded during recording of the motion
picture.
(An MP4 motion picture with a [Rec Quality] size of [4K]: up to 5 pictures)
13
13
13
MENU

175
7. Recording Motion Pictures
•The picture aspect ratio will be fixed to [16:9].
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When [Rec Quality] is set to [VGA/4M/25p] for MP4 motion pictures
–When [Rec Quality] is set to [4K/100M/24p] for MP4 motion picture or [FHD/24M/24p] for
AVCHD motion pictures (only when [ ] ([Photo Priority]) is selected)
–When the drive mode is set to 4K Photo (only when [ ] ([Photo Priority]) is set)
–When using [Ex. Tele Conv.] in the [Motion Picture] menu (only when [ ] ([Photo Priority]) is
set)
–When [Snap Movie] is set to [ON]

7. Recording Motion Pictures
176
Recording Snap Movies
Applicable modes:
You can specify the recording time in advance and record motion pictures casually like you
take snapshots. The function also allows you to shift a focus at the start of recording and
add fade in/out effects in advance.
•Motion pictures will be recorded with [FHD/20M/25p] in [MP4].
•Using the smartphone/tablet app “Panasonic Image App”, you can combine motion pictures
recorded with the camera. Music can be added and various editing operations can be
performed when you combine them. In addition, you can send the combined motion picture to a
web service. (P263)
1Select the menu. (P54)
•Press the shutter button halfway to exit the menu.
2Start recording by pressing the motion
picture button.
AElapsed recording time
BSet recording time
•Release the motion picture button right after you press it.
•You cannot stop motion picture recording in the
middle.The recording will stop automatically when the set
recording time has elapsed.
∫To deactivate Snap Movie
Select [OFF] in step 1.
> [Motion Picture] > [Snap Movie] > [ON]
MENU
3
s
3
s
3
s
SNAP
4SEC
4
s
4
s
4
s
A
B

177
7. Recording Motion Pictures
∫Changing the Snap Movie settings
Select the menu. (P54)
•Motion pictures recorded with [WHITE-IN] or [BLACK-IN] are displayed as all-white or all-black
thumbnails in Playback Mode.
•If you assign [Snap Movie] to [Fn Button Set] (P58), you can display a screen that lets you
switch [Snap Movie] between [ON]/[OFF] by pressing the assigned function button. If you press
[DISP.] while the screen is displayed, you can change the settings for Snap Movie.
•[Snap Movie] will be set to [OFF] when you connect to Wi-Fi with [Remote Shooting & View].
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–[Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode)
–When the drive mode is set to 4K Photo
–When [4K Live Cropping] is set
> [Motion Picture] > [Snap Movie] > [SET]
[Record time] Sets the recording time of motion pictures.
[Pull Focus] Allows dramatic imaging expression by shifting focus gradually at the start
of recording. (P178)
[Fade]
Adds a fade-in (gradual appearance) effect to an image and audio as
recording starts or adds a fade-out (gradual disappearance) effect to them
as recording ends.
[WHITE-IN]/[WHITE-OUT]:
Adds a fade-in or fade-out effect that uses a white screen.
[BLACK-IN]/[BLACK-OUT]:
Adds a fade-in or fade-out effect that uses a black screen.
[COLOR-IN]/[COLOR-OUT]:
Adds an effect that fades in from black-and-white to colour or an effect that
fades out from colour to black-and-white. Audio will be recorded normally.
[OFF]
MENU

7. Recording Motion Pictures
178
Set the frames that specify the positions where the [Pull
Focus] starts (first position) and stops (second position).
1Press 2.
2Press 3/4/2/1 to move the AF area frame, and
press [MENU/SET]. (First position)
•If you press [DISP.] before pressing [MENU/SET], the frame will return to the centre.
3Repeat step 2. (Second position)
•If you press [MENU/SET], the frame settings will be cancelled.
Touch a subject (first position), drag your finger to the desired location (second
position), and release the finger.
•If you touch [ ], the frame settings will be cancelled.
•When the camera fails to set the frame, it returns to the first position.
•When [Pull Focus] is set to [ON]:
–Auto Focus Mode will be switched to [ ], a setting specially designed for [Pull Focus].
–If you take a picture, the Auto Focus operation [Ø] will take place at the first frame position.
•Even when [Metering Mode] (P194) is set to [ ], the spot metering target does not move with
focus. The target is fixed at the start position (first position) of Pull Focus.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–In Manual Focus
–When using the Digital Zoom
Setting up [Pull Focus]
Button operation
Touch operation
•A greater effect can be achieved by creating a striking contrast of focus between the
start and end positions, for example by shifting focus from the background to
foreground, or vice versa.
•After setting focus, try to keep the distance between the subject and the camera
constant.

179
8. Playing Back and Editing Images
Playing Back Pictures
1Press [(].
2Press 2/1.
•If you press and hold 2/1, you can play back the
pictures in succession.
•Pictures can also be forwarded or rewound by rotating the front dial or dragging the
screen horizontally. (P51)
•You can forward or rewind pictures continuously by keeping your finger on the left or
right sides of the screen after forwarding/rewinding a picture.
(Pictures are displayed reduced in size)
∫To finish playback
Press [(] again or press the shutter button halfway.
Not available in these cases:
•This camera complies with the DCF standard “Design rule for Camera File system” established
by JEITA “Japan Electronics and Information Technology Industries Association” and with Exif
“Exchangeable Image File Format”.
This camera can only display pictures that comply with the DCF standard.
•The camera may not play back images recorded on other devices correctly, and the functions
of the camera may not be available for the images.
2: Play back the previous picture
1: Play back the next picture
Sending an image to a web service
If you press 4 when displaying images one by one, you can easily send an image to a
web service. (P276)
1/981/981/981/98

8. Playing Back and Editing Images
180
Playing Back Motion Pictures
This unit was designed to play motion pictures using the AVCHD and MP4 formats.
•Motion pictures are displayed with the motion picture icon
([ ]).
Press 3 to play back.
AMotion picture recording time
•After playback starts, the elapsed playback time is displayed on
the screen.
For example, 8 minutes and 30 seconds is displayed as [8m30s].
•Some information (recording information, etc.) is not displayed for motion pictures recorded in
[AVCHD].
•Touching [ ] in the middle of the screen allows you to play back motion pictures.
•Motion pictures recorded with [Snap Movie] are played back automatically.
∫Operations during Motion Picture Playback
¢ 1 The fast forward/rewind speed increases if you press 1/2 again.
¢ 2 When a motion picture recorded with [AVCHD] is rewound frame-by-frame, its frames will be
shown in intervals of approximately 0.5 seconds.
∫Operations during automatic Snap Movie playback
•If you touch the screen, automatic playback will stop.
•You can play back motion pictures on a PC with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (P296).
Button
operation
Touch
operation
Description of
operation
Button
operation
Touch
operation
Description of
operation
3Play/Pause 4Stop
2
Fast rewind¢1
1
Fast forward¢1
Frame-by-frame
rewind
(while pausing)¢2
Frame-by-frame
forward
(while pausing)
Reduce volume level Increase volume
level
3Playback from the beginning
2Back to previous picture
1Ahead to next picture
12s12s
12s
12s
A

181
8. Playing Back and Editing Images
You can save a scene of a motion picture as a picture.
1Press 3 to pause motion picture playback.
•You can finely adjust the location for division by pressing 2/1 while the motion picture
is paused.
2Press [MENU/SET].
•The same operation can be performed by touching
[].
•Still pictures will be saved with [Aspect Ratio] set to [16:9] and [Quality] set to [›]. The number
of pixels will differ according to the motion picture you play back.
–When the motion picture size is set to [4K] in [Rec Quality]: [M] (8 M)
–When the motion picture size is set to [FHD], [HD] in [Rec Quality]: [S] (2 M)
•Still pictures created from a motion picture may be coarser than with normal picture quality.
•[ ] is displayed during playback of still pictures created from motion pictures.
•To create still pictures from motion pictures when the camera is connected to a TV with an
HDMI micro cable, set [VIERA Link] in [TV Connection] in the [Setup] menu to [OFF].
Not available in these cases:
•Still pictures cannot be created from motion pictures recorded in [VGA/4M/25p] of [MP4].
Creating Still Pictures from a Motion Picture

8. Playing Back and Editing Images
182
Switching the Playback Method
Using the Playback Zoom
Rotate the rear dial right.
1k2k4k8k16k
•If the rear dial is rotated to the left after the image is enlarged, the
magnification will be reduced.
•You can also enlarge/reduce the image by pinching out/pinching
in (P51) on the part you want to enlarge/reduce.
•You can move the enlarged part by pressing 3/4/2/1 or
dragging the screen. (P51)
•You can also enlarge (2k) the image by double-touching the part
you want to enlarge. If you double-touch the enlarged image, the
magnification is reset to 1k.
∫Switching the displayed image while maintaining the
Playback Zoom
You can switch the displayed image while maintaining the
same zoom magnification and zoom position for the Playback
Zoom.
Forward or rewind images by rotating the front dial
during Playback Zoom.
•Images can also be forwarded or rewound by setting the image
forward/rewind operation by pressing the rear dial during
Playback Zoom, and then touching [ ]/[ ] or pressing 2/1.
2.0X2.0X
2.0X
2.0X
2.0X2.0X
2.0X
2.0X

183
8. Playing Back and Editing Images
•The recording date of the picture selected in the playback screen becomes the date selected
when the Calendar screen is first displayed.
•You can display the Calendar between January 2000 and December 2099.
•If the date is not set in the camera, the recording date is set as the 1st January, 2016.
•If you take pictures after setting the travel destination in [World Time], the pictures are
displayed by the dates at the travel destination in Calendar Playback.
Displaying multiple screens (Multi Playback)
Rotate the rear dial left.
1 screen 12 screens 30 screens Calendar screen
display
•If the rear dial is rotated to the right, the previous playback
screen will be displayed.
•It is possible to switch the playback screen by touching the
following icons.
–[ ]: 1 screen
–[ ]: 12 screens
–[ ]: 30 screens
–[ ]: Calendar screen display
•The screen can be switched gradually by dragging the screen
up or down.
•Pictures displayed using [ ] cannot be played back.
∫To return to Normal Playback
Press 3/4/2/1 to select a picture and then press [MENU/SET].
Displaying Pictures by Recording Date (Calendar Playback)
1Rotate the rear dial left to display the Calendar screen.
2Press 3/4/2/1 to select the recording date and
press [MENU/SET].
•Only the images recorded on that date will be displayed.
•Rotate the rear dial left to return to the Calendar screen
display.
3Press 3/4/2/1 to select a picture and then press
[MENU/SET].
CAL
1/98
6HW
2016
SUN MON TUE WED THU FRI SAT
12
19
26
5
11
18
25
4
14
21
28
7
13
20
27
6
12
910
23
30
24
8
15
22
29
16 17
31
321

8. Playing Back and Editing Images
184
Playing Back Group Pictures
A picture group consists of multiple pictures. You can play back pictures in a group either
continuously or one by one.
•You can edit or delete all pictures in a group at once.
(For example, if you delete a picture group, all pictures in the group are deleted.)
•Pictures will not be grouped if recorded without setting the clock.
Press 3.
•The same operation can be performed by touching the group picture icon ([ ], [ ],
[]).
•When playing back group pictures one at a time, options are displayed.
After selecting [Burst Play] (or [Sequential Play]), select either of the following playback
methods:
[From the first picture]:
Pictures are played back continuously from the first picture of the group.
[From the current picture]:
Pictures are played back continuously from the picture being played back.
∫Operations during Group Pictures playback
[]:
A picture group consisting of pictures taken in the Burst
Mode with the burst speed [SH]. (P135)
[]:
A picture group consisting of pictures taken with Focus
Bracket. (P140)
[]:
A picture group consisting of pictures taken in a Time Lapse
Shot. (P141)
[]:
A picture group consisting of pictures taken in the Stop
Motion Animation. (P143)
Continuously playing back Group Pictures
3Continuous playback/Pause 4Stop
2
Fast rewind
1
Fast forward
Rewind
(while pausing)
Forward
(while pausing)
1/981/98
1/98
1/98
SLF
SLF
SLF

185
8. Playing Back and Editing Images
1Press 4.
•The same operation can be performed by touching [ ],
[ ], [ ], or [ ].
2Press 2/1 to flip through images.
•Pressing 4 again or touching [ ] will return you to the normal playback screen.
•Each picture in a group can be treated same as normal pictures when they are played
back. (Such as Multi Playback, Playback Zoom and deleting images)
Playing back group pictures one by one
1/981/981/981/98
SLF
SLF
SLF

8. Playing Back and Editing Images
186
Deleting Pictures
Once deleted, pictures cannot be recovered.
1In Playback Mode, select the picture to delete
and then press [ ].
•The same operation can be performed by touching
[].
2Press 3 to select [Delete Single] and then
press [MENU/SET].
¢Picture groups are treated as a single picture.
(All the pictures in the selected picture group will be deleted.)
1In Playback Mode, press [ ].
2Press 3/4 to select [Delete Multi] or [Delete All] and then press
[MENU/SET].
•It is possible to delete all pictures except the ones set as favourite when [All Delete
Except Favorite] is selected with the [Delete All] set.
3(When [Delete Multi] is selected)
Press 3/4/2/1 to select the picture, and
then press [MENU/SET] to set. (Repeat this
step.)
•[‚] appears on the selected pictures.
If [MENU/SET] is pressed again, the setting is cancelled.
4(When [Delete Multi] is selected)
Press 2 to select [OK], and then press [MENU/SET] to execute.
•Depending on the number of pictures to be deleted, it may take some time to delete them.
To delete a single picture
To delete multiple pictures (up to 100¢) or all the pictures
'HOHWH0XOWL
'HOHWH6LQJOH
'HOHWH$OO
2.

187
9. Using Menu Functions
Menu list
•[Photo Style], [Filter Settings], [Focus Mode], [Metering Mode], [Highlight Shadow], [i.Dynamic],
[i.Resolution], [Diffraction Compensation], [Digital Zoom] and [Stabilizer] are common to both
the [Rec] menu and [Motion Picture] menu. Changing these settings in one of these menus is
reflected in other menu.
[Rec] P187 [Motion Picture] P208 [Custom] P210
[Setup] P220 [Playback] P228
:[Rec] menu
•[Photo Style] (P188)
•[Filter Settings] (P190)
•[Aspect Ratio] (P192)
•[Picture Size] (P192)
•[Quality] (P193)
•[Focus Mode] (P95)
•[Metering Mode] (P194)
•[Burst Rate] (P135)
•[4K PHOTO] (P118)
•[Bracket] (P138)
•[Self Timer] (P137)
•[Highlight Shadow] (P195)
•[i.Dynamic] (Intelligent dynamic range
control) (P196)
•[i.Resolution] (P196)
•[Post Focus] (P131)
•[iHandheld Night Shot] (P65)
•[iHDR] (P66)
•[HDR] (P197)
•[Multi Exp.] (P198)
•[Time Lapse Shot] (P141)
•[Stop Motion Animation] (P143)
•[Panorama Settings] (P78)
•[Shutter Type] (P199)
•[Shutter Delay] (P200)
•[Flash] (P159)
•[Red-Eye Removal] (P200)
•[ISO Limit Set] (P201)
•[ISO Increments] (P201)
•[Extended ISO] (P201)
•[Long Shtr NR] (P202)
•[Shading Comp.] (P202)
•[Diffraction Compensation] (P203)
•[Ex. Tele Conv.] (P151)
•[Digital Zoom] (P153)
•[Color Space] (P203)
•[Stabilizer] (P146)
•[Face Recog.] (P204)
•[Profile Setup] (P207)

9. Using Menu Functions
188
Applicable modes:
You can select effects to match the type of image you wish to record.
It is possible to adjust the items such as colour or picture quality of the effect to your
desire.
¢This is disabled when Intelligent Auto Plus Mode is selected.
•In Intelligent Auto Plus Mode, the setting will be reset to [Standard] when the camera is
switched to another Recording Mode or this unit is turned on and off.
•Only picture quality adjustment can be set in the Scene Guide Mode.
[Photo Style]
> [Rec] > [Photo Style]
[Standard] This is the standard setting.
[Vivid]¢Brilliant effect with high saturation and contrast.
[Natural]¢Soft effect with low contrast.
[Monochrome] Monochrome effect with no colour shades.
[L.Monochrome]¢Black-and-white effect with rich gradation and crisp black
accents
[Scenery]¢An effect appropriate for sceneries with vivid blue skies and
greens.
[Portrait]¢An effect appropriate for portraits with a healthy and beautiful
skin tone.
[Custom]¢Use the setting registered in advance.
MENU

189
9. Using Menu Functions
∫Adjusting the picture quality
•Picture quality cannot be adjusted in the Intelligent Auto Plus
Mode.
1Press 2/1 to select the type of Photo Style.
2Press 3/4 to select the items, and then press 2/1
to adjust.
¢1[Color Tone] is displayed only when [Monochrome] or [L.Monochrome] is selected. In
other cases, [Saturation] will be displayed.
¢2Displayed only when [Monochrome] or [L.Monochrome] is selected.
•If you adjust the picture quality, [_] is displayed beside the Photo Style icon on the screen.
3Press [MENU/SET].
∫Registering settings to [Custom]
Adjust the picture quality following step 2 of “Adjusting the picture quality”, and
then press [DISP.].
[Contrast]
[r]Increases the difference between the brightness and
the darkness in the picture.
[s]Decreases the difference between the brightness
and the darkness in the picture.
[Sharpness] [r]The picture is sharply defined.
[s]The picture is softly focused.
[Noise Reduction]
[r]The noise reduction effect is enhanced.
Picture resolution may deteriorate slightly.
[s]The noise reduction effect is reduced. You can obtain
pictures with higher resolution.
[Saturation]¢1[r]The colours in the picture become vivid.
[s]The colours in the picture become natural.
[Color Tone]¢1[r]Adds a bluish tone.
[s]Adds a yellowish tone.
[Filter Effect]¢2
[Yellow] Enhances the contrast of an subject. (Effect: Weak)
The blue sky can be recorded clearly.
[Orange]
Enhances the contrast of an subject. (Effect:
Medium)
The blue sky can be recorded in darker blue.
[Red] Enhances the contrast of an subject. (Effect: Strong)
The blue sky can be recorded in much darker blue.
[Green] The skin and lips of people appear in natural tones.
Green leaves appear brighter and more enhanced.
[Off] —
DISP.カスタム登録
±0
±0
S
±0
±0
-5 0 +5
6WDQGDUG
S

9. Using Menu Functions
190
Applicable modes:
You can apply image effects (filters) that are available for Creative Control Mode to images
in other modes, such as Aperture-Priority AE Mode or Panorama Shot Mode. (P83)
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]/[SET]
∫Change the settings by using the touch screen
1Touch [ ].
2Touch the item you want to set.
•[Rough Monochrome]/[Silky Monochrome]/[Toy Effect]¢1/[Toy Pop]¢1/[Miniature Effect]¢1, 2/[Soft
Focus]/[Star Filter]/[Sunshine] are not available in the following cases.
–Creative Video Mode
–When recording motion pictures
¢1 When [4K Live Cropping] is set to [ON].
¢2 When recording motion pictures with [Rec Quality] of [4K]
•Please note the following points when using Panorama Shot Mode:
–[Toy Effect]/[Toy Pop]/[Miniature Effect]/[Sunshine] are not available.
–The image effects of [Rough Monochrome]/[Silky Monochrome]/[Soft Focus]/[Star Filter] are
not visible on the screen.
–Using [High Key] may not be effective in dimly-lit conditions.
•The available ISO sensitivity settings will be limited up to [ISO 3200]. The ISO sensitivity for
[High Dynamic] will be fixed to [AUTO].
•When using [Filter Effect], you cannot use menus or recording functions not available in
Creative Control Mode.
For example, White Balance will be fixed to [AWB] and the flash will be set to [Œ] (forced flash
off).
[Filter Settings]
> [Rec] > [Filter Settings] > [Filter Effect]
[]:Image effect ON/OFF
[]:Selects an image effect (filter)
[]:Adjusts an image effect
MENU
EXPS
EXPS
EXPS
EXPS
EXPS

191
9. Using Menu Functions
∫Taking a picture with and without an image effect simultaneously
([Simultaneous record w/o filter])
You can press the shutter button once and take two pictures simultaneously, one with an
image effect and the other one without it.
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]
•When this item is set to [ON], a picture with an image effect will be taken first, followed by a
picture without it.
•Only an image with an image effect is displayed for Auto Review.
Not available in these cases:
•In the following case, [Simultaneous record w/o filter] does not work:
–Panorama Shot Mode
–Recording still pictures while recording a motion picture (only when set to [ ] ([Video
Priority]))
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When recording in Burst Mode
–When [Quality] is set to [ ], [ ] or [ ]
–When recording with the Bracket function
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation]
> [Rec] > [Filter Settings] > [Simultaneous record w/o filter]
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
192
Applicable modes:
This allows you to select the aspect ratio of the pictures to suit printing or the playback
method.
Applicable modes:
Set the number of pixels.
The higher the numbers of pixels, the finer the detail of the pictures will appear even when
they are printed onto large sheets.
•When [Ex. Tele Conv.] (P151) is set, [ ] is displayed on the picture sizes of each aspect ratio
except for [L].
•The picture size will be fixed to [4K] ([4:3]: 3328k2496; [3:2]: 3504k2336; [16:9]: 3840k2160;
[1:1]: 2880k2880) when recording 4K photos or recording in Post Focus.
[Aspect Ratio]
> [Rec] > [Aspect Ratio]
[4:3] [Aspect Ratio] of a 4:3 TV
[3:2] [Aspect Ratio] of a 35 mm film camera
[16:9] [Aspect Ratio] of a high-definition TV, etc.
[1:1] Square aspect ratio
[Picture Size]
> [Rec] > [Picture Size]
When the aspect ratio is [4:3]. When the aspect ratio is [3:2].
Settings Image size Settings Image size
[L] (16M) 4592k3448 [L] (14M) 4592k3064
[M] (8M) 3232k2424 [M] (7M) 3232k2160
[S] (4M) 2272k1704 [S] (3.5M) 2272k1520
When the aspect ratio is [16:9]. When the aspect ratio is [1:1].
Settings Image size Settings Image size
[L] (12M) 4592k2584 [L] (11.5M) 3424k3424
[M] (8M) 3840k2160 [M] (6M) 2416k2416
[S] (2M) 1920k1080 [S] (3M) 1712k1712
MENU
MENU

193
9. Using Menu Functions
Applicable modes:
Set the compression rate at which the pictures are to be stored.
•RAW images are always recorded in the [4:3] (4592k3448) aspect ratio regardless of the
aspect ratio at the time of recording.
•When you delete an image recorded with [ ] or [ ], both the RAW and JPEG images
will be deleted simultaneously.
•When you play back an image recorded with [ ], grey areas corresponding to the aspect
ratio at the time of recording are displayed.
•The setting is fixed to [A] when recording 4K photos or recording in [Post Focus].
Not available in these cases:
•In the following cases, [ ], [ ], and [ ] cannot be set.
–Panorama Shot Mode
–[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
–When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH]
[Quality]
> [Rec] > [Quality]
Settings File format Description of settings
[A]
JPEG
A JPEG image in which image quality was given priority.
[›]
A standard image quality JPEG image.
This is useful for increasing the number of shots without
changing the number of pixels.
[]RAWiJPEG You can record a RAW image and a JPEG image ([A] or
[›]) simultaneously.
[]
[] RAW You can only record RAW images.
About RAW
RAW format refers to a data format of images that have not been processed. Playback
and editing of RAW images require the camera or the dedicated software.
•You can process RAW images in [RAW Processing] in the [Playback] menu. (P234)
•Use software (“SILKYPIX Developer Studio” (P297) by Ichikawa Soft Laboratory) to process
and edit RAW files on a PC.
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
194
Applicable modes:
Type of optical measurement to measure brightness can be changed.
[Metering Mode]
> [Rec] > [Metering Mode]
[]
(Multiple)
This is the method in which the camera measures the most suitable
exposure by judging the allocation of brightness on the whole screen
automatically.
Usually, we recommend using this method.
[]
(Centre weighted)
This is the method used to focus on the subject on the centre of the
screen and measure the whole screen evenly.
[]
(Spot)
This is the method to measure the subject in the spot
metering target A.
•If you set the spot metering target on the edge of the
screen, the metering may be affected by the brightness
around the location.
MENU

195
9. Using Menu Functions
Applicable modes:
You can adjust the brightness of bright and dark portions on an image while checking the
brightness on the screen.
1Rotate the front/rear dial to adjust the brightness of
bright/dark portions.
ABright portion
BDark portion
CPreview display
•The rear dial is for adjusting dark areas, and the front
dial is for adjusting bright areas.
•To register a preferred setting, press 3, and select the
destination where the custom setting will be registered to
([Custom1] ( )/[Custom2] ( )/[Custom3] ( )).
•Adjustments can also be made by dragging the graph.
2Press [MENU/SET].
•The screen display can be switched by pressing [DISP.] on the brightness adjustment screen.
•Turning off this unit will return the setting adjusted with /// back to the default setting.
[Highlight Shadow]
>[Rec] > [Highlight Shadow]
(Standard) A state with no adjustments is set.
(Raise the contrast) Bright areas are brightened, and dark areas are darkened.
(Lower the contrast) Bright areas are darkened, and dark areas are brightened.
(Brighten dark areas) Dark areas are brightened.
// (Custom) Registered custom settings can be applied.
MENU
ヒ
ヤ
ビ
ヤ
ピ
ヤ
A
BC
ヒ
ヤ
ビ
ヤ
ピ
ヤ

9. Using Menu Functions
196
Applicable modes:
Contrast and exposure are compensated when the brightness difference between the
background and subject is great, etc.
Settings: [AUTO]/[HIGH]/[STANDARD]/[LOW]/[OFF]
Not available in these cases:
•Compensation effect may not be achieved depending on the recording conditions.
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When [HDR] is set to [ON]
Applicable modes:
Pictures with sharp profile and resolution can be taken by using the Intelligent Resolution
Technology.
Settings: [HIGH]/[STANDARD]/[LOW]/[EXTENDED]/[OFF]
•[EXTENDED] allows you to take natural pictures with a higher resolution.
•The [EXTENDED] setting will automatically change to the [LOW] setting while recording motion
pictures, recording 4K photos, or recording in [Post Focus].
[i.Dynamic]
> [Rec] > [i.Dynamic]
[i.Resolution]
> [Rec] > [i.Resolution]
MENU
MENU

197
9. Using Menu Functions
Applicable modes:
You can combine 3 pictures with different levels of exposure into a single picture with rich
gradation.
You can minimise the loss of gradations in bright areas and dark areas when, for example,
the contrast between the background and the subject is large.
An image combined by HDR is recorded in JPEG.
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]/[SET]
∫Changing settings
•Do not move the unit during the continuous shooting after pressing the shutter button.
•You cannot take the next picture until the combination of pictures is complete.
•A moving subject may be recorded with unnatural blurs.
•The angle of view becomes narrow slightly when [Auto Align] is set to [ON].
•Flash is fixed to [Œ] (forced flash off).
Not available in these cases:
•[HDR] does not work for the pictures taken during a motion picture recording.
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When recording in Burst Mode
–When recording with the Bracket function
–When recording with the shutter speed set to [T] (Time)
–When [Quality] is set to [ ], [ ] or [ ]
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only when [Auto Shooting] is set)
[HDR]
> [Rec] > [HDR]
[Dynamic Range]
[AUTO]: Automatically adjusts the exposure range according to the
differences between the bright and dark areas.
[n1EV]/[n2EV]/[n3EV]:
Adjusts the exposure within the selected exposure
parameters.
[Auto Align]
[ON]: Automatically corrects camera shake (jitter) and other
problems that can cause the images to misalign.
Recommended for use during hand-held shooting.
[OFF]: Image misalignment not adjusted.
Recommended when a tripod is used.
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
198
Applicable modes:
Gives an effect like multi exposure. (up to 4 times equivalent per a single image)
1Press 3/4 to select [Start] and then press [MENU/SET].
2Decide on the composition, and take the first picture.
•After taking the picture, press the shutter button halfway
down to take the next picture.
•Press 3/4 to select the item and then press [MENU/SET]
for one of the following operations.
3Shooting the second, third, and fourth exposures.
•If [Fn3] is pressed while taking pictures, the photographed images are recorded, and the
multiple exposure picture-taking session will be completed.
4Press 4 to select [Exit] and then press [MENU/SET].
•You can also press the shutter button halfway to finish.
∫Changing settings
•The recording information displayed for pictures taken with multiple exposures is the recording
information for the last picture taken.
•Items shown in grey on the menu screen cannot be set during multiple exposures.
•[Overlay] is available only for RAW images taken with this unit.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation]
[Multi Exp.]
> [Rec] > [Multi Exp.]
–[Next]: Advance to the next picture.
–[Retake]: Return to the first picture.
–[Exit]: Record the image of the first picture, and
finish the multiple exposure picture-taking
session.
[Auto Gain] If you select [OFF], all exposure results are superimposed as they are.
Compensate the exposure as necessary, depending on the subject.
[Overlay]
If you select [ON], you can apply Multi Exposure to previously recorded
images. After [Start] is selected, images on the card will be displayed.
Select a RAW image, and press [MENU/SET] to proceed to recording.
MENU
([LW
5HWDNH
1H[W
([LW
5HWDNH

199
9. Using Menu Functions
Applicable modes:
You can use either of the two shutters to take pictures: the mechanical shutter or the
electronic shutter.
¢1 This setting is available only in Manual Exposure Mode. (P73)
¢2 Up to an ISO sensitivity of [ISO3200]. When the setting is higher than [ISO3200], the shutter
speed will be faster than 1 second.
¢3 Electronic shutter sound settings can be changed in [E-Shutter Vol] and [E-Shutter Tone].
(P221)
•When [ ] is displayed on the screen, pictures will be taken with the electronic shutter.
•When a moving subject is recorded with the electronic shutter, the subject may appear
distorted on the picture.
•When the electronic shutter is used under fluorescent or LED lighting, etc., horizontal
stripes may appear on the picture. In such cases, lowering the shutter speed may
reduce the effect of the horizontal stripes. (P72)
[Shutter Type]
Mechanical shutter Electronic Shutter
Flash ±—
Shutter Speed
(Sec.) T (Time)¢1/60 to 1/4000th 1¢2 to 1/16000th
Shutter sound Mechanical shutter sound Electronic shutter sound¢3
> [Rec] > [Shutter Type]
[AUTO]
The shutter mode automatically switches based on the recording conditions
and shutter speed.
•The mechanical shutter mode has higher priority over the electronic shutter
mode because the mechanical shutter has less function-related restrictions
when recording with a flash, etc.
[MSHTR] Uses only the mechanical shutter mode to take a picture.
[ESHTR] Uses only the electronic shutter mode to take a picture.
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
200
Applicable modes:
To reduce the influence of hand shake or shutter vibration, shutter is released after the
specified time has passed.
Settings: [8SEC]/[4SEC]/[2SEC]/[1SEC]/[OFF]
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When recording motion pictures
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with the Bracket function
–When [HDR] is set to [ON]
Applicable modes:
When Red-Eye Reduction ([ ], [ ]) is selected, Red-Eye Removal is performed
whenever the flash is used. The camera automatically detects red-eye and corrects the
picture.
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]
•[ ] is displayed on the icon when it is set to [ON].
•Under certain circumstances, red-eye cannot be corrected.
[Shutter Delay]
> [Rec] > [Shutter Delay]
[Red-Eye Removal]
> [Rec] > [Red-Eye Removal]
MENU
MENU

201
9. Using Menu Functions
Applicable modes:
It will select optimal ISO sensitivity with set value as limit depending on the brightness of
the subject.
•It will work when the [Sensitivity] is set to [AUTO] or [ ].
Settings: [400]/[800]/[1600]/[3200]/[6400]/[12800]/[25600]/[OFF]
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–[Clear Nightscape]/[Cool Night Sky]/[Warm Glowing Nightscape]/[Handheld Night Shot]
(Scene Guide Mode)
–When recording motion pictures
Applicable modes:
You can adjust the ISO sensitivity settings for every 1/3 EV.
Settings: [1/3 EV]/[1 EV]
Applicable modes:
ISO sensitivity can be set up to minimum [ISO100].
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
[ISO Limit Set]
> [Rec] > [ISO Limit Set]
[ISO Increments]
> [Rec] > [ISO Increments]
[Extended ISO]
> [Rec] > [Extended ISO]
MENU
MENU
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
202
Applicable modes:
The camera automatically removes noise that appears when the shutter speed becomes
slower to take pictures of night scenery etc. so you can take beautiful pictures.
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]
•[Long shutter noise reduction ongoing] is displayed for the same time as the shutter speed for
signal processing.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–When recording motion pictures
–When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH]
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When using the electronic shutter
Applicable modes:
When the screen periphery darkens as a result of the lens characteristics, you can record
pictures with the brightness of the screen periphery corrected.
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]
•Compensation effect may not be achieved depending on the recording conditions.
•Noise in the periphery of the picture may stand out with higher ISO sensitivity.
Not available in these cases:
•Correction is not possible in the following cases:
–When recording motion pictures
–Recording still pictures while recording a motion picture (only when set to [ ] ([Video
Priority]))
–When [Burst Rate] is set to [SH]
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
[Long Shtr NR]
> [Rec] > [Long Shtr NR]
[Shading Comp.]
> [Rec] > [Shading Comp.]
MENU
MENU

203
9. Using Menu Functions
Applicable modes:
The camera raises the resolution by correcting the blurriness caused by diffraction when
the aperture is closed.
Settings: [AUTO]/[OFF]
•Compensation effect may not be achieved depending on the recording conditions.
•Noise may stand out with higher ISO sensitivity.
Applicable modes:
Set this when you want to correct the colour reproduction of the recorded pictures on a
PC, printer etc.
•Set to [sRGB] if you are not very familiar with AdobeRGB.
•The setting is fixed to [sRGB] in the following cases.
–When recording motion pictures
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
[Diffraction Compensation]
> [Rec] > [Diffraction Compensation]
[Color Space]
> [Rec] > [Color Space]
[sRGB] Colour space is set to sRGB colour space.
This is widely used in computer related equipment.
[AdobeRGB]
Colour space is set to AdobeRGB colour space.
AdobeRGB is mainly used for business purposes such as professional
printing because it has a greater range of reproducible colours than sRGB.
MENU
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
204
Applicable modes:
Face Recognition is a function which finds a face resembling a registered face and
priorities focus and exposure automatically. Even if the person is located towards the back
or on the end of a line in a group photo, the camera can still take a clear picture.
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]/[MEMORY]
•The following functions will also work with the Face Recognition function.
In Recording Mode
–Display of corresponding name when camera detects a registered face¢
In Playback Mode
–Display of name and age
–Selective playback of pictures chosen from pictures registered with Face Recognition
([Category Play] (P232))
¢Names of up to 3 people are displayed.
Precedence for the names displayed when taking pictures is determined according to the
order of registration.
•[Face Recog.] only works when the AF Mode is set to [š].
•During the Burst Mode, [Face Recog.] picture information can be attached to only the first
picture.
•When group pictures are played back, the name of the first picture of the set is displayed.
•Even when face recognition information has been registered, pictures taken with [Name] set to
[OFF] will not be categorised by face recognition in [Category Play].
•If you rename a registered person, images recorded before the renaming operation will no
longer be categorised by the Face Recognition function for [Category Play]. You can rename
the person in these images in [REPLACE] in [Face Rec Edit] (P249).
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–[Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode)
–When recording motion pictures
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
[Face Recog.]
> [Rec] > [Face Recog.]
KEN
KEN
MENU

205
9. Using Menu Functions
∫Face Settings
You can register information such as names and birthdays for face images of up to 6
people.
1Press 3
/
4 to select [MEMORY] and then press
[MENU/SET].
2Press 3/4/2/1 to select the Face Recognition
frame that is not registered, and then press [MENU/
SET].
3Take the picture adjusting the face with the guide.
•The faces of subjects other than people (pets, etc.) cannot
be registered.
•To display the description of the face registration, press 1
or touch [ ].
Point of recording when registering the face images
•Face front with eyes open and mouth closed, making
sure the outline of the face, the eyes, or the eyebrows
are not covered with hair when registering.
•Make sure there is no extreme shading on the face when
registering.
(Flash will not flash during registration.)
(Good example for registering)
When face is not recognised during recording
•Register the face of same person indoors and outdoors, or with different expressions or
angles. (P206)
•Additionally register at the location of recording.
•When a person who is registered is not recognised, correct by re-registering.
•Face Recognition may not be possible or may not recognise faces correctly even for
registered faces, depending on the facial expression and environment.
KEN
1HZ

9. Using Menu Functions
206
4Set the item.
•You can register up to 3 face images.
∫Change or delete the information for a registered person
1Press 3
/
4 to select [MEMORY] and then press [MENU/SET].
2Press 3/4/2/1 to select the face image to edit or delete and then press
[MENU/SET].
3Press 3/4 to select the item and then press [MENU/SET].
[Name] It is possible to register names.
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
[Age] It is possible to register the birthday.
[Add Images]
(Add Images)
To add additional face images.
1Select the unregistered face recognition frame, and then press
[MENU/SET].
2Perform step 3 in “Face Settings”.
(Delete)
To delete one of the face images.
Press 2/1 to select the face image to delete, and then press
[MENU/SET].
[Info Edit] Changing the information of an already registered person.
Perform step 4 in “Face Settings”.
[Priority]
The focus and exposure are preferentially adjusted for
higher-priority faces.
Press 3/4/2/1 to select the priority and then press
[MENU/SET].
[Delete] Deleting information of a registered person.

207
9. Using Menu Functions
Applicable modes:
If you set the name and birthday of your baby or pet in advance, you can record their name
and age in months and years in the images.
You can display these at playback or stamp the recorded images using [Text Stamp]
(P241).
Settings: [ ] ([Baby1])/[ ] ([Baby2])/[ ] ([Pet])/[OFF]/[SET]
∫Setting [Age] or [Name]
1Press 3/4 to select [SET] and then press [MENU/SET].
2Press 3/4 to select [Baby1], [Baby2] or [Pet] and then press [MENU/SET].
3Press 3/4 to select [Age] or [Name] and then press
[MENU/SET].
4Press 3/4 to select [SET] and then press [MENU/
SET].
5Press 4 to select [Exit] and then press [MENU/SET] to finish.
∫To cancel [Age] and [Name]
Select the [OFF] setting in step 1.
•You can print out ages in months and names with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (P296).
Not available in these cases:
•[Profile Setup] is not available for 4K photo recording or recording in [Post Focus].
•Ages and names are not recorded in the following cases:
–When recording motion pictures
–Still pictures recorded during motion picture recording ([ ] ([Video Priority])) (P174)
[Profile Setup]
> [Rec] > [Profile Setup]
Enter [Age] (birthday)
Enter [Name]
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
JOE LUCKY
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
208
Applicable modes:
The shutter speed can be fixed to reduce the flicker or striping in the motion picture.
Settings: [1/50]/[1/60]/[1/100]/[1/120]/[OFF]
Applicable modes:
Display the microphone level on the recording screen.
Settings: [ON]/[OFF]
Applicable modes:
Adjust the sound input level to 4 different levels.
: [Motion Picture] menu
•[Photo Style] (P188)
•[Filter Settings] (P190)
•[4K Live Cropping] (P171)
•[Snap Movie] (P176)
•[Rec Format] (P168)
•[Rec Quality] (P168)
•[Exposure Mode] (P89)
•[Focus Mode] (P95)
•[Picture Mode] (P174)
•[Continuous AF] (P170)
•[Metering Mode] (P194)
•[Highlight Shadow] (P195)
•[i.Dynamic] (Intelligent dynamic range
control) (P196)
•[i.Resolution] (P196)
•[Diffraction Compensation] (P203)
•[Ex. Tele Conv.] (P151)
•[Digital Zoom] (P153)
•[Stabilizer] (P146)
•[Flkr Decrease] (P208)
•[Silent Operation] (P90)
•[Mic Level Disp.] (P208)
•[Mic Level Adj.] (P208)
•[Wind Noise Canceller] (P209)
[Flkr Decrease]
> [Motion Picture] > [Flkr Decrease]
[Mic Level Disp.]
> [Motion Picture] > [Mic Level Disp.]
[Mic Level Adj.]
> [Motion Picture] > [Mic Level Adj.]
MENU
MENU
MENU

209
9. Using Menu Functions
Applicable modes:
This will reduce the wind noise coming into the built-in microphone while maintaining
sound quality.
Settings: [HIGH]/[STANDARD]/[OFF]
•[HIGH] effectively reduces the wind noise by minimising the low-pitched sound when a strong
wind is detected.
•[STANDARD] extracts and reduces only the wind noise without deteriorating the sound quality.
•You may not see the full effect depending on the recording conditions.
[Wind Noise Canceller]
> [Motion Picture] > [Wind Noise Canceller]
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
210
: [Custom] menu
> [Custom]
[Cust.Set Mem.] Registers the current camera settings as custom set. P91
[Silent Mode]
Disables operational sounds and output of light at once.
•Audio from the speaker will be muted and the flash and
the AF Assist lamp will be disabled.
The following settings are fixed.
–[Shutter Type]: [ESHTR]
–[Flash Mode]: [Œ] (forced flash off)
–[AF Assist Lamp]: [OFF]
–[Beep Volume]: [s] (OFF)
–[E-Shutter Vol]: [ ] (OFF)
•Even when [ON] is set, the following functions light up/
flash.
–Status indicator
–Self-timer indicator
–Wi-Fi connection lamp
–Charging lamp
•Sounds that are produced by the camera regardless of
your operations, such as the lens aperture sound, cannot
be muted.
•Be sure to pay special attention to the privacy, the
likeness rights, etc. of the subject when you use this
function. Use at your own risk.
s
[AF/AE Lock] Sets the fixed content for focusing and exposure when the
AF/AE lock is on. P109
[AF/AE Lock Hold]
When [ON] is selected, focus and exposure stays locked
even if you press and release [AF/AE LOCK]. Press the
button again to cancel the lock.
s
[Shutter AF] Set whether or not the focus is adjusted automatically
when the shutter button is pressed halfway. s
[Half Press Release] The shutter will immediately fire when the shutter button is
pressed halfway. s
MENU

211
9. Using Menu Functions
[Quick AF]
Speeds up the focusing that takes place when you press
the shutter button.
•The battery will be consumed faster than usual.
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–In Preview Mode
–In low light situations
s
[Eye Sensor AF]
The camera automatically adjusts the focus when the eye
sensor is active.
•[Eye Sensor AF] may not work in dimly lit conditions.
s
[Pinpoint AF Time]
Sets the time for which the screen is enlarged when the
shutter button is pressed halfway with Auto Focus Mode
set to [ ].
s
[Pinpoint AF Display]
Sets whether to display the assist screen that appears
when Auto Focus Mode is set to [ ] in a window or full
screen.
s
[AF Assist Lamp]
AF assist lamp will illuminate the subject when the shutter
button is pressed half-way making it easier for the camera
to focus when recording in low light conditions.
•The effective range of the AF Assist Lamp is different
depending on the lens used.
–When the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032) is
attached and at Wide:
Approx. 1.0 m (3.3 feet) to 3.0 m (9.8 feet)
–When the interchangeable lens (H-FS35100) is
attached and at Wide:
Approx. 1.0 m (3.3 feet) to 3.0 m (9.8 feet)
–When the interchangeable lens (H-H020A) is attached:
Approx. 1.0 m (3.3 feet) to 5.0 m (16 feet)
–When the interchangeable lens (H-FS14140) is
attached and at Wide:
Approx. 1.0 m (3.3 feet) to 3.0 m (9.8 feet)
•Remove the lens hood.
s
> [Custom]
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
212
[AF Assist Lamp]
(continued)
•The AF Assist Lamp gets slightly blocked when the
interchangeable lens (H-FS12032/H-FS35100/H-H020A)
is used, but it does not affect the performance.
•The AF Assist Lamp may be greatly blocked, and it may
become harder to focus when a lens with large diameter
is used (such as H-FS14140).
•The setting is fixed to [OFF] in the following cases.
–[Distinct Scenery]/[Bright Blue Sky]/[Romantic Sunset
Glow]/[Vivid Sunset Glow]/[Glistening Water]/[Clear
Nightscape]/[Cool Night Sky]/[Warm Glowing
Nightscape]/[Artistic Nightscape]/[Handheld Night Shot]
(Scene Guide Mode)
–When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON]
s
[Direct Focus Area]
Moves the AF area or MF assist using the cursor button
when recording.
•When [š], [ ], [ ], or [Ø] is selected, the AF area
can be moved; when [ ] is selected, the enlarged
position can be moved.
•To set the items that use the cursor buttons like [Drive
Mode], [White Balance], or [Sensitivity], use the Quick
Menu (P56) instead.
•[Direct Focus Area] is fixed to [OFF] in the following cases:
–[Glistening Water] (Scene Guide Mode)
–Creative Control Mode
–When [4K Live Cropping] is set
s
[Focus/Release Priority] It will set so no picture can be taken when it is out of focus. s
[AF+MF]
When AF Lock is ON (press the shutter button halfway with
the focus mode set to [AFS] or set AF Lock using [AF/AE
LOCK]), you can make fine adjustments to the focus
manually.
s
> [Custom]
MENU

213
9. Using Menu Functions
[MF Assist]
Sets the display method of MF Assist (enlarged screen).
When an interchangeable lens with no focus ring is
used (H-FS12032)
[ON]/[OFF]
When an interchangeable lens having a focus ring
(H-FS35100/H-H020A/H-FS14140) is used
[]:
The screen is enlarged by operating the focus ring or the
focus lever of the lens or by pressing 2().
[]:
The screen is enlarged by operating the focus ring or the
focus lever of the lens.
[]:
The screen is enlarged by pressing 2().
[OFF]:
The screen is not be enlarged.
•MF Assist is not displayed in the following cases:
–When recording motion pictures
–When recording with [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]) of the 4K
Photo function
–When using the Digital Zoom
s
[MF Assist Display] Sets whether MF Assist (enlarged screen) will appear in a
windowed screen display or in a full screen display. s
[MF Guide]
When you set the focus
manually, an MF guide
that allows you to check
the direction to achieve
focus is displayed.
s
> [Custom]
MENU
AIndicator for ¶ (infinity)
A

9. Using Menu Functions
214
[Peaking]
In-focus portions (portions on the screen with clear
outlines) are highlighted when focus is being adjusted
manually.
•When [Detect Level] in [SET] is set to [HIGH], portions to
be highlighted are reduced, allowing you to achieve a
more precise focus.
•Changing the [Detect Level] setting also changes the
[Display Color] setting as follows.
•Each time [ ] in [ ] is touched, the setting is switched
in order of [ON] ([Detect Level]: [LOW]) > [ON]
([Detect Level]: [HIGH]) > [OFF].
•[Peaking] does not work with [Rough Monochrome] in
Creative Control Mode.
s
> [Custom]
MENU
[Detect Level]
[HIGH] [LOW]
[Display Color]
[ ] (Light blue) [ ] (Blue)
[ ] (Yellow) [ ] (Orange)
[]
(Yellow-green)[ ] (Green)
[] (Pink)[] (Red)
[] (White)[ ] (Grey)

215
9. Using Menu Functions
[Histogram]
This allows you to set either to display or not display the
histogram.
You can set the position by pressing 3/4/2/1.
•Direct touch operation is also possible from the recording
screen.
•A histogram is a graph that
displays brightness along the
horizontal axis (black to white)
and the number of pixels at each
brightness level on the vertical
axis.
It allows you to easily check a picture’s exposure.
Adark
Bbright
•When the recorded picture and the histogram do not
match each other under the following conditions, the
histogram is displayed in orange.
–During Exposure Compensation
–When the flash is activated
–When the correct exposure is not achieved, such as
when the lighting is low.
•The histogram is an approximation in the Recording
Mode.
s
[Guide Line]
This will set the pattern of guide lines displayed when
taking a picture.
When [ ] is set, guideline positions can be set by
pressing 3/4/2/1.
•You can also set the position directly by touching [ ] on
the guideline of the recording screen.
•The guideline is not displayed in the Panorama Shot
Mode.
s
> [Custom]
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
216
[Highlight]
When the Auto Review function is
activated or when playing back, white
saturated areas appear blinking in
black and white.
•If there are any white saturated
areas, we recommend compensating the exposure
towards negative (P110) referring to the histogram (P215)
and then taking the picture again. It may result in a better
quality picture.
•This function is disabled during 4K photo playback,
playback of pictures taken with Post Focus, Multi
Playback, Calendar Playback, or Playback Zoom.
s
[Zebra Pattern]
Indicates parts that may be whited out through
overexposure in a zebra pattern.
Select [SET] to set the brightness to be processed as a
zebra pattern.
•You can select a brightness value between [50%] and
[105%]. In [Zebra 2], you can select [OFF]. If you select
[100%] or [105%], only the areas that are already white
saturated are displayed in a zebra pattern. The smaller
the value is, the wider the brightness range to be
processed as a zebra pattern will be.
•If there are any white saturated areas, we recommend
compensating the exposure towards negative (P110)
referring to the histogram (P215) and then taking the
picture.
•Displayed zebra patterns will not be recorded.
•If you assign [Zebra Pattern] to [Fn Button Set] (P58) in
the [Custom] menu, each time you press the function
button to which the setting is assigned, the zebra pattern
toggles as follows:
[Zebra 1] > [Zebra 2] > [OFF].
When [Zebra 2] is set to [OFF], the setting toggles in the
order of [Zebra 1] > [OFF], allowing you to switch the
setting quickly.
s
> [Custom]
MENU
[ZEBRA1] [ZEBRA2]

217
9. Using Menu Functions
[Monochrome Live
View]
You can display the recording screen in black and white.
This function is convenient when a black and white screen
will make it easier to set focus with Manual Focus.
•Even if you use the HDMI output during recording, this
function will not work for the connected device.
•Recorded images will not be affected.
s
[Constant Preview]
You can check the effects of the chosen aperture and
shutter speed on the recording screen in Manual Exposure
Mode.
•This function does not work when using the flash. Close
the flash.
s
[Expo.Meter]
Set whether or not to
display the exposure meter.
AExposure meter
•Set to [ON] to display the Exposure meter when
performing Programme Shift, setting aperture, and setting
shutter speed.
•Unsuitable areas of the range are displayed in red.
•When the Exposure meter is not displayed, switch the
display information for screen by pressing [DISP.].
•If no operations are performed for approximately
4 seconds, the Exposure meter disappears.
s
[Dial Guide]
Set whether or not to
display the dial operation
guide.
s
[LVF Disp.Style] This will set the display style of the viewfinder. P48
[Monitor Disp. Style] This will set the display style of the monitor. P49
[Monitor Info. Disp.] Display the recording information screen. (P49) s
> [Custom]
MENU
60
60
604.0
4.0
4.0
2
00
SS
SS
SS
F
F
0
98
98
98
250 15
4.0 5.6 8.0
3060125
A
989898
0
603.5

9. Using Menu Functions
218
[Rec Area]
This changes the angle of view during motion picture
recording and still picture recording.
•The recording area indicated is an approximation.
•[Rec Area] is not available for 4K photo or [Post Focus]
recording.
s
[Remaining Disp.]
This will switch display between the number of recordable
pictures and available recording time.
•[9999i] is displayed if there are 10000 or more pictures
remaining.
s
[Auto Review]
Displays a picture immediately after it is taken.
If you set [Duration Time] to [HOLD], the picture is
displayed until you press the shutter button halfway.
If you set [Playback Operation Priority] to [ON], you can
perform certain playback operations during Auto Review.
For example, you can switch between different types of
playback screens or delete pictures.
•When [Duration Time] is set to [HOLD], [Playback
Operation Priority] is fixed to [ON].
•When recording with the 4K Photo function or [Post
Focus], settings available for [Duration Time] in [Auto
Review] change to [ON] and [OFF]. [Playback Operation
Priority] is fixed to [ON].
s
[Fn Button Set] You can assign various recording and other functions to
the function buttons. P58
[Q.MENU] If you select [CUSTOM], you can customise the Quick
Menu settings. P57
[Dial Set.] Changes the operation methods of the front dial and rear
dial. P46
[Video Button] Enables/disables the motion picture button. s
[Power Zoom Lens]
Sets the screen display and lens operations when using an
interchangeable lens that is compatible with power zoom
(electrically operated zoom).
P154
> [Custom]
MENU

219
9. Using Menu Functions
[Eye Sensor] Setting the eye sensor sensitivity and the method for
switching between the monitor and viewfinder. P41
[Touch Settings]
Enables/disables the Touch operation.
[Touch Screen]:
All touch operations.
[Touch Tab]:
Operations of tabs, such as [ ] on the right side of the
screen.
[Touch AF]:
Operation to bring the subject you touch into focus ([AF])
or adjust the focus and brightness ([AF+AE]).
[Touch Pad AF]:
Operation to move the AF area by touching the monitor
when the viewfinder is in use. (P104)
s
[Touch Scroll] This allows you to set the speed of continuously forwarding
or rewinding pictures using touch operation. s
[Menu Guide] Sets whether or not to display a selection screen when you
set the mode dial to [ ]/[ ]. s
[Shoot w/o Lens] Sets whether or not the shutter can be released when no
lens is attached to the main body. s
> [Custom]
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
220
: [Setup] menu
> [Setup]
[Online Manual] [URL display]/[QR Code display] s
[Clock Set] Setting Date/Time. P35
[World Time]
Sets the times for the region where you live and your
holiday destination.
•[Destination] can be set after setting up [Home].
After selecting [Destination] or [Home], press 2/1
to select an area, and press [MENU/SET] to set.
“ [Destination]:
Travel destination area
ACurrent time of the
destination area
BTime difference from
home area
– [Home]:
Your home area
CCurrent time
DTime difference from
GMT (Greenwich
Mean Time)
s
[Travel Date]
If you set [Travel Setup], elapsed days of your trip (i.e.
which day of the trip) based on its departure and return
dates will be recorded.
•The travel date is automatically cancelled if the current
date is after the return date.
If the [Travel Setup] is set to [OFF], [Location] will also be
set to [OFF].
If you set [Destination], the name of the travel desination
that you enter will be recorded.
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
s
MENU
A
B
D
C

221
9. Using Menu Functions
[Travel Date]
(continued)
•You can display the elapsed days and travel destination
during playback or stamp them on recorded pictures in
[Text Stamp] (P241).
•The number of days that have passed since the departure
date can be printed out using the software
“PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (P296).
•The travel date is calculated using the date in the clock
setting and the departure date you set. If you set [World
Time] to the travel destination, the travel date is
calculated using the date in the clock setting and the
travel destination setting.
•The [Travel Date] feature is disabled when recording
[AVCHD] motion pictures.
•[Location] cannot be recorded in the following cases:
–When recording motion pictures
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording with [Post Focus]
s
[Wi-Fi]
[Wi-Fi Function] P251
[Wi-Fi Setup] P288
[Beep]
This allows you to set the volume for electronic sound and
the electronic shutter sound.
[Beep Volume]/[E-Shutter Vol]/[E-Shutter Tone]
•When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON], [Beep Volume] and
[E-Shutter Vol] are set to [OFF].
s
[Live View Mode]
Set the frame rate of the recording screen (Live View
screen).
[30fps]:
Reduces the power consumption, extending the operating
time.
[60fps]:
Displays movements smoother.
•When [Live View Mode] is set to [30fps] the image quality
on the recording screen may be worse than when it is set
to [60fps], but this does not affect the recorded image.
•The viewfinder is fixed to [60fps].
s
> [Setup]
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
222
[Monitor Display]/
[Viewfinder]
Brightness, colour, or red or blue tint of the Monitor/
viewfinder is adjusted.
1Select the settings by pressing 3/4, and
adjust with 2/1.
•Adjusting can also be performed by rotating the rear
dial.
2Press [MENU/SET] to set.
•It will adjust the monitor when the monitor is in use, and
the viewfinder when the viewfinder is in use.
•Some subjects may appear differently from actuality on
the monitor. However, this does not affect the recorded
pictures.
s
[Monitor Luminance]
„ [AUTO]:
The brightness is adjusted automatically depending on
how bright it is around the camera.
[MODE1]:
Make the monitor brighter.
[MODE2]:
Set the monitor to the standard brightness.
[MODE3]:
Make the monitor darker.
•Some subjects may appear differently from actuality on
the monitor. However, this does not affect the recorded
pictures.
•The monitor automatically returns to standard brightness
if no operations are performed for 30 seconds when
recording in [MODE1]. It will light up brightly again with
button or touch operation.
•When [AUTO] or [MODE1] is set, the usage time is
reduced.
•[AUTO] is only available in the Recording Mode.
•The initial setting when using the AC adaptor (optional) is
[MODE2].
s
> [Setup]
MENU
…
1
…
2
…
3

223
9. Using Menu Functions
[Economy]
[Sleep Mode]:
The camera is automatically turned off if the camera has
not been used for the time selected on the setting.
[Sleep Mode(Wi-Fi)]:
The camera is automatically turned off if it is not connected
to a Wi-Fi network and has not been used for 15 minutes
(approx.).
[Auto LVF/Monitor Off]:
The monitor/viewfinder is automatically turned off if the
camera has not been used for the time selected on the
setting.
•Press the shutter button halfway or turn the camera off
and on to cancel [Sleep Mode].
•To turn the monitor/viewfinder on again, press any button
or touch the monitor.
•[Economy] does not work in the following cases.
–When connecting to a PC or a printer
–When recording or playing back motion pictures
–During a slide show
–When recording with [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]) of the 4K
Photo function
–When using [Multi Exp.]
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When using [Stop Motion Animation] (only when [Auto
Shooting] is set)
–When using the HDMI output during recording
•When using the AC adaptor (optional), [Sleep Mode] and
[Sleep Mode(Wi-Fi)] are disabled.
•When using the AC adaptor (optional), [Auto LVF/Monitor
Off] is fixed to [5MIN.].
s
[USB Mode]
Sets the communication method when connecting using
the USB connection cable (supplied).
y [Select on connection]:
Select this setting to select the USB communication
system when connecting to another device.
{ [PictBridge(PTP)]:
Select this setting when connecting to a printer supporting
PictBridge.
z [PC]:
Select this setting to export images to a connected PC.
s
> [Setup]
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
224
[TV Connection]
[Video Out]:
Set to match the colour television system in each
country when the HDMI micro cable is connected.
[NTSC]:
Video output is set to NTSC system.
[PAL]:
Video output is set to PAL system.
[HDMI Mode (Play)]:
Set the format for the HDMI output when playing back on
the HDMI compatible high-definition TV connected with
this unit using the HDMI micro cable.
[AUTO]:
The output resolution is automatically set based on
the information from the connected TV.
[4K]:
The progressive method with 2160 available scan
lines and an output resolution of 3840k2160 are
used for output.
[1080p]:
The progressive method with 1080 available scan
lines is used for output.
[1080i]:
The interlace method with 1080 available scan lines
is used for output.
[720p]:
The progressive method with 720 available scan
lines is used for output.
[576p]¢1/[480p]¢2:
The progressive method with 576¢1/480¢2 available
scan lines is used for output.
¢1 When [Video Out] is set to [PAL]
¢2 When [Video Out] is set to [NTSC]
•This will work only during playback.
•If no image appears on the TV with [AUTO], switch the
setting to a constant setting other than [AUTO] to set a
format supported by your TV. (Read the operating
instructions for the TV.)
P292
> [Setup]
MENU

225
9. Using Menu Functions
[TV Connection]
(continued)
[HDMI Info Display (Rec)]:
Sets whether or not to display information when you take
pictures while monitoring the camera image on a device
(TV, etc.) connected with an HDMI micro cable.
•When the camera is connected to a TV, lower the volume
of the TV.
P293
[3D Playback]:
Set the output method for 3D pictures.
[]:
Set when connecting to a 3D compatible television.
[]:
Set when connecting to a television not compatible with
3D.
Set this when you would like to view pictures in 2D
(conventional image) on a 3D compatible television.
P305
[VIERA Link]:
If you select [ON], operations of the camera and the VIERA
Link compatible equipment connected to the camera with
an HDMI micro cable are automatically linked, enabling
you to control the camera with the remote control of the
VIERA Link compatible equipment.
P294
[Menu Resume] Stores the location of the last-used menu item for each
menu. s
[Menu Background] Set the background colour for the menu screen. s
[Menu Information] Descriptions of menu items or their settings are displayed
on the menu screen. s
[Language] Set the language displayed on the screen. s
[Version Disp.]
This enables the firmware versions of the camera and lens
to be checked.
•Press [MENU/SET] on the version display screen to
display information about the software on the unit.
s
[Exposure Comp. Reset] An exposure value can be reset when the Recording Mode
is changed or the camera is turned off. s
[Self Timer Auto Off] Set this item to cancel the self-timer when you turn off the
camera. s
> [Setup]
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
226
[No.Reset]
Reset the file number of the next recording to 0001.
•The folder number is updated and the file number starts
from 0001.
•A folder number between 100 and 999 can be assigned.
The folder number should be reset before it reaches 999.
We recommend formatting the card (P29) after saving the
data on a PC or elsewhere.
•To reset the folder number to 100, format the card first
and then use this function to reset the file number.
A reset screen for the folder number will then appear.
Select [Yes] to reset the folder number.
s
[Reset]
The following settings are reset to the default:
–Recording settings (Except for [Face Recog.] and
[Profile Setup] settings) and drive mode
–Recording settings ([Face Recog.] and [Profile Setup]
settings)
–Setup/custom settings
•When the setup/custom settings are reset, the following
settings are also reset.
–The [World Time] setting
–The settings of [Travel Date] (departure date, return
date, location)
–The settings of [Rotate Disp.], [Picture Sort] and [Delete
Confirmation] in the [Playback] menu
•The folder number and the clock setting are not changed.
s
[Reset Wi-Fi Settings]
Reset all settings in the [Wi-Fi] menu to factory default
settings.
(Excluding [LUMIX CLUB])
•Always reset the camera when disposing or selling it to
prevent personal information saved within the camera
from being misused.
•Always reset the camera after making a copy of personal
information when sending the camera in to be repaired.
s
> [Setup]
MENU

227
9. Using Menu Functions
[Pixel Refresh]
It will perform optimisation of imaging device and image
processing.
•Imaging device and image processing is optimised when
the camera is purchased. Use this function when bright
spots that do not exist in the subject get recorded.
•Turn the camera off and on after the pixels are corrected.
s
[Sensor Cleaning]
Dust reduction to blow off the debris and dust that have
affixed to the front of the imaging device is performed.
•Dust Reduction Function will operate automatically when
the camera is turned on, but you can use this function
when you see dust.
s
[Level Gauge Adjust.]
[Adjust.]:
Hold the camera in a horizontal position, and press
[MENU/SET]. The level gauge will be adjusted.
[Level Gauge Value Reset]:
Restores the default level gauge setting.
s
[Demo Mode] You can try focusing, peaking, etc. in [Post Focus] (P133),
with the image picture. s
[Format] The card is formatted. P29
> [Setup]
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
228
•With [RAW Processing], [Light Composition], [Clear Retouch], [Text Stamp], [Time Lapse
Video], [Stop Motion Video], [Resize] or [Cropping], a new edited picture is created.
A new picture cannot be created if there is no free space on the card so we recommend
checking that there is free space before editing the picture.
•The camera may not play back images recorded on other devices correctly, and the functions
of the camera may not be available for the images.
:[Playback] menu
•[2D/3D Settings] (P229)
•[Slide Show] (P230)
•[Playback Mode] (P232)
•[Location Logging] (P233)
•[RAW Processing] (P234)
•[Light Composition] (P237)
•[Clear Retouch] (P239)
•[Title Edit] (P240)
•[Text Stamp] (P241)
•[Video Divide] (P242)
•[Time Lapse Video] (P243)
•[Stop Motion Video] (P243)
•[Resize] (P244)
•[Cropping] (P245)
•[Rotate] (P246)
•[Rotate Disp.] (P246)
•[Favorite] (P247)
•[Print Set] (P248)
•[Protect] (P249)
•[Face Rec Edit] (P249)
•[Picture Sort] (P250)
•[Delete Confirmation] (P250)

229
9. Using Menu Functions
∫How to select an image(s) after selecting [Single] or [Multi]
•When [Single] and [Multi] are not available, select an image in the same way as when [Single]
is selected.
Playback methods for the 3D pictures can be switched.
> [Playback] > [2D/3D Settings]
•This is a menu that is only displayed when 3D playback is possible. (P305)
[Single] setting
1Press 2/1 to select the picture.
2Press [MENU/SET].
•If [Set/Cancel] is displayed at the right bottom of the
screen, the setting is cancelled when [MENU/SET] is
pressed again.
[Multi] setting
When a screen similar to the one on the right is displayed:
1Press 3/4/2/1 to select the picture and then press
[MENU/SET] (repeat).
•The setting is cancelled when [MENU/SET] is pressed
again.
2Press 2 to select [OK], and then press [MENU/SET]
to execute.
When a screen similar to the one on the right is displayed:
Press 3/4/2/1 to select the picture, and then press
[MENU/SET] to set (repeat).
•The setting is cancelled when [MENU/SET] is pressed again.
[2D/3D Settings]
6HW
2.
1 2 3
4 5 6
6HW&DQFHO
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
230
You can play back the pictures you have taken in synchronisation with music, and you can
do this in sequence while leaving a fixed interval between each of the pictures.
You can also put together a slide show composed of only still pictures, only motion
pictures, etc.
We recommend this feature when you view your pictures by connecting the camera to a
TV.
> [Playback] > [Slide Show]
1Select the group to play back by pressing 3/4, and then press [MENU/SET].
•If you select [Video Only], 4K burst files and images recorded with [Post Focus] will also
be played back.
•Only an in-focus representative image will be played back from pictures recorded using
[Post Focus].
•For details on categories, refer to P232.
2Press 3 to select [Start] and then press [MENU/SET].
∫Operations during a slideshow
[Slide Show]
Button
operation
Touch
operation
Description of
operation
Button
operation
Touch
operation
Description of
operation
3Play/Pause 4Exit slide show
2Back to previous
picture 1Ahead to next picture
Reduce volume level Increase volume
level
MENU

231
9. Using Menu Functions
∫Changing the slide show settings
You can change the settings for slide show playback by selecting [Effect] or [Setup] on the
slide show menu screen.
•Even if [Effect] is set, it does not work during a slide show of 4K burst files, Images recorded
with [Post Focus], or Group Pictures.
•When playing back the following pictures, the [Duration] setting is disabled.
–Motion pictures
–4K burst files
–Images recorded with [Post Focus]
–Panorama pictures
–Group Pictures
[Effect]
This allows you to select the screen effects when switching from one
picture to the next.
•[AUTO] can be used only when [Category Selection] has been selected.
The pictures are played back with the recommended effects in each
category.
[Setup]
[Duration] •[Duration] can be set only when [OFF] has been selected
as the [Effect] setting.
[Repeat] [ON]/[OFF]
[Sound]
[AUTO]:
Music is played when the still pictures are played back,
and audio is played when the motion pictures are played
back.
[Music]:
Music is played back.
[Audio]:
Audio (only for motion pictures) is played back.
[OFF]:
There will be no sound.

9. Using Menu Functions
232
Playback in [Normal Play], [Picture Only], [Video Only], [4K PHOTO], [Post Focus],
[3D Play], [Category Play] or [Favorite Play] can be selected.
> [Playback] > [Playback Mode]
1Select the group to play back by pressing 3/4, and then press [MENU/SET].
•If you select [Video Only], 4K burst files and images recorded with [Post Focus] will also
be played back.
2(When [Category Play] is selected)
Press 3/4/2/1 to select the category and then press [MENU/SET] to set.
•Pictures are sorted into the categories shown below.
[Playback Mode]
–[Face Recog.]
*
–[i-Portrait]/[i-Night Portrait]/[i-Baby] (Scene Detection)
–[Clear Portrait]/[Silky Skin]/[Backlit Softness]/[Clear in Backlight]/[Relaxing
Tone]/[Sweet Child's Face]/[Clear Night Portrait] (Scene Guide Mode)
,
–[i-Scenery]/[i-Sunset] (Scene Detection)
–[Distinct Scenery]/[Bright Blue Sky]/[Romantic Sunset Glow]/[Vivid Sunset
Glow]/[Glistening Water] (Scene Guide Mode)
.
–[i-Night Portrait]/[i-Night Scenery]/[iHandheld Night Shot] (Scene Detection)
–[Clear Nightscape]/[Cool Night Sky]/[Warm Glowing Nightscape]/[Artistic
Nightscape]/[Glittering Illuminations]/[Handheld Night Shot]/[Clear Night
Portrait] (Scene Guide Mode)
–[Clear Sports Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
1– [i-Food] (Scene Detection)
–[Appetizing Food]/[Cute Dessert] (Scene Guide Mode)
–[Travel Date]
–Still pictures recorded continuously with burst speed set to [SH]
–[Time Lapse Shot]/[Time Lapse Video]
–[Stop Motion Animation]/[Stop Motion Video]
MENU

233
9. Using Menu Functions
You can write location information sent from a smartphone (latitude and longitude) on
images.
• You can send location information and write it on images using a smartphone.
(P261)
•You need to install “Panasonic Image App” on your smartphone. (P254)
•Read the [Help] in the “Image App” menu for further details on how to operate.
Preparation:
Sending location information to the camera from the smartphone.
> [Playback] > [Location Logging]
1Press 3/4 to select [Add Location Data], then press [MENU/SET].
2Press 3/4 to select the period you intend to record location information on
images, then press [MENU/SET].
•Images with location information are indicated with [ ].
∫To pause the recording of location information
Press [MENU/SET] while recording of the location information onto images is taking
place.
•During a suspended period, [±] is displayed.
Select the period with [±] to restart the recording process from the picture you left off.
∫To delete the received location information
1Press 3/4 to select [Delete Location Data], then press [MENU/SET].
2Press 3/4 to select the period you want to delete, then press [MENU/SET].
Not available in these cases:
•Location information cannot be written to the following images or in the following situations:
–Images recorded after location information was sent to the camera (P261)
–Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD]
–Images with location information already written to them
[Location Logging]
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
234
You can process the pictures taken in RAW format. The processed pictures will be saved
in JPEG format.
> [Playback] > [RAW Processing]
1Select RAW images with 2/1, and then press [MENU/
SET].
2Press 3/4 to select an item.
•You can set the following items. The settings you used for
the recording are selected when you start setting these
items.
[RAW Processing]
[White Balance]
Allows you to select a White Balance preset and adjust it. If you
select an item with [ ], you can process the image with the setting
at the time of recording.
[Exposure Comp.] Allows you to correct the exposure within the range between j1EV
and i1EV.
[Photo Style] Allows you to select a photo style effect ([Standard]/[Vivid]/[Natural]/
[Monochrome]/[L.Monochrome]/[Scenery]/[Portrait]).
[i.Dynamic] Allows you to select an [i.Dynamic] setting ([HIGH]/[STANDARD]/
[LOW]/[OFF]).
[Contrast] Allows you to adjust the contrast.
[Highlight] Allows you to adjust the brightness of bright portions.
[Shadow] Allows you to adjust the brightness of dark portions.
[Saturation]/[Color
Tone]
Allows you to adjust the saturation. (When [Monochrome] or
[L.Monochrome] is selected in [Photo Style], you can adjust the
colour tone.)
[Filter Effect] Allows you to select a filter effect. (Only when [Monochrome] or
[L.Monochrome] is selected in [Photo Style])
[Noise Reduction] Allows you to adjust the noise reduction setting.
[i.Resolution] Allows you to select an [i.Resolution] setting ([HIGH]/[STANDARD]/
[LOW]/[EXTENDED]/[OFF]).
[Sharpness] Allows you to adjust the resolution effect.
[Setup]
You can set the following items:
[Reinstate Adjustments]:
Returns the settings to the ones you used during the recording.
[Color Space]:
Allows you to select a [Color Space] setting from [sRGB] or [Adobe
RGB].
[Picture Size]:
Allows you to select the size in which the image will be saved in
JPEG format ([L]/[M]/[S]).
MENU

235
9. Using Menu Functions
3Press [MENU/SET] and set.
•Refer to “How to set each item” on P235.
4Press [MENU/SET].
•This operation returns you to the screen in step 2. To set other items, repeat steps 2
through 4.
5Select [Begin Processing] with 3/4, and then press [MENU/SET].
∫How to set each item
When you select an item, the setting screen will be displayed.
•When [Noise Reduction], [i.Resolution] or [Sharpness] is selected, the comparison screen
cannot be displayed.
•If you touch the picture twice, the picture will be enlarged. If you touch the picture twice when it
is enlarged, it will be reduced to the original size.
On the comparison screen, you can use the following operations to make adjustments:
ACurrent setting
•If you touch the picture at the centre, it will be enlarged. If you touch [ ], the picture will be
reduced to the original size.
Button
operation
Touch
operation Description of operation
2/1
/Dragging Selects a setting.
3[WB K
Set]
Displays the screen that lets you
set the colour temperature. (P115)
(only when [White Balance] is set
to [ ])
4[Adjust.]
Displays the screen that lets you
fine-adjust the White Balance.
(P116)
(only when [White Balance] is set)
[DISP.] [DISP.] Displays the comparison screen.
[MENU/SET] [Set] Sets the adjusted level and returns
you to the item selection screen.
Button
operation
Touch
operation Description of operation
2/1
/Dragging Selects a setting.
[DISP.] [DISP.] Returns you to the setting screen.
[MENU/SET] [Set] Sets the adjusted level and returns
you to the item selection screen.
+1+1
-
1
-
100
DISP.
WBWBWBWBWBWBWBWBWBWBWB
AWB
AWB
AWB
AWB
DISP.
DISP.
0
A

9. Using Menu Functions
236
[Setup] setting
When you select an item, the screen that asks you to select [Reinstate Adjustments],
[Color Space], or [Picture Size] will be displayed.
1Press 3/4 to select an item, and press [MENU/SET].
•If you select [Reinstate Adjustments], a confirmation screen will be displayed. Selecting
[Yes] will execute the operation and return you to the item selection screen.
2Press 3/4 to select a setting, and press [MENU/SET].
•The effects applied through the RAW processing on the camera and those applied through the
RAW processing on the software “SILKYPIX Developer Studio” (P297) are not completely
identical.
•RAW images are always recorded in the [4:3] (4592k3448) aspect ratio regardless of the
aspect ratio at the time of recording, but when you perform [RAW Processing] in the [Playback]
menu, they are processed in the aspect ratio at the time of recording.
•The [White Balance] setting of pictures taken with multiple exposures is fixed to the setting at
the time of recording.
Not available in these cases:
•[RAW Processing] is not available when an HDMI micro cable is connected.
•You can process only the RAW images you recorded with the camera.

237
9. Using Menu Functions
Select multiple frames from 4K burst files that you wish to combine. Parts of the image that
are brighter than the preceding frame will be superimposed on the preceding frame to
combine the frames into one picture.
> [Playback] > [Light Composition]
1Press 2/1 to select the 4K photo burst files and press [MENU/SET].
2Choose the combining method, and then press [MENU/SET].
[Light Composition]
[Composite Merging] setting
Select the frames you want to combine to superimpose brighter parts.
1Select the frames.
For information on button and touch operation, refer to
P128.
•Images displayed cannot be enlarged or shrunk or
shown as in slide view.
•[ ] in touch operation becomes [ ].
2Press [MENU/SET].
The selected frames are remembered, and the display
goes to the preview screen.
Press 3/4 to select items and press [MENU/SET] to
perform the following operations.
–[Next]: Lets you select more frames for combining. Goes
back to step 1.
–[Reselect]: Discards the frame selected immediately
before and lets you select a different image.
–[Save]: Ends frame selection
3Repeat steps 1 and 2 to select more frames to combine.
•You can select up to 40 frames.
4Press 4 to select [Save], and then press [MENU/SET].
MENU
1H[W
5HVHOHFW
6DYH

9. Using Menu Functions
238
3Select [Yes] at the confirmation screen, and then press [MENU/SET].
The combined picture is displayed.
•Pictures are saved in JPEG format. Recording information (Exif information) of the first
frame such as shutter speed, aperture, and ISO sensitivity are also registered.
[Range Merging] setting
Select the first and last frames to superimpose the brighter parts of the frames
between them.
1Select the frame of the first picture.
The selection method is the same as in step 1 of [Composite Merging] setting.
2Press [MENU/SET].
The position of the first frame will be saved.
3Select the frame of the last picture.
4Press [MENU/SET].
The position of the last frame will be saved.

239
9. Using Menu Functions
•The erasure operation can only be performed
by touching. [Clear Retouch] automatically
enables the touch operation.
> [Playback] >
[Clear Retouch]
1Press 2/1 to select a picture, and then press
[MENU/SET].
2Drag your finger over the part you want to delete.
•The parts to be erased are coloured.
•Touching [Undo] will return the coloured part back to its
previous state.
3Touch [Set].
4Touch [Save] or press [MENU/SET].
•Pictures may appear unnatural because the background of deleted parts is artificially created.
•For group pictures, perform [Clear Retouch] on each picture.
(They cannot be edited at once.)
•When [Clear Retouch] is performed on group pictures, they are saved as new pictures separate
from the original ones.
Not available in these cases:
•Not available when the viewfinder is in use.
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–Pictures taken in Panorama Shot Mode
–Motion pictures
–4K burst files
–Images recorded with [Post Focus]
–Pictures taken with [ ]
[Clear Retouch]
Erasing details (enlarging the display)
1Touch [SCALING].
•Pinching out/pinching in (P51) the screen allows you
to enlarge/reduce it.
•Enlarge/reduce can also be performed by rotating
the rear dial.
•Dragging the screen allows you to move the
enlarged part.
2Touch [REMOVE].
•This will bring you back to the operation of dragging your finger over the part you
want to delete. The part you want to delete can be dragged even while the picture is
enlarged.
MENU
6HW
6&$/,1*
5(029(
8QGR
8QGR
6&$/,1*
5(029(
6HW

9. Using Menu Functions
240
You can add text (comments) to pictures. After text has been registered, it can be stamped
in prints using [Text Stamp] (P241).
> [Playback] > [Title Edit]
1Select the picture. (P229)
•[’] is displayed for pictures with titles already registered.
2Enter the text. (P61)
•To delete the title, erase all the text in the text input screen.
•You can print out texts (comments) using the software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (P296).
•You can set up to 100 pictures at one time with [Multi].
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–Motion pictures
–4K burst files
–Images recorded with [Post Focus]
–Images recorded with [Quality] set to [ ], [ ] or [ ]
[Title Edit]
MENU

241
9. Using Menu Functions
You can stamp recording information on recorded images.
> [Playback] > [Text Stamp]
1Select the picture. (P229)
•[‘] appears on screen if the picture is stamped with text.
2Press 3/4 to select [Set], and then press [MENU/SET].
3Press [ ] to return to the previous screen.
4Press 3 to select [OK], and then press [MENU/SET].
•When you print pictures stamped with text, the date will be printed over the stamped text if you
specify printing of the date at the photo shop or on the printer.
•You can set up to 100 pictures at one time in [Multi].
•The picture quality may deteriorate when text stamping is carried out.
•When you stamp pictures in a group, the stamped ones are saved separately from the original
ones in the group.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–Motion pictures
–4K burst files
–Images recorded with [Post Focus]
–Pictures taken in Panorama Shot Mode
–Pictures recorded without setting the clock and title
–Pictures stamped with [Text Stamp]
–Pictures taken with [ ]
[Text Stamp]
[Shooting Date] Stamps the recording date.
[Name]
[] ([Face Recognition]):
Name registered in [Face Recog.] will be stamped.
[] ([Baby/Pet]):
Name registered in [Profile Setup] will be stamped.
[Location] Stamps the travel destination name set under [Location].
[Travel Date] Stamps the travel date set under [Travel Date].
[Title] Title input in the [Title Edit] will be stamped.
LISA
LISA
LISA
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
242
Recorded motion picture can be divided in two. It is recommended for when you want to
divide a part you need with a part you do not need.
Dividing a motion picture is permanent. Decide before you divide!
> [Playback] > [Video Divide]
1Press 2/1 to select the motion picture to divide, and then press [MENU/SET].
Not available in these cases:
•Avoid trying to divide motion picture near the very beginning or end of the motion picture.
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–Motion pictures with a short recording time
[Video Divide]
2Press 3 at the location to divide.
•You can finely adjust the location for division by pressing
2/1 while the motion picture is paused.
3Press 4.
•Motion picture may be lost if the card or battery is removed
while processing the dividing.
MENU

243
9. Using Menu Functions
This function allows you to create a motion picture from a picture group recorded with
[Time Lapse Shot].
The created motion picture is saved in MP4 recording format.
> [Playback] > [Time Lapse Video]
1Select the [Time Lapse Shot] picture group with 2/1, and then press [MENU/
SET].
2Create a motion picture by selecting the methods for creating it.
•Refer to step 4 onwards on P142 for details.
Also refer to the notes on P142 for created motion pictures.
A Motion picture is created from group pictures taken with [Stop Motion Animation].
Created motion pictures are saved in MP4 recording format.
> [Playback] > [Stop Motion Video]
1Select the Stop Motion Animation group with 2/1, and then press [MENU/SET].
2Create a motion picture by selecting the methods for creating it.
•Refer to step 7 onwards on P144 for details.
Also refer to the notes on P145 for created motion pictures.
[Time Lapse Video]
[Stop Motion Video]
MENU
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
244
To allow easy posting to web pages, attachment to e-mail etc., picture size (number of
pixels) is reduced.
> [Playback] > [Resize]
•You can set up to 100 pictures at one time in [Multi].
•The picture quality of the resized picture will deteriorate.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–Motion pictures
–4K burst files
–Images recorded with [Post Focus]
–Pictures taken in Panorama Shot Mode
–Group Pictures
–Pictures stamped with [Text Stamp]
–Pictures taken with [ ]
[Resize]
Select the picture and size.
[Single] setting
1Press 2/1 to select the picture, and then press
[MENU/SET].
2Press 3/4 to select the size, and then press
[MENU/SET].
[Multi] setting
1Press 3/4 to select the size, and then press
[MENU/SET].
2Press 3/4/2/1 to select the picture, and then
press [MENU/SET] to set (repeat).
•The setting is cancelled when [MENU/SET] is pressed
again.
3Press 2 to select [OK], and then press [MENU/SET]
to execute.
MENU
16
16
16
8
8
4
4
L
4:3
M
4:3
S
6HW
4:3
2.

245
9. Using Menu Functions
You can enlarge and then clip the important part of the recorded picture.
> [Playback] > [Cropping]
1Press 2/1 to select the picture, and then press [MENU/SET].
2Use the rear dial and press 3/4/2/1 to select the parts to be cropped.
•You can also touch [ ]/[ ] to enlarge/reduce.
•You can also move by dragging on the screen.
3Press [MENU/SET].
•The picture quality of the cropped picture will deteriorate.
•Crop one picture at a time when you want to crop the pictures in a picture group.
(You cannot edit all pictures in a group at once.)
•When you crop pictures in a group, the cropped ones are saved separately from the original
ones in the group.
•Information regarding the Face Recognition in the original picture will not be copied to images
having undergone [Cropping].
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–Motion pictures
–4K burst files
–Images recorded with [Post Focus]
–Pictures taken in Panorama Shot Mode
–Pictures stamped with [Text Stamp]
–Pictures taken with [ ]
[Cropping]
Rear dial (right): Enlargement
Rear dial (left): Reduction
3/4/2/1: Move
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
246
Rotate pictures manually in 90o steps.
•The [Rotate] function is disabled when [Rotate Disp.] is set to [OFF].
> [Playback] > [Rotate]
1Press 2/1 to select the picture and then press [MENU/SET].
2Select the rotation direction.
:
The picture rotates clockwise in steps of 90o.
:
The picture rotates counter-clockwise in steps of 90o.
This mode allows you to display pictures vertically if they were recorded holding the
camera vertically.
> [Playback] > [Rotate Disp.] > [ON]
Not available in these cases:
•When you play back pictures on a PC, they cannot be displayed in the rotated direction unless
the OS or software is compatible with Exif.
Exif is a file format for still pictures which allows recording information etc. to be added. It was
established by “JEITA (Japan Electronics and Information Technology Industries Association)”.
[Rotate] (The picture is rotated manually.)
[Rotate Disp.] (The picture is automatically rotated and displayed.)
MENU
MENU

247
9. Using Menu Functions
You can do the following if a mark has been added to pictures and they have been set as
favourites.
•Play back the pictures set as favourites only as a slide show.
•Play back only the pictures set as favourites. ([Favorite Play])
•Delete all the pictures not set as favourites. ([All Delete Except Favorite])
> [Playback] > [Favorite]
Select the picture. (P229)
∫Cancelling all the [Favorite] settings
Press 3/4 to select [Cancel], and then press [MENU/SET].
•In [Playback Mode], the [Cancel] is disabled.
•You can set up to 999 pictures as favourites.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following case:
–Pictures taken with [ ]
[Favorite]
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
248
DPOF “Digital Print Order Format” is a system that allows the user to select which pictures
to print, how many copies of each picture to print and whether or not to print the recording
date on the pictures when using a DPOF compatible photo printer or photo printing store.
For details, ask at your photo printing store.
•When you set [Print Set] for a group pictures, the print setting for the number of prints will be
applied to every picture in the group.
> [Playback] > [Print Set]
1Select the picture. (P229)
2Press 3/4 to set the number of prints, and then press [MENU/SET] to set.
•When [Multi] has been selected, repeat steps 1 and 2 for each picture.
(It is not possible to use the same setting for a multiple number of pictures.)
•[999+] is displayed on the screen, if the total number of prints you set for a group pictures
is more than 1000 pictures.
∫Cancelling all the [Print Set] settings
Press 3/4 to select [Cancel], and then press [MENU/SET].
∫To print the date
After setting the number of prints, set/cancel printing with the recording date by pressing
1.
•Depending on the photo printing store or the printer, the date may not be printed even if you set
to print the date. For further information, ask at your photo printing store or refer to the
operating instructions for the printer.
•The date print feature is disabled for pictures that are stamped with text.
•The number of prints can be set from 0 to 999.
•Depending on the printer, the date print settings of the printer may take precedence so check if
this is the case.
Not available in these cases:
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–Motion pictures
–4K burst files
–Images recorded with [Post Focus]
–Pictures taken with [ ]
[Print Set]
MENU

249
9. Using Menu Functions
You can set protection for pictures you do not want to delete by mistake.
> [Playback] > [Protect]
Select the picture. (P229)
∫Cancelling all the [Protect] settings
Press 3/4 to select [Cancel], and then press [MENU/SET].
•The [Protect] feature is only designed to work with this camera.
•Even if you protect pictures on a card, they will be deleted if the card is formatted.
You can clear and replace all information relating to face recognition in selected images.
> [Playback] > [Face Rec Edit]
1Press 3/4 to select [REPLACE] or [DELETE], and then press [MENU/SET].
2Press 2/1 to select the picture and then press [MENU/SET].
3Press 2/1 to select the person and then press [MENU/SET].
4(When [REPLACE] is selected)
Press 3/4/2/1 to select the person to replace and then press [MENU/SET].
•Cleared information regarding the [Face Recog.] cannot be restored.
•When all Face Recognition information in a picture has been cancelled, the picture will not be
categorised using Face Recognition in [Category Play].
•The Face Recognition information of pictures in a group has to be edited at once.
(You cannot edit one picture at a time.)
•Editing of group pictures can be performed only on the first picture of each set.
[Protect]
Even if you do not protect pictures on a card, they cannot be deleted when the
card’s Write-Protect switch is set to [LOCK].
[Face Rec Edit]
MENU
MENU

9. Using Menu Functions
250
You can set the order in which the camera displays images during playback.
> [Playback] > [Picture Sort]
•When you insert another card, images may not be displayed by [DATE/TIME] first. The images
will be displayed by [DATE/TIME] if you wait for a while.
This sets which option, [Yes] or [No], will be highlighted first when the confirmation screen
for deleting a picture is displayed.
It is set to [“No” first] at the time of purchase.
> [Playback] > [Delete Confirmation]
[Picture Sort]
[FILE NAME] Displays images by folder name/file name. This display format allows you
to locate images in the card easily.
[DATE/TIME]
Displays images by recording date. If the card contains pictures taken with
more than one camera, this display format is convenient for looking for
images.
[Delete Confirmation]
[“Yes” first] [Yes] is highlighted first, so deletion can be done quickly.
[“No” first] [No] is highlighted first. Accidental deletion of pictures is avoided.
MENU
MENU

251
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
What you can do with the Wi-FiR function
These operating instructions refer to both smartphones and tablets as “smartphones” from
this point on unless noted otherwise.
Controlling with a Smartphone/Tablet (P254)
Recording with a smartphone (P259)
Playing back pictures in the camera
(P260)
Saving images stored in the camera
(P260)
Sending images in the camera to an SNS (P261)
Writing location information on images stored in the camera (P261)
Combining motion pictures recorded with Snap Movie according to
your preference on a smartphone (P263)
Easy connection
You can easily set up a direct connection to your
smartphone without entering a password.
Displaying pictures on a TV (P264)
Printing Wirelessly (P270)
When sending images to AV device (P271)
You can send pictures and motion pictures to AV devices in your house
(home AV devices).
When sending images to PC (P272)
Using Web services (P274)
You can send pictures and motion pictures to an SNS, etc. via “LUMIX
CLUB”.
By using [Cloud Sync. Service], you can receive pictures and motion pictures
on a PC or smartphone.

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
252
Wi-Fi function
∫Before Use
•Set the date and time settings in advance. (P35)
•To use the Wi-Fi function on this unit, a wireless access point or a destination device equipped
with the wireless LAN function is required.
∫About the Wi-Fi connection lamp
∫About the [Wi-Fi] button
In these operating instructions, a function button to which [Wi-Fi] is assigned is referred to
as the [Wi-Fi] button. (At the time of purchase, [Wi-Fi] is assigned to [Fn5].)
•For information about the function button, refer to P58.
Steps for pressing [Wi-Fi]
1Touch [ ].
2Touch [ ].
When the camera is not connected to Wi-Fi, press [Wi-Fi]. The camera will then be
ready to be connected to the smartphone. You can connect the camera directly to
the smartphone. (P255)
•When the camera is ready to be connected, you can press [DISP.] to connect with the same
settings as used previously. This is a convenient and quick way to establish a connection.
(P286)
Lit red: When the Wi-Fi function is ON or connected by
Wi-Fi
Blinking red: When sending picture data
Fn5
Fn6
Fn6
Fn7
Fn6
Fn8
Fn9
SNAP
Fn5

253
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
When the camera is connected to Wi-Fi, you can press [Wi-Fi] and perform the
following operations:
¢1 These items are not displayed when you send the displayed image to a web service by
pressing 4. (P276)
¢2 This is not displayed when the destination of [Remote Shooting & View], [Playback on TV] or
[Send Images Stored in the Camera] is set to [Printer].
∫Describing method
When “select [Select a destination from History]”, etc. is
described in a step, perform any of the following operations.
•The camera cannot be used to connect to a public wireless LAN connection.
•Use a IEEE802.11b, IEEE802.11g or IEEE802.11n compatible device when using a wireless
access point.
•We strongly recommend that you set an encryption to maintain information security.
•It is recommended to use a fully charged battery when sending images.
•When the battery indicator is flashing red, the connection with other equipment may not start or
the connection may be disrupted.
(A message such as [Communication error] is displayed.)
•When sending images on a mobile network, high packet communication fees may be incurred
depending on the details of your contract.
•Pictures may not be completely sent depending on radio wave conditions. If the connection is
terminated while sending pictures, pictures with missing sections may be sent.
•Do not remove the memory card or battery or move to an area without any reception
while sending images.
[Terminate the Connection] Terminates the Wi-Fi connection.
[Change the Destination]¢1Terminates the Wi-Fi connection, and allows you to select
a different Wi-Fi connection.
[Change Settings for Sending
Images]¢2
Refer to P268 for details.
[Register the Current Destination
to Favorite]¢1
Registering the current connection destination or the
connection method, you can easily connect with the same
connection method next time.
[Network Address] Displays the MAC address and IP address of this unit.
Button operation: Select [Select a destination from
History] with the cursor button, and
then press [MENU/SET].
Touch operation: Touch [Select a destination from
History].

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
254
Controlling with a Smartphone/Tablet
With a smartphone, you can record images remotely,
play back images on the camera or save them to the
smartphone.
•You need to install “Panasonic Image App” (referred to as
“Image App” from this point on) on your smartphone.
The “Image App” is an application provided by Panasonic.
•OS
•Use the latest version.
•Supported OSs are current as of April 2016 and are subject to change.
•Read the [Help] in the “Image App” menu for further details on how to operate.
•When you operate the “Image App” on the smartphone that is connected to the camera via
Wi-Fi, [Help] in the “Image App” may not be displayed depending on the smartphone. In this
case, after terminating the connection to the camera, reconnect the smartphone to a mobile
phone network such as the 3G or LTE network or to a Wi-Fi router, and then display [Help] in
the “Image App”.
•Some of the screens and information provided in these operating instructions may differ from
your device depending on the supported OS and “Image App” version.
•The service may not be able to be used properly depending on the type of smartphone being
used.
For information on the “Image App”, refer to the support site below.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/
(This Site is English only.)
•When downloading the app on a mobile network, high packet communication fees may be
incurred depending on the details of your contract.
Installing the smartphone/tablet app “Image App”
App for AndroidTM:Android 4.0 or higher
App for iOS: iOS 7.0 or higher
1Connect the smartphone to a network.
2(Android) Select “Google PlayTM Store”.
(iOS) Select “App Store”.
3Enter “Panasonic Image App” or “LUMIX” into the search box.
4Select “Panasonic Image App” and install it.

255
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
You can easily set up a direct connection to your smartphone without entering a password.
1Select the menu on the camera. (P54)
ASSID
•When the camera is ready to be connected to the
smartphone, the SSID is displayed.
•You can also display the information by pressing [Wi-Fi] on
the camera.
2Turn on the Wi-Fi function in the setting menu of the
smartphone.
3On the Wi-Fi setting screen of the smartphone, select the
SSID displayed on the camera.
4On the smartphone, start “Image App”.
5When the connection confirmation screen is displayed on
the camera, select [Yes] to connect. (For first time
connection only)
•When [Wi-Fi Password] is set to the default setting [OFF], third parties may intercept
Wi-Fi radio waves and collect the content of communications. Set [Wi-Fi Password] to
[ON] to enable the password. (P256, 257)
Connecting to a smartphone/tablet
For both iOS devices (iPhone/iPod touch/iPad) and Android devices
Connecting without using the password
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function]
> [New Connection] > [Remote Shooting & View]
A
MENU
Wi-Fi
0123456789ABC

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
256
Connecting with a password further enhances security. You can scan a QR code or
manually enter a password to set up a connection.
Preparations: Set [Wi-Fi Password] to [ON].
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Setup] > [Wi-Fi Password] > [ON]
1Select the menu on the camera. (P54)
ASSID and password
BQR code
•When the camera is ready to be connected to the
smartphone, the QR code, SSID and password are displayed.
•You can also display the information by pressing [Wi-Fi] on the camera.
2On the smartphone, start “Image App”.
3Select [QR code].
•When the smartphone is connected to a wireless access point, it may take time to display
[QR code].
•(For iOS devices) A confirmation screen will be displayed. Select [OK] to proceed.
4Use the “Image App” to scan the QR code displayed on the screen of the
camera.
•If you press [MENU/SET] on the camera, the QR code will be enlarged. When it is difficult
to scan the QR code, try enlarging it.
5Install the profile to the smartphone.
•If the smartphone is locked with a passcode, enter the passcode to unlock the
smartphone.
6When a message is displayed on the browser, press the home button to close
the browser.
7Turn on the Wi-Fi function in the setting menu of the smartphone.
8On the Wi-Fi setting screen of the smartphone, select the
SSID displayed on the camera.
9On the smartphone, start “Image App”.
•(iOS devices) Steps 2 through 6 are not required from the second
time on.
Using a password to set up a connection
For both iOS devices (iPhone/iPod touch/iPad) and Android devices
Using the QR code to set up a connection
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi
Function] > [New Connection] > [Remote
Shooting & View]
For iOS devices only
MENU
AB
MENU
Wi-Fi
0123456789ABC

257
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
Preparations: Set [Wi-Fi Password] to [ON].
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Setup] > [Wi-Fi Password] > [ON]
1Select the menu on the camera. (P54)
ASSID and password
BQR code
•When the camera is ready to be connected to the
smartphone, the QR code, SSID and password are displayed.
•You can also display the information by pressing [Wi-Fi] on the camera.
2Turn on the Wi-Fi function in the setting menu of the
smartphone.
3On the Wi-Fi setting screen of the smartphone, select the
SSID displayed on the camera.
4Enter the password displayed on the camera into the
smartphone. (For first time connection only)
•If you are using an Android device, marking the box for password
display will allow the device to display the password as you enter it.
5On the smartphone, start “Image App”.
To change the connection method, follow the steps below:
Select the menu. (P54)
or
For both iOS devices (iPhone/iPod touch/iPad) and Android devices
Manually entering a password to set up a connection
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi
Function] > [New Connection] > [Remote
Shooting & View]
For both iOS devices (iPhone/iPod touch/iPad) and Android devices
Changing the connection method
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] >
[New Connection] > [Remote Shooting & View] >
[DISP.] button
> [DISP.] button > [New Connection] >
[Remote Shooting & View] > [DISP.] button
MENU
AB
MENU
Wi-Fi
0123456789ABC
MENU
Wi-Fi

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
258
When connecting via a wireless access point ([Via Network]):
1Select [Via Network].
•Follow the connection procedure described on P283 to connect the camera to a wireless
access point.
2Turn on the Wi-Fi function.
3Connect the smartphone to the wireless access point to which the camera is
connected.
4Start “ Image App”. (P254)
When directly connecting the camera and smartphone ([Direct]):
1Select [Direct].
•Select [Wi-Fi Direct] or [WPS Connection]¢, and follow the connection procedure
described on P285 to connect the camera to the smartphone.
¢WPS is a function that allows you to easily set up a connection with a wireless LAN device
and make security-related settings. To check whether your smartphone supports the
function, refer to the operating instructions of the smartphone.
2Start “ Image App”. (P254)
1Set the camera to Recording Mode.
2Select the camera’s menu items to terminate the
Wi-Fi connection.
•You can also terminate the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi]
on the camera. (P253)
3On the smartphone, close “Image App”.
On the camera
On your smartphone
On the camera
On your smartphone
For both iOS devices (iPhone/iPod touch/iPad) and Android devices
Terminating the connection
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi
Function] > [Yes]
(If you are using an iOS device)
On the screen of “Image App”, press the home button to close the app.
(If you are using an Android device)
On the screen of “Image App”, press the return button twice to close the app.
MENU

259
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
1Connect to a smartphone. (P255)
2Operate the smartphone.
•When recording with 4K Pre-Burst with the smartphone,
terminate the connection only after switching to 4K Burst
recording by pressing [ ] on the camera.
Not available in these cases:
•In the following case, remote recording does not work:
–Panorama Shot Mode
–When using [Time Lapse Shot]
–When [Snap Movie] is set to [ON]
∫Taking a picture while jumping
When you hold your smartphone and jump, the camera’s
shutter can be released automatically as the smartphone
detects the peak of the jump. This function is convenient for
taking a picture while jumping.
Operate the smartphone.
[]>[]>Select the sensitivity.
•[ ] will be displayed on the remote recording screen of the
smartphone.
•We recommend that you take test pictures to determine the camera’s angle and how hard you
jump and to make any desired adjustments.
•For details, refer to the help section in the “Image App” menu.
Taking images via a smartphone/tablet (remote recording)
1Select [ ].
2Record an image.
•The recorded images are saved in the camera.
•Some settings are not available.

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
260
1Connect to a smartphone. (P255)
2Operate the smartphone.
•When you play a motion picture, the camera transmits it to the “Image App” at a reduced data
size. As a result, its image quality differs from that of the actual recorded motion picture. In
addition, depending on the smartphone or conditions of use, the image quality may deteriorate
or the sound may skip during motion picture or picture playback.
1Connect to a smartphone. (P255)
2Operate the smartphone.
•Pictures in RAW format, AVCHD motion pictures, MP4 motion pictures with a [Rec Quality] size
of [4K], 4K burst files, and images recorded with [Post Focus] cannot be saved.
•3D pictures (MPO format) will be saved as 2D pictures (JPEG format).
Playing back images in the camera
1Select [ ].
•You can switch the images to be
displayed by selecting the icon (A)
on the top left of the screen. To
display images stored in the camera,
select [LUMIX].
2Touch the image to enlarge it.
Saving images stored in the camera
1Select [ ].
•You can switch the images to be
displayed by selecting the icon (A)
on the top left of the screen. To
display images stored in the camera,
select [LUMIX].
2Touch and hold an image, and drag
it to save it.

261
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
1Connect to a smartphone. (P255)
2Operate the smartphone.
You can send location information acquired with a smartphone to the camera. After
sending the information, you can also write it on images stored in the camera.
•Once the location information is sent to the camera, you can also write it on images by
performing [Location Logging] (P233) in the [Playback] menu.
•Location information different from that at the time of recording may be written. Keep the
following points in mind:
–Set the camera’s [Home] setting in [World Time] to your region.
–Once you start recording location information with your smartphone, do not change the
camera’s [Home] setting in [World Time].
•Location information cannot be written on images that were recorded when the clock was not
set.
Sending images in the camera to an SNS
1Select [ ].
•You can switch the images to be
displayed by selecting the icon (A)
on the top left of the screen. To
display images stored in the camera,
select [LUMIX].
2Touch and hold an image, and drag
it to send it to an SNS, etc.
•The image is sent to a web service
such as an SNS.
Adding location information to images stored in the camera from a
smartphone/tablet
AStart recording location
information
BStart recording images
CFinish recording the location
information
DSending and writing location
information
2
1
4
3
GPS

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
262
∫Recording location information and images
1Start recording location information with the smartphone.
2Record images with the camera.
3Stop recording the location information with the smartphone.
∫Writing the location information to the images
(Preparation on the camera)
Connect to a smartphone. (P255)
4Operate the smartphone.
•Cautions for Use:
Be sure to pay special attention to the privacy, the likeness rights, etc. of the subject
when you use this function. Use at your own risk.
•The smartphone battery drains faster while location information is being recorded.
When recording of location information is not necessary, stop it.
•On the smartphone, you can set the acquisition interval of location information and check the
transfer status of location information.
Refer to [Help] in the “Image App” menu for details.
Not available in these cases:
•Location information cannot be written to the following images or in the following situations:
–Images recorded after location information was sent to the camera
–Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD]
–Images with location information already written to them
1 Start “Image App”. (P254)
2 Select [ ].
3 Select [Geotagging].
4 Select [ ] to start recording location information.
1 Select [ ] to stop recording the location information.
1 Start “Image App”. (P254)
2 Select [ ].
3 Select [Geotagging].
4 Select [ ] to send and write the location information.
•Follow the on-screen messages to operate the smartphone.
•Images with location information are indicated with [ ].

263
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
Using a smartphone, you can combine motion pictures recorded with the camera’s [Snap
Movie] function (P176). Music can be added to motion pictures to be combined. In
addition, you can save the combined motion picture or upload it on a web service.
ARecord motion pictures with [Snap Movie].
BSend the recorded motion pictures.
CEdit the motion pictures.
DCombine the motion pictures, save the combined motion picture, and send it to a web
service.
ECombine the motion pictures, and save the combined motion picture.
∫Combining motion pictures by operating a smartphone
1Connect to a smartphone. (P255)
2Operate the smartphone.
•[Snap Movie] of the “Image App” requires a smartphone that supports Android OS 4.3 or
higher.
•The iPhone 4 does not support [Snap Movie] of the “Image App”.
Combining motion pictures recorded with Snap Movie according to
your preference on a smartphone/tablet
1Select [ ].
2Select [Snap Movie].
•[Snap Movie] motion pictures with recent recording dates will be selected and
automatically sent to the smartphone.
•When motion pictures with recent recording dates are not available, a screen that
lets you select motion pictures will be displayed. Select motion pictures and send
them.
3Edit the motion pictures.
•Operate the smartphone to edit the motion pictures, such as rearranging them,
deleting those that are unnecessary or adding music to them.
•You can combine the edited motion pictures and save the combined file on the
smartphone or upload it on a web service.
•Read the [Help] in the “Image App” menu for further details on how to operate.

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
264
Displaying pictures on a TV
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Select [Via Network] or [Direct], and connect. (P282)
3Select a device you want to connect.
•When the connection is established, the screen is displayed.
4Take or play back pictures on this unit.
•To terminate the connection, follow the steps below:
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] > [Yes]
(You can also terminate the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi]. (P253))
•If you display pictures using the Wi-Fi function, they cannot be output in 4K resolution. To
output them in 4K resolution, connect the camera and the TV with an HDMI micro cable. (P292)
•When a TV is connected to this unit, the TV screen may temporarily return to the status before
the connection. Pictures are displayed again when you take or play back pictures.
•[Effect] and [Sound] of the Slide Show are disabled.
Not available in these cases:
•Motion pictures and 4K burst files cannot be played back.
•During Multi Playback, Calendar Playback or when selecting the focus area of an image
recorded with [Post Focus], images displayed on the camera are not displayed on the TV.
You can display pictures on a TV that supports the
Digital Media Renderer (DMR) function of the DLNA
standard.
Preparations
Set the TV to DLNA waiting mode.
•Read the operating instructions for your TV.
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] > [New Connection] >
[Playback on TV]
MENU
MENU

265
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
Sending images
When sending images, select the method for sending them after selecting [New
Connection].
After the connection has been completed, settings for sending, such as the image size for
sending, can also be changed.
∫Images that can be sent
¢1 Sending by [Send Images While Recording] is not available.
¢2 A motion picture recorded in [AVCHD] can be sent to [PC] if the file size is 4 GB or smaller. It
cannot be sent if the size is greater than 4 GB.
¢3 Excluding motion pictures recorded with their size set to [4K] in [Rec Quality]
•Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device.
•Refer to the manual of the destination equipment or the web service for more information on
how to playback pictures.
Destination JPEG RAW MP4¢1AVCHD¢1, 2
4K Burst File¢1
Pictures recorded in [Post
Focus]¢1
3D
[Smartphone] (P269) ±—±¢3———
[PC] (P272) ±± ± ± ± ±
[Cloud Sync. Service]
(P277) ±—±¢3——±
[Web service] (P274) ±—±¢3——±
[AV device] (P271) ±—— — — ±
[Printer]¢1 (P270) ±—— — — —

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
266
A picture can be automatically sent to a specified device every time you take it.
•When connected with [Send Images While Recording], [ ] is
displayed on the recording screen, and [ ] is displayed while
sending a file.
•To terminate the connection, follow the steps below:
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] > [Yes]
•You can terminate the connection or change the send settings
by pressing [Wi-Fi]. (P253)
You cannot change the settings while sending pictures. Wait until sending is complete.
•Since the camera gives priority to recording, sending may take longer during the recording.
•If you turn off this unit or the Wi-Fi connection before sending is complete, unsent pictures will
not be resent.
•You may not be able to delete files or use the playback menu while sending.
Not available in these cases:
•You cannot send motion pictures, 4K burst files recorded with the 4K Photo function, and
pictures recorded in [Post Focus].
Send Images While Recording
5
5
MENU

267
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
Images can be selected and sent after recording.
∫How to select an image(s) after selecting [Single Select] or [Multi Select]
•Details of the playback menu [Favorite] or [Print Set] settings will not be sent.
Not available in these cases:
•Some images taken with a different camera may not be able to be sent.
•Images that have been modified or edited with a computer may not be able to be sent.
Send Images Stored in the Camera
[Single Select] setting
1Select the picture.
2Select [Set].
[Multi Select] setting
1Select the picture. (repeat)
•The setting is cancelled when the picture is selected
again.
2Select [OK].
•The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select]
is limited.
•To change the send settings on a screen that is displayed after the image has been sent,
press [DISP.]. To terminate the connection, select [Exit].
6HW
2.

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
268
Pressing [DISP.] after completing a connection allows you to change the settings for
sending such as the image size for sending.
¢1 Only available when the destination is set to [Web service].
¢2 Only available when the destination is set to [PC].
¢3 Only available when the destination is set to [Cloud Sync. Service] or [Web service].
¢4 Only available when the destination is set to [Cloud Sync. Service].
Changing the settings for sending images
[Size]
Resize the image to send.
[Original]/[Auto]¢1/[Change]
•If you select [Auto], the image size is determined by the
circumstances at the destination.
•You can select the image size for [Change] from [M], [S] or [VGA].
The aspect ratio does not change.
[File Format]¢2[JPG]/[RAWiJPG]/[RAW]
[Delete Location
Data]¢3
Select whether to delete the location information from images before
sending them.
[ON]: Delete the location information, then send.
[OFF]: Keep the location information and send.
•This operation only deletes the location information from the images
that are set to be sent.
(The location information will not be deleted from the original images
stored in this unit.)
[Cloud Limit]¢4
You can select whether to send images when the Cloud Folder runs
out of free space.
[ON]: Do not send images.
[OFF]: Delete images from the oldest ones, then send new images.

269
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
Sending images to a smartphone/tablet
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Select [Via Network] or [Direct], and connect. (P282)
3Select a device you want to connect.
4Check the send settings, and select [Set].
•To change the send setting, press [DISP.]. (P268)
Preparations
•Install the “Image App” in advance. (P254)
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] > [New Connection] >
[Send Images While Recording] or [Send Images Stored in the Camera] >
[Smartphone]
On your smartphone
When connecting with [Via Network]:
1Turn on the Wi-Fi function.
2Select the wireless access point you want to connect to, and set.
3Start “Image App”. (P254)
When connecting with [Wi-Fi Direct] or [WPS Connection] in [Direct]:
1Start “Image App”. (P254)
When connecting with [Manual Connection] in [Direct]:
1Turn on the Wi-Fi function.
2Select the SSID that matches the one displayed on the screen of this unit.
3Start “Image App”. (P254)
5When [Send Images While Recording] has been selected
Take pictures. (P266)
When [Send Images Stored in the Camera] has been selected
Select the picture. (P267)
MENU

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
270
Printing Wirelessly
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Select [Via Network] or [Direct], and connect. (P282)
3Select a printer you want to connect.
4Select pictures, and then print.
•The procedure for selecting pictures is the same as the one for when the USB connection
cable is connected. (P302)
•To terminate the connection, press [ ].
(You can also terminate the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi]. (P253))
Not available in these cases:
•Motion pictures, 4K burst files, and pictures recorded with [Post Focus] cannot be printed.
You can send images to a compatible printer, and print
them wirelessly.
Preparations
To print out recorded pictures wirelessly, you must use a printer that supports PictBridge
(wireless LAN)¢.
¢Compliant with the DPS over IP standards.
•For details on the PictBridge (wireless LAN-compatible) printer, contact the respective
company.
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] > [New Connection] >
[Send Images Stored in the Camera] > [Printer]
MENU

271
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
When sending images to AV device
You can send pictures and motion pictures to AV devices in your house (home AV
devices).
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Select [Via Network] or [Direct], and connect. (P282)
3Select a device you want to connect.
4Check the send settings, and select [Set].
•To change the send setting, press [DISP.]. (P268)
•Sending may fail depending on the operational status of the AV device. Also, sending may take
a while.
AWireless access point BHome AV device
Preparations
When sending a picture to AV devices, set your device to DLNA waiting mode.
•Read the operating instructions of your device for details.
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] > [New Connection] >
[Send Images While Recording] or [Send Images Stored in the Camera] >
[AV device]
5When [Send Images While Recording] has been selected
Take pictures. (P266)
When [Send Images Stored in the Camera] has been selected
Select the picture. (P267)
MENU

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
272
When sending images to PC
•Create a PC user account [account name (up to 254 characters) and password (up to
32 characters)] consisting of alphanumeric characters. An attempt to create a receive folder
may fail if the account includes non-alphanumeric characters.
∫When using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
1Install “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” to the PC. (P296)
2Create a folder that receives images with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”.
•To create the folder automatically, select [Auto-create]. To specify a folder, create a new
folder, or set a password to the folder, select [Create manually].
•For details, refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF).
∫When not using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
(For Windows)
Supported OS: Windows 7/Windows 8/Windows 8.1/Windows 10
Example: Windows 7
1Select a folder you intend to use for receiving, then right-click.
2Select [Properties], then enable sharing of the folder.
•For details, refer to the operating instructions of your PC or Help on the OS.
You can send pictures and motion pictures recorded
with this unit to a PC.
Preparations
(On the camera)
•If the workgroup of the destination PC has
been changed from the standard setting, you
also need to change the setting of this unit in
[PC Connection]. (P288)
(On your PC)
•Turn the computer on.
•Prepare folders for receiving images on the
PC before sending a picture to the PC.
(P272)
To create a folder that receives images

273
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
(For Mac)
Supported OS: OS X v10.5 to v10.11
Example: OS X v10.8
1Select a folder you intend to use for receiving, then click on the items in the
following order.
[File] [Get Info]
2Enable sharing of the folder.
•For details, refer to the operating instructions of your PC or Help on the OS.
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Select [Via Network] or [Direct], and connect. (P282)
3Select the PC you want to connect to.
•When the PC you want to connect to is not displayed, select [Manual Input], and enter the
computer name of the PC (NetBIOS name for Apple Mac computers).
4Select the folder you want to send.
5Check the send settings, and select [Set].
•To change the send setting, press [DISP.]. (P268)
•Folders sorted by the sent date are created in the specified folder, and pictures are saved in
those folders.
•If the screen for a user account and password entry appears, enter the one you set on your PC.
•When the computer name (NetBIOS name for Apple Mac computers) contains a space (blank
character), etc., it may not be recognised correctly.
If a connection attempt fails, we recommend that you change the computer name (or NetBIOS
name) to the one consisting of only alphanumeric characters, with a maximum of
15 characters.
•When the firewall of the OS, security software, etc. is enabled, connecting to the PC may not
be possible.
Sending images to the PC
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] > [New Connection] >
[Send Images While Recording] or [Send Images Stored in the Camera] >
[PC]
6When [Send Images While Recording] has been selected
Take pictures. (P266)
When [Send Images Stored in the Camera] has been selected
Select the picture. (P267)
MENU

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
274
Using Web services
You can send pictures and motion pictures to an SNS, etc. via “LUMIX CLUB”.
By setting up automatic transfers of pictures and motion pictures to the Cloud Sync
Service, you can receive the transferred pictures or motion pictures on a PC or
smartphone.
•Images uploaded to the web service cannot be displayed or deleted with this camera. Check
images by accessing the web service with your smartphone or computer.
•If sending images fails, a report email outlining the failure will be sent to the email address
registered with “LUMIX CLUB”.
•Images may contain personal information that can be used to identify the user, such as a
title, the time and date when the images was taken, and the location where the image
was taken. Check this information before uploading images to web services.
AWireless access point BWeb service CCloud Sync Service
Preparations
To send images to a web service or a cloud folder, you need to register to “LUMIX
CLUB” (P278).
To send images to a web service, you need to register the web service. (P275)
When sending images to web service P274
When sending images to [Cloud Sync. Service] P277
When sending images to web service
•Panasonic assumes no responsibility for the damages resulting from the leakage, loss, etc.
of images uploaded on web services.
•When uploading images to the web service, do not delete images from this camera, even
after they have finished sending, until you have checked that they have been properly
uploaded to the web service. Panasonic assumes no responsibility for the damages
resulting from the deletion of images stored in this unit.
LUMIX CLUB

275
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
When sending images to web services, the web service being used must be registered
with the “LUMIX CLUB”. (P278)
•Check the “FAQ/Contact us” on the following site for compatible web services.
http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/lumix_faqs/
Preparation:
Make sure that you have created an account on the web service you want to use, and
have the login information available.
1Connect to the “LUMIX CLUB” site using a smartphone or computer.
http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/
2Enter your “LUMIX CLUB” login ID and password and log in to the service.
(P278)
3Register your email address.
4Select the web service to be used and register it.
•Follow the instructions on the screen to register the service.
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Select [Via Network], and connect. (P282)
3Select a web service.
4Check the send settings, and select [Set].
•To change the send setting, press [DISP.]. (P268)
Registering web services
Sending images
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] > [New Connection] >
[Send Images While Recording] or [Send Images Stored in the Camera] >
[Web service]
5When [Send Images While Recording] has been selected
Take pictures. (P266)
When [Send Images Stored in the Camera] has been selected
Select the picture. (P267)
MENU

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
276
∫Sending images in the camera to a web service with simple operations
Once you send an image, you can send other images to a web service with simple,
smartphone-like operations in an environment where a wireless access point connection is
available.
(The instructions below assume that you are already registered to “LUMIX CLUB”
and the camera has a record of a connection to a wireless access point.)
1Display an image.
2Press 4.
(When group pictures are selected, press 3, and select
[Upload(Wi-Fi)] or [Upload All(Wi-Fi)].)
•The same operation can be performed by touching [ ].
(When group pictures are selected, select [Upload(Wi-Fi)]
or [Upload All(Wi-Fi)] after touch [ ], [ ], [ ], or
[ ], and then touch [ ].)
3Select [Yes] on the confirmation screen.
4Select a web service.
5Check the send settings, and select [Set].
•The camera will connect to a previously connected wireless access point and sends the
image to a web service.
•To change the send setting, press [DISP.]. (P268)
•Step 4, 5 are not necessary when you continue to send another image.
The image will be sent to the same web service with the same send settings.
•To terminate the connection, press [MENU/SET] or operate other controls to exit the
playback screen. You can also terminate the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi]. (P253)
To change the settings for sending images or web service
Terminate the Wi-Fi connection, and follow step 1 and onwards again.
•You can also change the send settings by pressing [Wi-Fi] while using a Wi-Fi connection.
(P253)
•If the camera has no records of connections to wireless access points that are available, a
screen that asks you to select a connection method is displayed. Select a connection method,
and connect the camera to a wireless access point. (P283)
•When you are not registered to “LUMIX CLUB”, a screen that asks you to acquire a new login
ID is displayed. Acquire a login ID and set a password. (P278)
•When group pictures are displayed continuously, all pictures in the group will be sent. When
group pictures are displayed one by one, the currently displayed picture will be sent.
SUB
MENU

277
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
∫Using [Cloud Sync. Service] (As of April 2016)
•If you set the picture destination to [Cloud Sync. Service], sent pictures are temporarily saved
in the cloud folder, and they can be synchronised with the device in use, such as the PC or
smartphone.
•A Cloud Folder stores transferred images for 30 days (up to 1000 pictures). Transferred images
are deleted automatically 30 days after the transfer. Furthermore, when the number of stored
images exceeds 1000, some images may be deleted depending on the [Cloud Limit] (P268)
setting even within 30 days after the transfer.
•When the download of images from a Cloud Folder to all specified devices is complete, images
may be deleted from the Cloud Folder even within 30 days after the transfer.
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Select [Via Network], and connect. (P282)
3Check the send settings, and select [Set].
•To change the send setting, press [DISP.]. (P268)
When sending images to [Cloud Sync. Service]
Preparations
You need to register to “LUMIX CLUB” (P278) and configure the Cloud Sync. setting to
send a picture to a Cloud Folder.
For a PC, use “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (P296) to set up Cloud Sync settings. For a
smartphone, use “Image App” to set them up.
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] > [New Connection] >
[Send Images While Recording] or [Send Images Stored in the Camera] >
[Cloud Sync. Service]
4When [Send Images While Recording] has been selected
Take pictures. (P266)
When [Send Images Stored in the Camera] has been selected
Select the picture. (P267)
MENU

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
278
Registering to the “LUMIX CLUB”
If you register this unit to the “LUMIX CLUB”, you can synchronise images between the
devices you are using, or transfer these images to web services.
Use the “LUMIX CLUB” when uploading pictures to web services.
Acquire a “LUMIX CLUB” login ID (free).
•You can set the same “LUMIX CLUB” login ID for this unit and a smartphone. (P280)
1Select the menu. (P54)
•Connect to the network.
Proceed to the next page by selecting [Next].
•A confirmation screen will be displayed if a login ID has already been acquired for the
camera. Select [Yes] to acquire a new login ID, or [No] if you do not need to acquire a new
login ID.
2Select the method for connecting to a wireless access point, and set. (P283)
•A setting screen will be displayed only when connecting for the first time.
Once you set the connection method, it will be saved on this unit and used when
connecting the next time. To change the wireless access point you want to connect to,
press [DISP.], and change the connection destination.
•Proceed to the next page by selecting [Next].
3Read through the “LUMIX CLUB” terms of use and select [Agree].
•You can switch pages by 3/4.
•You can enlarge (2k) the display by rotating the rear dial to the right.
•You can reset the enlarged display to its original size (1k) by rotating the rear dial to the
left.
•You can move the position of the enlarged display with 3/4/2/1.
•Press [ ] to cancel the process without acquiring a login ID.
About the [LUMIX CLUB]
Refer to the “LUMIX CLUB” site for details.
http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/
Please note:
•The service may be suspended due to regular maintenance or unexpected troubles, and
the service contents may be changed or added, without prior notice to the users.
•The service may be stopped in whole or in part with a reasonable period of advance notice.
Acquiring a new login ID ([New account])
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Setup] > [LUMIX CLUB] > [Set/Add
Account] > [New account]
MENU

279
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
4Enter a password.
•Enter any combination of 8 to 16 characters and numbers for the password.
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
5Check the login ID and select [OK].
•Be sure to make a note of the login ID and password.
•The login ID (12-digit number) will be displayed
automatically.
When logging in to the “LUMIX CLUB” with a computer,
you only need to enter the numbers.
•A message is displayed when the connection is complete.
Select [OK].
Preparation:
When using the acquired login ID, check the ID and password.
To change the “LUMIX CLUB” password on the camera, access the “LUMIX CLUB”
website from your smartphone or PC and change the “LUMIX CLUB” password in
advance.
•The login ID and password registered to the “LUMIX CLUB” cannot be changed on this unit.
1Select the menu. (P54)
•The login ID and password are displayed.
•The password is displayed as “ ”.
•Close the menu if only checking the login ID.
2Select the item to change.
3Enter the login ID or password.
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
•Enter the new password you have created on your
smartphone or PC into the camera. If the password differs
from the one you created on your smartphone or PC, you
will not be able to upload images.
Using the acquired login ID/Checking or changing the login ID or password ([Set
Login ID])
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Setup] > [LUMIX CLUB] > [Set/Add
Account] > [Set Login ID]
MENU

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
280
Setting the same login ID on this unit and your smartphone is convenient for sending
images on this unit to other devices or web services.
Check the details if the terms of use have been updated.
Select the menu. (P54)
•The camera will connect to the network and the terms of use will be displayed.
Close the menu after checking the terms of use.
To set the same login ID for the camera and the smartphone/tablet
When either this unit or the smartphone/tablet has acquired the login ID:
1Connect this unit to the smartphone. (P255)
2From the “Image App” menu, set the common login ID.
•The login IDs for this unit and the smartphone become the same.
•After connecting this unit to the smartphone, the setup screen for a common login ID may
appear when you display the playback screen. You can also set a common login ID by
following the on-screen instructions.
•This operation is not available for [Wi-Fi Direct] connection.
When this unit and the smartphone/tablet have acquired different login IDs:
(When you want to use the smartphone’s login ID for this unit)
Change the login ID and password for this unit to those acquired by the
smartphone.
(When you want to use this unit’s login ID for the smartphone)
Change the login ID and password for the smartphone to those acquired by this
unit.
Check the “LUMIX CLUB” terms of use
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Setup] > [LUMIX CLUB] >
[Terms of use]
MENU

281
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
Delete the login ID from the camera when transferring it to another party or disposing of it.
You can also delete your “LUMIX CLUB” account.
1Select the menu. (P54)
•The message is displayed. Select [Next].
2Select [Yes] in the login ID delete confirmation screen.
•The message is displayed. Select [Next].
3Select [Yes] on the confirmation screen for deleting the “LUMIX CLUB”
account.
•If you want to continue using the service, selecting [No] will only delete the login ID.
Exit the menu after it is executed.
4Select [Next].
•The login ID is deleted, and then the message notifying the deletion of your account is
displayed. Select [OK].
•Changes and other actions to login IDs can only be made to the login ID acquired with the
camera.
Delete your login ID and account from the “LUMIX CLUB”
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Setup] > [LUMIX CLUB] > [Delete
account]
MENU

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
282
About Connections
If you have selected [New Connection], select a Wi-Fi function and destination first, and
then select a connection method.
If you have selected [Select a destination from History] or [Select a destination from
Favorite], you can connect with the same Wi-Fi connection settings as used previously.
This section describes connection methods.
•When connecting with the same settings as used previously, refer to P286.
When a screen similar to the one below is displayed, select a connection method.
•Example of operation for displaying a screen:
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] > [New Connection] > [Send
Images While Recording] > [Smartphone]
Performing a direct connection is convenient for when you are in a place away from home
where wireless access points are not available or for when connecting temporarily to a
device you do not usually use.
Wireless access point
[Via Network] Connects via a wireless access point. P283
[Direct] Your device connects directly to this unit. P285
MENU

283
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
You can select the method for connecting to a wireless
access point.
¢WPS refers to a function that allows you to easily configure
the settings related to the connection and security of wireless
LAN devices.
To check if the wireless access point you are using is
compatible with WPS, refer to the manual of the wireless
access point.
Connecting via a wireless access point (via the network)
[WPS (Push-Button)]
Save push button type wireless access point that is compatible with
Wi-Fi Protected SetupTM with a WPS mark.
Press the wireless access point
WPS button until it switches to WPS
mode.
•Refer to the wireless access point
instruction manual for details.
e.g.:
[WPS (PIN code)]
Save PIN code type wireless access point that is compatible with
Wi-Fi Protected Setup with a WPS mark.
1On the camera screen, select the wireless access
point you are connecting to.
2Enter the PIN code displayed on the camera screen
into the wireless access point.
3Press [MENU/SET] of the camera.
•Refer to the wireless access point instruction manual for
details.
[From List]
Select this option when you are not sure about the WPS
compatibility, or when you want to search for and connect to a
wireless access point. (P284)

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
284
Search for available wireless access points.
•Confirm encryption key of the selected wireless access point if the network authentication is
encrypted.
•When connecting by [Manual Input], confirm SSID, encryption type, encryption key of the
wireless access point you are using.
1Select the wireless access point you are connecting
to.
•Pressing [DISP. ] will search for a wireless access point
again.
•If no wireless access point is found, refer to “When
connecting with [Manual Input]” on P284.
2(If network authentication is encrypted)
Enter the encryption key.
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
∫When connecting with [Manual Input]
1On the screen displayed in step 1 of “If you are not sure about the WPS
compatibility (connecting by [From List])”, select [Manual Input].
2Enter the SSID of the wireless access point you are connecting to, then select
[Set].
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
3Select the network authentication type.
•For information on network authentication, see the manual of the wireless access point.
4Select the encryption type.
•The type of settings that can be changed may vary depending on the details of network
authentication settings.
5(When an option other than [No Encryption] is selected)
Enter the encryption key.
If you are not sure about the WPS compatibility (connecting by [From List])
Network authentication type Encryption types that can be set
[WPA2-PSK] [TKIP]/[AES]
[WPA-PSK] [TKIP]/[AES]
[Common Key] [WEP]
[Open] [No Encryption]/[WEP]

285
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
•Check the wireless access points instruction manual and settings when saving a wireless
access point.
•If no connection can be established, the wireless access point’s radio waves may be too weak.
Refer to “Message Display” (P316) and “Troubleshooting” (P318) for details.
•Depending on your environment, transmission speed between the camera and wireless access
point may decrease. In addition, the wireless access point may not be available for use.
You can select the method for connecting to the device you
are using.
Select the connection method supported by your device.
•Please also refer to the operating instructions of the device to be connected.
Connecting the camera and another device directly (direct connection)
[Wi-Fi Direct]
1Set the device to Wi-Fi DirectR mode.
2On the camera screen, select [Wi-Fi Direct].
3On the camera screen, select the device to connect to.
[WPS Connection]
[WPS (Push-Button)]
1On the camera, select [WPS (Push-Button)].
2Set the device to WPS mode.
•You can wait longer for a connection by pressing [DISP.] on this
unit.
[WPS (PIN code)]
1On the camera, select [WPS (PIN code)].
2Enter the PIN code of the device into this camera.
[Manual Connection]
Enter the SSID and password into
the device. The SSID and
password are displayed on the
connection waiting screen of this
unit.
•If the destination is set to
[Smartphone], the password is not
displayed. Select the SSID to establish a connection. (P255)

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
286
When the Wi-Fi function is used, a record is saved in the history. You can register records
as favourites. Using the history or favourites list, you can easily connect with the same
settings as used previously.
Check to see if the Wi-Fi settings of the device to connect to are the same as used
previously.
•If the settings of the device to connect to have been changed, it may not be possible to connect
to the device.
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Select [Select a destination from History] or
[Select a destination from Favorite].
3Select item.
•If the device you want to connect to (smartphone, etc.) is
connected to a wireless access point other than the
camera, you cannot connect the device to the camera
using [Direct]. Change the Wi-Fi settings of the device
you want to connect to so that the access point to be
used is set to the camera.
You can also select [New Connection] and reconnect the devices. (P255)
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Select the history you want to register to favourites, and then press 1.
3Enter a registration name.
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
•A maximum of 30 characters can be entered. A two-byte character is treated as two
characters.
Connecting quickly with the same settings as the previous ones
([Select a destination from History]/[Select a destination from Favorite])
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function]
[Select a destination from
History]
Connects with the same
settings as the previous
ones.
[Select a destination from
Favorite]
Connects with settings
registered as favourites.
Registering records as favourites
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] >
[Select a destination from History]
MENU
MENU

287
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
1Select the menu. (P54)
2Select the favourite history you want to edit, and then press 1.
•Performing [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] clears the history and the contents saved in [Select a
destination from Favorite].
•When connecting to a network to which many PCs are connected by using [Select a destination
from History] or [Select a destination from Favorite], a connection attempt may fail because the
previously-connected device will be identified from among many devices.
If a connection attempt fails, reconnect by using [New Connection].
Editing the history registered to favourites
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Function] >
[Select a destination from Favorite]
[Remove from Favorite] —
[Change the Order in
Favorite]
Select the destination.
[Change the Registered
Name]
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
•A maximum of 30 characters can be entered. A two-byte
character is treated as two characters.
Save frequently-used Wi-Fi connection settings as favourites
The number that can be saved in the history is limited.
We recommend that you save frequently-used Wi-Fi connection settings by registering
them as favourites. (P286)
Checking the connection detail of a record or favourite
If [DISP.] is pressed when selecting an item in the history or favourites, the detail of the
connection can be displayed.
MENU

10. Using the Wi-Fi function
288
[Wi-Fi Setup] Menu
Configure the settings required for the Wi-Fi function.
The settings cannot be changed when connected to Wi-Fi.
Select the menu. (P54)
•When [ON] is selected, you can also set up a connection by scanning a QR code. (P256)
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
•If you are using the PC with standard settings, you do not need to change the workgroup.
> [Setup] > [Wi-Fi] > [Wi-Fi Setup] > Desired item to be set
[Wi-Fi Password]
You can improve security by enabling password entry for a direct
connection to a smartphone.
[ON]:
Connects the camera and a smartphone using an SSID and
password. (P256)
[OFF]:
Connects the camera and a smartphone using an SSID. (P255)
[LUMIX CLUB] Acquires or changes the “LUMIX CLUB” login ID. (P278)
[PC Connection]
You can set the workgroup.
To send images to a PC, a connection to the same workgroup as
the destination PC is required.
(The default setting is “WORKGROUP”.)
[Change Workgroup Name]:
Enter the workgroup of the connecting PC.
[Restore to Default]:
Restores the default state.
[Device Name]
You can change the name (SSID) of this unit.
1Press [DISP.].
2Enter the desired device name.
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
•A maximum of 32 characters can be entered.
MENU

289
10. Using the Wi-Fi function
•For information on how to enter characters, refer to P61.
•Make a copy of password.
If you forget the password, you can reset it with [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] in the [Setup] menu,
however other settings will also be reset. (excluding [LUMIX CLUB])
•A “MAC Address” is a unique address that is used to identify network equipment.
•“IP address” refers to a number that identifies a PC connected to a network such as the
Internet. Usually, the addresses for homes are automatically assigned by the DHCP function
such as a wireless access point. (Example: 192.168.0.87)
[Wi-Fi Function Lock]
To prevent incorrect operation or use of the Wi-Fi function by a
third party and to protect saved personal information, it is
recommended that you protect the Wi-Fi function with a
password.
Setting a password will automatically display the password input
screen when the Wi-Fi function is used.
[Setup]:
Enter any 4-digit numbers as the password.
[Cancel]
[Network Address] Displays the MAC address and IP address of this unit.

290
11. Connecting to other equipment
Watching 4K motion pictures on a TV/ Saving
4K motion pictures on your PC or recorder
∫Playing Back on a TV Screen
By connecting the camera to a TV that supports motion pictures in
4K and playing back motion pictures recorded with their size set to
[4K] in [Rec Quality], you can enjoy finely-detailed motion pictures
in 4K. Even though the output resolution will be lower, you can also
play them back by connecting the camera to a TV that does not support motion pictures in
4K.
•When connecting to a TV that does not support 4K motion picture, select [AUTO].
Connect the camera and a 4K-compatible TV with an HDMI micro cable,
and display the playback screen. (P292)
•When [VIERA Link] is set to [ON] and the camera is connected to a TV supporting VIERA Link,
input of the TV will be switched automatically and playback screen will be displayed. (P294)
•You can also play back MP4 motion pictures with a [Rec Quality] size
of [4K] by inserting the card into the SD card slot of a TV that supports
4K motion picture.
•Read the operating instructions for the TV.
∫Watching on a PC
•To play back motion pictures recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K] on a PC, use the
software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (P296).
•To play back and edit motion pictures in 4K, you need a high-performance PC
environment.
•Refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF).
Watching motion pictures in 4K
Preparation: Set [HDMI Mode (Play)] (P224) to [AUTO] or [4K].

291
11. Connecting to other equipment
∫Storing on a PC
Refer to P295 for details.
∫Storing on a Hard Disk or DVD
You cannot dub motion pictures recorded with their size set to [4K] in [Rec Quality] to
Blu-ray discs and DVDs with Panasonic recorders. (As of April 2016)
You can use the software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (P296) to convert the file size of a motion
picture to a smaller size or copy it to a DVD.
•Refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF).
Storing 4K motion pictures

11. Connecting to other equipment
292
Playing Back Pictures on a TV Screen
You can view pictures on a TV screen by connecting your camera to your TV with the
HDMI micro cable.
Preparations: Turn this unit and the TV off.
1Connect the camera and a TV.
•Check the direction of the terminals and plug in/out straight holding onto the plug.
(It may result in malfunction by the deforming of the terminal if it is plugged in obliquely
or in wrong direction.)
Do not connect devices to incorrect terminals. Doing so may cause malfunction.
2Turn on the TV and select the input to match the connector in use.
3Turn the camera on and then press [(].
•Depending on the [Aspect Ratio], black bands may be displayed on the top and bottom or the
left and right of the pictures.
•Change the screen mode on your TV if the picture is displayed with the top or bottom cut off.
•HDMI output will be cancelled if a USB connection cable (supplied) is connected
simultaneously.
•You can view pictures on TVs in other countries (regions) which use the NTSC or PAL system
when you set [Video Out] in the [Setup] menu.
•Depending on the TV to be connected, 4K burst files may not be played back correctly.
•No sound is output from the camera speakers.
•Read the operating instructions for the TV.
AHDMI socket (on the TV)
BHDMI micro cable
C[HDMI] socket (on the camera)
•Use a “High Speed HDMI micro cable” with the HDMI logo.
Cables that do not comply with the HDMI standards will not work.
“High Speed HDMI micro cable” (Type D–Type A plug, up to 2 m (6.6 feet) long)
•Check the [HDMI Mode (Play)]. (P224)
•During 24p motion picture playback, please set [HDMI Mode (Play)] to [AUTO].
For settings other than [AUTO], it cannot output at 24 frames/second.
•No picture is displayed on the screen of this unit.
HDMI

293
11. Connecting to other equipment
When using the HDMI output, you can record pictures and
motion pictures while monitoring the camera image on an
external monitor, TV or similar device.
∫Switching the information displayed
You can change the display shown during HDMI output using
[HDMI Info Display (Rec)] (P225) in [TV Connection] on the
[Setup] menu.
•When you perform recording during HDMI output, the [Rec Quality] setting in the [Motion
Picture] menu is applied to images. If the connected device does not support the setting, the
optimal setting for the device will be automatically selected for the HDMI output image quality.
•When the camera is connected to an external monitor or a TV that supports 4K motion
picture, if you use one of the following settings, the angle of view becomes even narrower than
normal:
–[4K/100M/25p]/[4K/100M/24p] in [Rec Quality]
–[4K Live Cropping]
•When using the Auto Focus Mode [ ] or MF assist, the screen cannot be enlarged in
windowed mode.
•Ex. Tele Conv. (motion picture) does not work (excluding Creative Motion Picture Mode).
•[Aspect Ratio] in the [Rec] menu is fixed to [16:9].
•[VGA/4M/25p] in [Rec Quality] is not available.
•Electronic sounds and electronic shutter sounds are muted.
•If you set up a Wi-Fi connection while using the HDMI output, no image will be displayed on the
camera monitor.
•The scene selection screen in Scene Guide Mode is not output through the HDMI connection.
•This function is not available in the following cases:
–During panorama picture recording
–When recording 4K photos
–When recording using [Post Focus]
The recorded pictures can be played back on a TV with an SD Memory Card
slot
•Depending on the TV model, pictures may not be displayed on the full screen.
•The file format of the motion pictures that can be played back differs depending on the TV
model.
•In some cases, panorama pictures cannot be played back. Also, auto-scroll playback of
panorama pictures may not work.
•For cards compatible with playback, refer to the operating instructions of the TV.
Recording while monitoring camera images
[ON]: The camera display is output as is.
[OFF]: Only images are output.

11. Connecting to other equipment
294
Preparations:
Set the [VIERA Link] to [ON]. (P225)
1Connect this unit to a Panasonic TV compatible with VIERA Link with
an HDMI micro cable (P292).
2Turn the camera on and then press [(].
3Operate with the remote control for the TV.
Turning this unit off:
If you use the remote control for the TV to turn the TV off, this unit is also turned off.
Automatic input switching:
•If you connect with an HDMI micro cable and then turn this unit on, and then press [(], the
input channel on the TV automatically switches to this unit’s screen. If the TV’s power is in
standby status, it will turn on automatically (if [Set] has been selected for the TV’s [Power on
link] setting).
•Operation using the buttons on this unit will be limited.
•To play back the sound of a film during a slide show, set [Sound] to [AUTO] or [Audio] on the
Slide Show setting screen.
•Use a “High Speed HDMI micro cable” with the HDMI logo.
Cables that do not comply with the HDMI standards will not work.
“High Speed HDMI micro cable” (Type D–Type A plug, up to 2 m (6.6 feet) long)
•If VIERA Link does not work properly, refer to P326.
Using VIERA Link (HDMI)
What is the VIERA Link (HDMI) (HDAVI Control™)?
•This function allows you to use your remote control for the Panasonic TV for easy
operations when this unit has been connected to a VIERA Link compatible device using an
HDMI micro cable for automatic linked operations.
(Not all operations are possible.)
•VIERA Link is a unique Panasonic function built on an HDMI control function using the
standard HDMI CEC (Consumer Electronics Control) specification.
Linked operations with HDMI CEC compatible devices made by other companies are not
guaranteed. When using devices made by other companies that are compatible with
VIERA Link, refer to the operating instructions for the respective devices.
•This unit supports “VIERA Link Ver.5” function. “VIERA Link Ver.5” is the standard for
Panasonic’s VIERA Link compatible equipment. This standard is compatible with
Panasonic’s conventional VIERA Link equipment.

295
11. Connecting to other equipment
Saving still pictures and motion pictures on
your PC
You can acquire recorded pictures to a PC by connecting the camera and the PC.
•Some PCs can read directly from the card removed from the camera. For details, refer to the
operating instructions of your PC.
∫PC that can be used
The unit can be connected to any PC capable of recognising a mass storage device.
•Windows support: Windows 7/Windows 8/Windows 8.1/Windows 10
•Mac support: OS X v10.5 to v10.11
AVCHD motion pictures may not be imported correctly when copied as files or
folder
•When using Windows, import AVCHD motion pictures with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (P296).
•With a Mac, AVCHD motion pictures can be imported using “iMovie”.
Please note that importing is not possible depending on the picture quality.
(For details about iMovie, please contact Apple Inc.)

11. Connecting to other equipment
296
Download and install software to edit and play back images with a PC.
This software allows you to manage images. For example, you can send pictures and
motion pictures to a PC and sort them by recording date or model name. You can also
perform operations such as writing images to a DVD, processing and correcting images,
and editing motion pictures.
Check the site below to download and install the software.
Download the software while it is available for download.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/soft/download/d_pfs99pe.html
(This Site is English only.)
•Download expiration: May 2021
•Operating environment
•Refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF file) for further operating
environment.
Downloading software
PHOTOfunSTUDIO 9.9 PE
OS
WindowsR 7 (32bit/64bit) SP1,
WindowsR 8 (32bit/64bit),
WindowsR 8.1 (32bit/64bit),
WindowsR 10 (32bit/64bit)
CPU
WindowsR 7
PentiumR 4 (2.8 GHz or higher)
WindowsR 8
WindowsR 8.1
WindowsR 10
Display 1024k768 pixels or more (1920k1080 pixels or more recommended)
RAM
WindowsR 7
1 GB or more (32bit)
2 GB or more (64bit)
WindowsR 8
WindowsR 8.1
WindowsR 10
Free hard disk
space 450 MB or more for installing software

297
11. Connecting to other equipment
This is software to edit RAW format images.
Edited images can be saved in a format (JPEG, TIFF, etc.) that can be displayed on a
personal computer.
Check the site below to download and install the software.
http://www.isl.co.jp/SILKYPIX/english/p/
•Operating environment
•For details on how to use the “SILKYPIX Developer Studio”, refer to the “Help” or the
Ichikawa Soft Laboratory’s support website.
This software allows you to edit motion pictures with ease.
Check the site below to download and install the software.
http://loilo.tv/product/20
•Only the trial version will be installed.
•For more information on how to use LoiLoScope, read the LoiLoScope manual available for
download at the site.
•To download the software, you need to connect the PC to the Internet.
•It may take some time to download the software depending on the communication
environment.
SILKYPIX Developer Studio SE
OS
Windows
WindowsR 7,
WindowsR 8,
WindowsR 8.1,
WindowsR 10
Mac Mac OS X v10.6 to v10.11
LoiLoScope 30 day full trial version
(Windows 7/Windows 8/Windows 8.1/Windows 10)

11. Connecting to other equipment
298
Preparations:
Install “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” to the PC. (P296)
1Connect the computer and camera with the USB connection cable
(supplied).
•Please turn this unit on and your PC before connecting.
•Check the direction of the terminals and plug in/out straight holding onto the plug.
(It may result in malfunction by the deforming of the terminal if it is plugged in obliquely
or in wrong direction.)
Do not connect devices to incorrect terminals. Doing so may cause malfunction.
•Do not use any other USB connection cables except the supplied one.
A[CHARGE] socket
BUSB connection cable (supplied)
2Press 3/4 to select [PC], and then press [MENU/SET].
•If [USB Mode] (P223) is set to [PC] in the [Setup] menu in advance, the camera will be
automatically connected to the PC without displaying the [USB Mode] selection screen.
3Copy the images to a PC using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”.
•Do not delete or move copied files or folders in Windows Explorer.
When viewing in “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”, you will not be able to play back or edit.
•Use a battery with sufficient battery power or the AC adaptor (optional). If the remaining battery
power becomes low while the camera and the PC are communicating, the status indicator
blinks and the alarm beeps.
Disconnect the USB connection cable safely. Otherwise, data may be destroyed.
•Before inserting or removing a card, turn the camera off and disconnect the USB connection
cable. Otherwise, data may be destroyed.
Transferring images to a PC

299
11. Connecting to other equipment
∫Copying to a PC without using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
If you are not able to install “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”, you can copy files and folders to your
PC by dragging and dropping files from this unit.
•The content (folder structure) on the card of this unit is as follows.
•A new folder is created when pictures are taken in the following situations.
–After [No.Reset] (P226) in the [Setup] menu has been executed
–When a card containing a folder with the same folder number has been inserted
(such as when pictures were taken using another maker of camera)
–When there is a picture with file number 999 inside the folder
For Windows: A drive ([LUMIX]) is displayed in [Computer]
For Mac: A drive ([LUMIX]) is displayed on the desktop
•Card
DCIM: Images
1Folder number
2Colour space P: sRGB
_: AdobeRGB
3File number
4JPG: Still pictures
MP4: [MP4] Motion pictures
RW2: Pictures in RAW files
MPO: 3D pictures
MISC: DPOF print
Favourite
AVCHD: [AVCHD] Motion pictures
AVCHD
DCIM
100_PANA
101_PANA
999_PANA
P1000001.JPG
P1000002.JPG
P1000999.JPG
PRIVATE
MISC

11. Connecting to other equipment
300
Saving still pictures and motion pictures on a
Recorder
If you insert card holding content recorded with this unit into a
Panasonic recorder, you can dub the content to a Blu-ray Disc or
DVD etc.
Methods to export still pictures and motion pictures to other
devices will vary depending on the file format. (JPEG, RAW,
MPO, AVCHD, or MP4).
•You cannot dub 4K burst files (MP4 format) with [Aspect Ratio] set to an option other than
[16:9] to hard disk drives, including those of Panasonic recorders. (As of April 2016)
•See the operating instructions for the recorder about the details about copying and playing
back.

301
11. Connecting to other equipment
Printing the Pictures
If you connect the camera to a printer supporting PictBridge, you can select the pictures to
be printed out and instruct that printing be started on the camera’s monitor.
•Group pictures will not be displayed as group pictures but as single pictures.
•Some printers can print directly from the card removed from the camera. For details, refer to
the operating instructions of your printer.
Preparations:
Turn on the camera and the printer.
Perform the print quality and other settings at the printer before printing the pictures.
1Press [(] on the camera.
2Connect the printer and camera with the USB connection cable
(supplied).
•Check the direction of the terminals and plug in/out straight holding onto the plug.
(It may result in malfunction by the deforming of the terminal if it is plugged in obliquely
or in wrong direction.)
Do not connect devices to incorrect terminals. Doing so may cause malfunction.
•Do not use any other USB connection cables except the supplied one.
A[CHARGE] socket
BUSB connection cable (supplied)
3Press 3/4 to select [PictBridge(PTP)], and then press [MENU/SET].

11. Connecting to other equipment
302
•Disconnect the USB connection cable after printing.
•Use a battery with sufficient battery power or the AC adaptor (optional). If the remaining battery
power becomes low while the camera and the printer are connected, the status indicator blinks
and the alarm beeps. If this happens during printing, stop printing at once. If not printing,
disconnect the USB connection cable.
•Do not disconnect the USB connection cable while [å] (Cable disconnect prohibit icon) is
displayed.
(May not be displayed depending on the type of printer used.)
•Before inserting or removing a card, turn the camera off, and disconnect the USB connection
cable.
Not available in these cases:
•Motion pictures, 4K burst files, and pictures recorded with [Post Focus] cannot be printed.
1Press 2/1 to select the picture and then press
[MENU/SET].
2Press 3 to select [Print start] and then press [MENU/
SET].
1Press 3.
2Press 3/4 to select an item and then press [MENU/SET].
3Press 3 to select [Print start] and then press [MENU/SET].
Selecting a single picture and printing it
Selecting multiple pictures and printing them
[Multi Select]
Multiple pictures are printed at one time.
•Press 3/4/2/1 to select the pictures and then press [MENU/
SET].
(When [MENU/SET] is pressed again, the setting is cancelled.)
•After the pictures have been selected, press 2 to select [OK], and
then press [MENU/SET].
[Select All] Prints all the stored pictures.
[Print Set (DPOF)] Prints the pictures set in [Print Set] only. (P248)
[Favorite] Prints the pictures set as favourites only. (P247)
0XOWL3ULQW
3ULQW
PictBridge
PictBridge

303
11. Connecting to other equipment
∫Print Settings
Select and set the items both on the screen in step 2 of the “Selecting a single picture and
printing it” and in step 3 of the “Selecting multiple pictures and printing them” procedures.
•When you want to print pictures on a paper size or a layout which is not supported by the
camera, set [Paper Size] or [Page Layout] to [{] and then set the paper size or the layout on
the printer.
(For details, refer to the operating instructions of the printer.)
•If the printer does not support date printing, the date cannot be printed on the picture.
•Depending on the printer, the date print settings of the printer may take precedence so check if
this is the case.
•The camera is receiving an error message from the printer when the [¥] indication lights
orange during printing. After finishing printing, make sure there are no problems with the
printer.
[Print with Date] Sets date printing.
[Num.of prints] Sets the number of pictures to be printed (up to 999 pictures).
[Paper Size] Sets the paper size.
[Page Layout] Sets whether or not to add borders and how many pictures to be
printed on each sheet of paper.

11. Connecting to other equipment
304
Enjoying 3D pictures
Attaching the 3D interchangeable lens (H-FT012: optional) to the camera allows you to
take 3D pictures for extra impact.
1Attach the 3D interchangeable lens to the camera.
2Bring the subject into the frame and record by pressing the shutter
button fully.
•Focusing is not required when recording 3D pictures.
•Still pictures recorded with the 3D interchangeable lens attached are saved in MPO
format (3D).
•It is recommended to use a tripod or a flash to record steady pictures.
•Up to approx. 3990 3D pictures can be recorded on a 16 GB card.
(When the aspect ratio is set to [4:3], and the quality is set to [ ].)
•Read the operating instructions of the 3D interchangeable lens for details.
•You cannot record 3D pictures in vertical orientation.
•When a distance to the subject is 0.6 m (2.0 feet) to approximately 1 m (3.3 feet), horizontal
disparity becomes too great, and you may not see the 3D effect at the edges of the image.
Taking 3D pictures
To ensure that the 3D pictures can be safely viewed, pay attention to the
following points when recording.
•Where possible, record with the unit in a horizontal state.
•The suggested minimum subject distance is 0.6 m (2.0 feet).
•Be careful not to shake the camera while in a vehicle or walking.

305
11. Connecting to other equipment
Connecting the camera to a 3D compatible television and playing back pictures taken in
3D allows you to enjoy 3D pictures for extra impact.
Connect the unit to a 3D compatible television using the HDMI micro cable
and display the playback screen. (P292)
•When [VIERA Link] is set to [ON] and the camera is connected to a TV supporting VIERA Link,
input of the TV will be switched automatically and playback screen will be displayed. (P294)
•For the pictures recorded in 3D, [ ] will appear on the thumbnail display at playback.
∫Switch the playback method for the still pictures recorded in 3D
1Select the picture recorded in 3D.
2Select [2D/3D Settings] on the [Playback] menu. (P54)
•Playback method will switch to 3D if it is playing back in 2D (conventional image), or it will
switch to 2D if it is playing back in 3D.
•If you feel tired, uncomfortable or otherwise strange when playing back pictures recorded
in 3D, set to 2D.
•It is also possible to play back the recorded 3D pictures by inserting an SD card into the 3D
compatible television with an SD card slot.
•A black screen is displayed for a few seconds when switching playback back and forth from 3D
to 2D pictures.
•When you select a 3D picture thumbnail, it may take a few seconds for playback to start. After
playback, the thumbnail display may take a few seconds to reappear.
•When viewing 3D pictures, your eyes may become tired if you are too close to the television
screen.
•If your television does not switch to a 3D picture, make the necessary settings on the TV.
(For details, refer to the operating instructions of the TV.)
•3D pictures can be saved to your computer or Panasonic devices. (P295, 300)
Playing back 3D pictures
Preparations: Set the [HDMI Mode (Play)] to [AUTO], [1080p] or [1080i]. (P224)
Set the [3D Playback] to [ ]. (P225)

11. Connecting to other equipment
306
∫Functions that cannot be used during 3D recording
When recording with the 3D interchangeable lens (H-FT012: optional), the following
feature will be disabled:
(Recording functions)
•[Glistening Water]/[Glittering Illuminations]/[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
•[Rough Monochrome]/[Impressive Art]/[High Dynamic]/[Toy Effect]/[Toy Pop]/[Star Filter]/[One
Point Color]/[Sunshine] (Creative Control Mode)
•Defocus control function
¢1 The motion picture button, Creative Video Mode and the [Motion Picture] menu will be
unavailable or unusable.
([Rec] menu)
•[Simultaneous record w/o filter] in [Filter Settings]/[Picture Size]¢2/[Quality]¢3/[Focus Mode]/
[SH] of [Burst Rate]/Aperture Bracket, Focus Bracket, and White Balance Bracket in [Bracket]/
[i.Dynamic]/[i.Resolution]/[Post Focus]/[iHandheld Night Shot]/[iHDR]/[HDR]/[Multi Exp.]/
[Panorama Settings]/[Red-Eye Removal]/[Shading Comp.]/[Ex. Tele Conv.]/[Digital Zoom]
¢2 The setting is fixed as shown below.
¢3 When attaching 3D interchangeable lens, the following icons are displayed.
([Custom] menu)
•[AF/AE Lock]/[Shutter AF]/[Quick AF]/[Eye Sensor AF]/[Pinpoint AF Time]/[Pinpoint AF
Display]/[AF Assist Lamp]/[Direct Focus Area]/[Focus/Release Priority]/[AF+MF]/[MF Assist]/
[MF Assist Display]/[MF Guide]/[Rec Area]/[Remaining Disp.]/[Video Button]/[Power Zoom
Lens]/[Touch AF] ([Touch Settings])/[Touch Pad AF] ([Touch Settings])
∫Functions that cannot be used during 3D picture playback
During the 3D playback of 3D pictures on a 3D-compatible TV, the following functions are
disabled.
•Editing functions in the [Playback] menu (menu functions other than [Slide Show]/[Playback
Mode])
Functions that cannot be used on 3D pictures
•Auto Focus/Manual Focus operation •Aperture setting
•Zoom operation •Recording motion pictures¢1
•4K Photo recording •Panorama Shot Mode
Aspect ratio Picture size Aspect ratio Picture size
[4:3] 1824k1368 [16:9] 1824k1024
[3:2] 1824k1216 [1:1] 1712k1712
[]
([3D+Fine])
Both MPO images and fine JPEG images are recorded
simultaneously.
[]
([3D+Standard])
Both MPO images and standard JPEG images are recorded
simultaneously.
•[Highlight] ([Custom] menu) •Playback Zoom

307
12. Others
Optional accessories
•Some optional accessories may not be available in some countries.
After attaching the flash (DMW-FL200L, DMW-FL360L, DMW-FL580L:
optional), the effective range will be increased when compared to the
camera’s built in flash.
Preparations:
•Turn off the camera and close the built-in flash.
•To change the settings for external flashes on the camera, refer to P158.
•Refer to P163 about the settings for the wireless flash.
External Flash (optional)
Removing the Hot Shoe Cover
The camera comes with a hot shoe cover attached to the hot shoe.
Remove the hot shoe cover by pulling it in the direction
indicated by arrow 2 while pressing it in the direction
indicated by arrow 1.
•Keep the Hot Shoe Cover out of reach of children to prevent
swallowing.
When using other commercially available external flashes without
communication functions with the camera
•It is necessary to set the exposure on the external flash. If you want to use the external flash
in Auto Mode, use an external flash that allows you to set the aperture value and the ISO
sensitivity to match the settings on the camera.
•Set to Aperture-Priority AE Mode or Manual Exposure Mode on the camera and then set the
same aperture value and ISO sensitivity on the external flash. (The exposure cannot be
compensated adequately due to the change on the aperture value in Shutter-Priority AE
Mode and the external flash cannot control the light adequately in Programme AE Mode
because the aperture value cannot be fixed.)

12. Others
308
•When an external flash is attached, the following functions are available in addition to the
functions available with the built-in flash.
–Burst recording (when a setting other than [SH] is selected for [Burst Rate])
–Aperture Bracket
–Focus Bracket
•You can set the aperture value, the shutter speed and the ISO sensitivity on the camera even
when attaching the external flash.
•If you record at close range with a wide angle, light from the flash may be blocked by the lens,
darkening the lower part of the screen.
•Do not use commercially available external flashes with high-voltage synchro terminals,
reverse polarity or functions that enable them to communicate with the camera. Doing so may
cause the camera to malfunction or operate incorrectly.
•When attaching the external flash, do not hold only the external flash because it may detach
from the camera.
•Read the operating instructions of the external flash for details.
By using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional), you can record and play
back without worrying about the remaining battery charge.
The optional DC coupler can only be used with the designated Panasonic AC adaptor
(optional).
•Always use a genuine Panasonic AC adaptor (optional).
•When using an AC adaptor (optional), use the AC cable supplied with the AC adaptor.
•Also read the operating instructions for the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler.
The MC protector is a transparent filter which affects neither the colours nor the amount of
light, so it can always be used to protect the camera’s lens.
The ND filter reduces the amount of light to approximately 1/8th (equal to adjusting the
aperture value 3 increments) without affecting the colour balance.
PL filter will suppress the reflected light from a metal or non spherical surfaces (flat
non-metallic surfaces, water vapour or invisible particles in the air), making it possible to
take a picture with enhanced contrast.
•Do not attach multiple filters at the same time.
•You can attach the lens cap or the lens hood when the filter is attached.
•If you have difficulty attaching or removing the PL filter on the interchangeable lens (H-H020A),
we recommend that you attach or remove the filter with the camera power turned on and the
Focus Mode set to [MF].
•Refer to the instructions for each filter for details.
AC adaptor (optional)/DC coupler (optional)
Filters (optional)

309
12. Others
Monitor Display/Viewfinder Display
•The following images are examples of when the display screen is set to [ ] (monitor
style) in the monitor.
In recording
BKT
BKT
BKT
BKT
BKT
BKT
98
98
98
2
00
00
2
00
2
00
60
60
603.5
3.5
3.5
AFS
AFS
AFS
BKT
BKT
BKT
L
4:3
0
0
AEL
AEL
AEL
BKT
BKT
BKT
AWB
AWB
AWB
50p
ラュン
ラュン
ISO
ISO
SS
SS
SS
F
F
MINI
MINI
MINIMINI
Fn5
Fn5
Fn5Fn5
Fn6
Fn6
Fn6Fn6
Fn7
Fn7
Fn7Fn7
Fn8
Fn8
Fn8Fn8
Fn9
Fn9
Fn9Fn9
SNAP
SNAP
SNAP
×
×
1
Recording Mode (P43)
Custom settings (P91)
Photo Style (P188)
‰Œ
Flash Mode (P159)
Flash (P161, 164)
Extra Tele Conversion (when
recording motion pictures)
(P151)
Recording format/Recording
quality (P168)
Snap Movie (P176)
Picture size/Aspect Ratio
(P192)
Extra Tele Conversion (when
taking still pictures) (P151)
P
C2
1
EXPSEXPS
WL
50p
50p
SNAP
4SEC
L
4:3
EXM
4:3
Image size (Panorama Shot
Mode) (P78)
Image effect (filter) adjustment
display (P86, 190)
Image effect (filter) setting
(P190)
Card (displayed only during
recording) (P28)
Elapsed recording time¢1 (P166)
Simultaneous recording
indicator (P174)
Automatic viewfinder/monitor
switching (P40)
Peaking (P214)
Highlight Shadow (P195)
HDR (P197)/iHDR (P66)
Multi exposure (P198)
Digital Zoom (P153)
Electronic shutter (P199)
Picture Mode (Photo Priority)
(P174)
Overheat indicator (P320, 321)
STD. WIDE
EXPS
8
m
30
s
ラュン

12. Others
310
2
A›Quality (P193)
Focus Mode (P95, 106)
Focus Bracket (P140)
Post Focus (P131)
š
ØAF Mode (P97)
Pull Focus (P178)
Face Recognition (P204)
AF Lock (P109)
Burst (P135)
4K Photo (P118)
Self-timer (P137)
Battery indication (P22)
Image Stabiliser (P146)
Jitter alert (P147)
Recording state (Flashes red.)/
Focus (Lights green.) (P42)
Focus (Under low illumination)
(P93)
Focus (Starlight AF) (P93)
Connected to Wi-Fi
Histogram (P215)
3
Name¢2 (P206)
Number of days that have passed since the
departure date¢3 (P220)
Age¢2 (P206)
Location¢3 (P220)
Current date and time/Travel destination setting¢3:
“ (P220)
Exposure meter (P217)
Focal distance display (P154)
Step zoom (P154)
AFS
AFF
AFC MF
AFS
BKT
A
F
L
LOW
STAR
4
AF area (P93, 102)
Spot metering target (P194)
Self-timer (P137)
Mic level display (P208)
Silent Mode (P210)
AE Lock (P109)
Metering Mode (P53, 194)
Programme Shift (P70)
3.5 Aperture value (P42)
Aperture Bracket (P140)
60 Shutter speed (P42)
Exposure compensation value
(P110)
Exposure Bracket (P139)
Brightness (P68, 88)
Manual Exposure Assistance
(P73)
ISO sensitivity (P112)
5
Dial operation guide (P217)
White Balance Bracket (P117)
White Balance Fine Adjustment
(P116)
VÐîÑ White Balance (P114)
Colour (P68)
98 Number of recordable pictures
(P30)
r20
Maximum number of pictures
that can be taken continuously
(P135)
Available recording time¢1 (P30)
A
E
L
AE
3.5
BKT
BKT
BKT
AWB
1
R
8
m
30
s

311
12. Others
6
¢1 m: minute, s: second
¢2 This is displayed for about 5 seconds when the camera is turned on if the [Profile Setup]
setting is set.
¢3 This is displayed for about 5 seconds when the camera is turned on, after setting the clock
and after switching from Playback Mode to Recording Mode.
Touch tab (P219)
Touch zoom (P155)
Touch Shutter (P52)
Touch AE (P53)
Peaking (P214)
Function button (P59)
//
(P90)
Colour (P68)
Defocus control function (P67, 88)
Brightness (P68, 88)
Type of defocus ([Miniature Effect]) (P85)
One point colour (P85)
Position of the light source (P86)
Image effect (filter) adjustment (P88, 190)
Image effect ON/OFF (P190)
Image effect (filter) (P190)
Aperture value (P42)
Shutter speed (P42)
ISO sensitivity (P112)
Microphone level adjustment (P208)
×
AE
Fn5 Fn6
Fn7
Fn8
Fn9
SNAP
MINIMINI
F
SS
ISO

12. Others
312
On-monitor recording information
In recording
1
Recording Mode (P43)
F3.5 Aperture value (P42)
1/60 Shutter speed (P42)
Battery indication (P22)
2
ISO sensitivity (P112)
Exposure compensation value
(P110)
Brightness (P68)
Manual Exposure Assistance
(P73)
‰Œ
Flash Mode (P159)
Flash (P161, 163)
F
3.5
98
AWB
1/60
0 0
0
Fn
ISO
AUTO
Wi-Fi
L
4:3
AFS
AFS
C1
1
EXPSEXPS
ISO
AUTO
0
0
WL
3
Single (P134)
Burst (P135)
4K Photo (P118)
Self-timer (P137)
Focus Mode (P95, 106)
š
ØAF Mode (P97)
A›Quality (P193)
Picture size/Aspect Ratio
(P192)
Wi-Fi Wi-Fi (P252)
Function button setting (P58)
4
Photo Style (P188)
VÐîÑ White Balance (P114)
Intelligent Dynamic Range
Control (P196)
Metering Mode (P194)
98 Number of recordable pictures
(P30)
r20
Maximum number of pictures
that can be taken continuously
(P135)
Available recording time (P30)
AFS
AFF
AFC
MF
L
4:3
Fn
AWB
1
AE
R
8
m
30
s

313
12. Others
In playback
1
Playback Mode (P232)
Protected picture (P249)
Number of prints (P248)
Location Information display (P233)
ÜFavourites (P247)
åCable disconnect prohibit icon
(P302)
Motion picture playback (P180)
Play panorama (P79)
Continuous Burst Picture Group
Playback (P184)
Save pictures from the 4K burst file
(P126, 129)
Save a picture from pictures
recorded using [Post Focus] (P133)
Continuous [Time Lapse Shot]
Picture Group Playback (P184)
Continuous playback of the Stop
Motion Animation Group (P184)
‘Stamped with text indication (P241)
Elapsed playback time¢1 (P180)
6060
60
F3.5F3.5
F3.5
00
AWBAWBAWB
1/981/981/98
2
0000
2
00
2
00
L
4:3
11
PRQWK GD\VPRQWK GD\VPRQWK GD\VPRQWK GD\V
67'$<67'$<67'$<67'$<
SLFSLFSLFSLF
3D
8
m
30
s
2
Icon indicating the presence of a
marker (P126)
4K Photo (4K burst file) (P118)
Post Focus (P131)
Picture size/Aspect Ratio (P192)
Recording format/Recording quality
(P168)
Snap Movie (P176)
A›Quality (P193)
Battery indication (P22)
1/98 Picture number/Total pictures
Connected to Wi-Fi
Number of group pictures
Motion picture recording time¢1
(P180)
L
4:3
50p
SLF
8
m
30
s

12. Others
314
Detailed information display
In playback
3
Clear Retouch completed icon
(P239)
Currently retrieving information icon
(P130)
Playback (Motion Pictures) (P180)
Number of days that have passed
since the departure date (P220)
Upload (Wi-Fi) (P276)
Burst Picture Group Display (P185)
Focus Bracket Group Display (P185)
[Time Lapse Shot] Picture Group
Display (P185)
Display for the Stop Motion
Animation Group (P185)
67'$<
Sub Menu (P276)
Silent Mode (P210)
Age (P206, 207)
Multi Playback (P183)
Delete (P186)
4
Name¢2 (P206, 207)
Location¢2 (P220)
Title¢2 (P240)
5
Recording information
SUB
MENU
PRQWKGD\V
F3.5 60
P
sRGB
AFS
200
0
WB
WB
ISO
ISO
AWB
STD.
STD.
STD.
L
4:3
100-0001
10:00 1.DEC.2016
1
Recording information
Intelligent Dynamic Range Control
(P196)
HDR (P197)/iHDR (P66)
Intelligent Resolution (P196)
Shading Compensation (P202)
2
Recorded date and time/World Time (P220)
3
Picture size/Aspect Ratio (P192)
Recording format/Recording quality
(P168)
A›Quality (P193)
Colour space (P203)
4K Photo (4K burst file) (P118)
Post Focus (P131)
100-0001 Folder/File number (P299)
L
4:3
50p

315
12. Others
Histogram display
¢1 m: minute, s: second
¢2 It is displayed in order of [Title], [Location], [Name] ([Baby1]/[Baby2], [Pet]), [Name] ([Face
Recog.]).
In playback
1/98
F3.5 60
ISO
200
0
100-0001
13
Histogram (P50)
2
Recording information
1/98 Picture number/Total pictures
100-0001 Folder/File number (P299)

12. Others
316
Message Display
Confirmation messages or error messages will be displayed on the screen in some cases.
The major messages are described below as examples.
[Some pictures cannot be deleted]/[This picture cannot be deleted]
•This feature can only be used with pictures that comply with the DCF standard.
Perform formatting (P29) on this unit after saving necessary data on a PC, etc.
[Cannot be set on this picture]
•[Title Edit], [Text Stamp], [Print Set], etc. cannot be set for pictures not based on the DCF
standard.
[Memory Card Error
Format this card?]
•It is a format that cannot be used with this unit.
–Insert a different card.
–Format the card again with the camera after saving necessary data on a PC etc. (P29)
Data will be deleted.
[The lens is not attached properly. Do not push lens release button while lens is
attached.]
•Detach the lens once, and then attach it again without pressing the lens release button. (P32)
Turn this unit on again, and if it is still displaying, contact the dealer.
[Lens attachment failed. Please make sure the lens is attached correctly.]
•Detach the lens from the camera body and gently wipe the contacts on the lens and the
camera body using a dry cotton swab.
Attach the lens, turn this unit on again, and if it is still displaying, contact the dealer.
[Memory Card Error]/[This memory card cannot be used]
•Use a card compatible with this unit. (P28)
[Insert SD card again]/[Try another card]
•An error has occurred accessing the card.
Insert the card again.
•Insert a different card.
[Read Error/Write Error
Please check the card]
•It has failed to read or write data.
Remove the card after turning this unit off. Insert the card again, turn this unit on, and try to
read or write the data again.
•The card may be broken.
•Insert a different card.

317
12. Others
[Motion recording was cancelled due to the limitation of the writing speed of the
card]
•Depending on the [Rec Format] and [Rec Quality] of a motion picture, the speed class rating
required for the card differs. 4K photo recording requires a card that meets a particular speed
class rating. Use a card that meets the rating. For details, refer to “About motion picture/4K
photo recording and speed class ratings” on P28.
•If the recording stops even when you are using a card that meets the speed class rating, the
data writing speed is too slow. We recommend making a backup and then format the card
(P29).
Depending on the type of the card, recording may stop in the middle.
[This battery cannot be used]
•Use a genuine Panasonic battery. If this message is displayed even when a genuine
Panasonic battery is used, contact the dealer or Panasonic.
•If the battery terminal is dirty, clean it and remove any objects.
[Failed to connect wireless access point]/[Connection failed]/[No destination
found]
•The wireless access point information set on this unit is wrong.
Check the authentication type, encryption type, and encryption key. (P284)
•Radio waves from other devices may block the connection to a wireless access point.
Check other devices that are connected to the wireless access point and devices that use the
2.4 GHz band.
[Connection failed. Please retry in a few minutes.]/[Network disconnected. Transfer
stopped.]
•Radio waves from the wireless access point are getting weak.
Perform the connection closer to the wireless access point.
•Depending on the wireless access point, connection may be automatically disconnected after
specific time has passed.
Reconnect the connection again.
[Connection failed]
•Change the access point to connect to in the smartphone Wi-Fi settings to this camera.
[Cannot connect to server]
•If a message is displaying asking to update the root certificate, agree to update the root
certificate.

12. Others
318
Troubleshooting
First, try out the following procedures (P318 to P327).
•The sound is caused by the In-Body Image Stabiliser. This is not a malfunction.
•The battery is exhausted. Charge the battery. (P19)
•[Economy] is enabled. (P223)
•This phenomenon occurs when charging in a location where the temperature is very high or
very low.
>Reconnect the USB connection cable (supplied) in a location where the ambient
temperature (and the temperature of battery) is in a 10 oC to 30 oC (50 oF to 86 oF) range,
and try charging again.
•If your PC is not capable of supplying sufficient power, charging is not possible.
•When [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]) is set, the battery drains faster.
>Select [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]) only when recording.
•Is a Wi-Fi connection being used for a long period of time?
The battery can become flat quickly when connected to Wi-Fi.
>Turn the camera off frequently by using the [Economy] etc. (P223)
•Is [Focus/Release Priority] in the [Custom] menu set to [FOCUS]? (P212)
You cannot take a picture until the subject is brought into focus.
If the problem is not resolved, it may be improved by selecting [Reset] (P226) on
the [Setup] menu.
Battery and power source
When I shake the camera, I hear a rattling sound from the camera.
The camera cannot be operated even when it is turned on.
The camera turns off immediately after it is turned on.
This unit is turned off automatically.
The charging lamp blinks.
The battery becomes flat too quickly.
Recording
Taking pictures is not possible.
The shutter will not operate immediately when the shutter button is pressed.

319
12. Others
•Picture might look whitish when lens or image sensor gets dirty with fingerprints or similar.
>If the lens is dirty turn the camera off and then gently wipe the lens surface with a soft, dry
cloth.
>Refer to P329 when the image sensor gets dirty.
•Is the AE Lock (P109) applied incorrectly?
•Check the drive mode setting. (P134)
•Are you using the bracket function? (P138)
•The subject is beyond the focus range of the camera.
•Is [Focus/Release Priority] in the [Custom] menu set to [RELEASE]? (P212)
•Is [Shutter AF] in the [Custom] menu set to [OFF]? (P210)
•Is the AF Lock (P109) applied incorrectly?
•The shutter speed will become slower and the Image Stabiliser function may not work properly
when taking pictures especially in dark places.
>We recommend using a tripod and the self-timer (P137) when taking pictures with a slow
shutter speed.
•Try the following:
>Decrease the ISO sensitivity. (P112)
>Increase the setting for [Noise Reduction] in [Photo Style] or lower the setting for each of
the items other than [Noise Reduction]. (P189)
>Set the [Long Shtr NR] to [ON]. (P202)
•If you record a moving subject when using the electronic shutter or recording motion picture or
a 4K photo, the subject may appear distorted on the picture. This is characteristic of MOS
sensors which serve as the camera’s pickup sensors. This is not a malfunction.
The recorded picture is whitish.
The recorded picture is too bright or dark.
Multiple pictures are taken at one time.
The subject is not focused properly.
The recorded picture is blurred.
The Image Stabiliser is not effective.
The recorded picture looks rough.
Noise appears on the picture.
The subject appears distorted on the picture.

12. Others
320
•This is characteristic of MOS sensors which serve as the camera’s
pickup sensors.
This is not a malfunction.
•When using the electronic shutter (P199), lowering the shutter speed
may reduce the effect of the horizontal stripes.
•If noticeable flicker or striping is seen under lighting such as a
fluorescent or LED lighting fixture when recording motion pictures, you can reduce the flicker or
striping by setting up [Flkr Decrease] (P208) and fixing the shutter speed. It is possible to select
a shutter speed from [1/50], [1/60], [1/100], or [1/120]. You can set the shutter speed manually
in the Creative Video Mode. (P89)
•Stripes may appear in high ISO sensitivity or depending on the lens you use.
>Decrease the ISO sensitivity. (P112)
•When recording under fluorescent or LED lighting fixture, etc., increasing the shutter speed
may introduce slight changes to brightness and colour. These are a result of the characteristics
of the light source and do not indicate a malfunction.
•When recording subjects in extremely bright locations or recording under fluorescent lighting,
LED lighting fixture, mercury lamp, sodium lighting, etc., the colours and screen brightness may
change or horizontal striping may appear on the screen.
•There may be defective pixels in the image sensor.
>Perform [Pixel Refresh] (P227).
•Press the rear dial to switch to Exposure Compensation operation. (P110)
•When the ambient temperature is high or recording with [ ] ([4K Burst]) or [ ]
([4K Burst(S/S)]) of the 4K Photo function is performed continuously, the camera may display
[ ] and stop the recording to protect itself. Wait until the camera cools down.
Striping or flicker may appear under lighting such as fluorescent lighting and
LED lighting fixture.
Stripes appear in high ISO sensitivity.
The brightness or the hue of the recorded picture is different from the actual
scene.
Bright spot not in subject is recorded.
You cannot compensate the exposure.
4K photo recording stops before finishing.

321
12. Others
•You may not be able to record for a short while after turning this unit on when using a large
capacity card.
•When the ambient temperature is high or motion picture is recorded continuously, the camera
may display [ ] and stop the recording to protect itself. Wait until the camera cools down.
•Depending on the [Rec Format] and [Rec Quality] of a motion picture, the speed class rating
required for the card differs. Use a card that meets the rating. (“About motion picture/4K photo
recording and speed class ratings” on P28)
•This phenomenon occurs when the camera is trying to record with highly accurate focus at a
reduced Auto Focus speed, and is not a malfunction.
•With recording in a quiet environment, depending on the lenses used, the sound of aperture
and focus actions may be recorded in motion pictures.
Focus operation can be set to [OFF] in [Continuous AF] (P170).
•While recording motion pictures, plugging the aperture of the microphone with a finger may
reduce the level of audio recording or audio may not record at all. Also be careful because the
operation sound of lenses can easily be recorded at this time.
•Use of [Silent Operation] is recommended if you are concerned about operational sounds.
(P90)
Motion pictures
Recording motion pictures is not possible.
Motion picture recording stops in the middle.
Sometimes it is difficult to focus with Auto Focus when recording 4K motion
pictures.
In motion pictures, abnormal clicking and buzzing sounds are recorded.
The recorded sound is very quiet.
An operation sound is recorded in a motion picture.

12. Others
322
•The Optical Image Stabiliser function of the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032/H-FS35100)
only works correctly with supported cameras.
>When older Panasonic digital cameras (DMC-GF1/DMC-GH1/DMC-G1) are used,
[Stabilizer] in the [Rec] menu cannot be set to [OFF].
It is recommended to update the firmware of the digital camera at the following website.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/download/
(This Site is English only.)
>When using this lens with another make of digital cameras, the Optical Image Stabiliser
function will not work.
(As of April 2016)
For details, contact the respective company.
•You can use Manual Focus with the interchangeable lens (H-FS12032) only if your model is
compatible with the lens.
Refer to the support website below for details:
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/
(This Site is English only.)
•Is the flash closed? Open the flash. (P156)
•When the electronic shutter is used, the flash is not activated. (P199)
•When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON], the flash is not activated. (P210)
Lens
When the lens is attached to another digital camera, stabiliser function cannot be
turned off or stabiliser function does not work.
When the lens is attached to another digital camera, manual focus operation
cannot be performed.
Flash
The flash is not activated.

323
12. Others
•If no operations are performed during the set time period, [Auto LVF/Monitor Off] (P223) is
activated, and the Monitor/Viewfinder turns off.
•When an object or your hand is positioned near the eye sensor, the Monitor display may switch
to the Viewfinder display. (P41)
•This occurs due to the aperture of the lens changing when the shutter button is pressed
halfway, or when the brightness of the subject changes. This is not a malfunction.
•It is only displayed on the monitor when the camera is connected to a PC or printer.
•Being a characteristic of the viewfinder of this unit, this phenomenon is not a problem.
Recorded images are not affected.
•Is the card inserted?
•Is this a folder or picture which was processed in the PC?
If it is, it cannot be played back by this unit.
>It is recommended to use the software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (P296) to write pictures from
PC to card.
•Has [Playback Mode] been set for playback?
>Change to [Normal Play]. (P232)
•When Red-Eye Removal ([ ] or [ ]) is performed, red parts may be corrected to black.
>It is recommended to take a pictures with the flash closed, Flash Mode set to [‰], or
[Red-Eye Removal] set to [OFF]. (P200)
Monitor/Viewfinder
The Monitor/Viewfinder turns off although the camera is turned on.
It may flicker for an instant or the brightness of the screen may change
significantly for an instant.
Monitor and viewfinder do not switch when [LVF] is pressed.
The colour tone of the viewfinder differs from the actual tone.
Playback
The picture is not played back.
There are no recorded pictures.
Red part of the recorded image has changed colour to black.

12. Others
324
∫General tips for using a Wi-Fi connection
•Use within the communication range of the device to be connected.
•Is any device, such as microwave oven, cordless phone, etc., that uses 2.4 GHz frequency
operated nearby?
>Radio waves may get interrupted when used simultaneously. Use them sufficiently away
from the device.
•When the battery indicator is flashing red, the connection with other equipment may not start or
the connection may be disrupted.
(A message such as [Communication error] is displayed.)
•If you place the camera on a metal table or shelf, the radio waves may be adversely affected. In
such cases, you may not be able to establish a connection. Move the camera away from the
metal surface.
∫About a wireless access point
•Check if the wireless access point to connect is in operating state.
•Check the radio wave condition of the wireless access point.
>Move this unit closer to the wireless access point.
>Change the location and orientation of the wireless access point.
•It may not display even if the radio waves exist depending on the setting of the wireless access
point.
>Check the settings of the wireless access point.
>When the network SSID of the wireless access point is set not to broadcast, the wireless
access point may not be detected. Enter the network SSID to start the connection (P284) or
enable the SSID broadcast of the wireless access point.
•From the Wi-Fi setting menu on the smartphone, turn off and then on the Wi-Fi function.
•Some OS versions, including Windows 8, use two types of accounts: a local account and a
Microsoft account.
Be sure to use the user name and password for the local account.
Wi-Fi function
A Wi-Fi connection cannot be established.
Radio waves get disconnected.
Wireless access point is not displayed.
This unit is not displayed in the Wi-Fi setting screen of the smartphone.
When I try to set up a Wi-Fi connection with a Windows 8 PC, my user name and
password are not recognised, so I cannot connect to the PC.

325
12. Others
•The default workgroup name is set to “WORKGROUP”. If you changed the workgroup name,
the PC will not be recognised.
In [Change Workgroup Name] in [PC Connection] of the [Wi-Fi Setup] menu, change the
workgroup name to that of the PC you are connecting to. (P288)
•Please confirm login name and password are correctly typed.
•When the system time of Mac computer or Windows PC connected to a camera differs severely
from that of the camera, the camera cannot be connected to the computer or PC in some OSs.
>Please confirm [Clock Set] and [World Time] of the camera matches with time, date and
time zone in Windows PC or Mac computer. When both settings do not match severely,
please match them.
•Confirm that the login information (login ID/user name/email address/password) is correct.
•Is the size of the image too large?
>Reduce the image size at [Size] (P268), and then send.
>Transmit after dividing the motion picture with [Video Divide] (P242).
•It may take longer time to transmit when distance to the wireless access point is far.
>Transmit closer to the wireless access point.
•File format of the motion picture that can be sent differs depending on the destination. (P265)
•Execute the [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] in the [Setup] menu. (P226)
However, all the information you have set on the [Wi-Fi Setup] menu will be reset. (excluding
[LUMIX CLUB])
The PC is not recognised when I use a Wi-Fi connection. The camera cannot be
connected to PC via Wi-Fi connection.
Images cannot be transmitted to the web service.
It takes time to transmit an image to the web service.
Transmission of the image fails midway. Some images cannot be transmitted.
I have forgotten the password for the Wi-Fi.

12. Others
326
•Is the camera connected to the TV correctly? (P292)
>Set the TV input to external input mode.
•Is the [VIERA Link] on this unit set to [ON]? (P225)
>Check the VIERA Link setting on the connected device.
>Turn this unit off and on.
•Set to [PC] in [USB Mode]. (P223, 298)
•Turn this unit off and on.
•Check if your PC is compatible with SDXC memory cards.
http://panasonic.net/avc/sdcard/information/SDXC.html
•A message prompting to format the card may be displayed when connecting, but do not format.
•If the [Access] displayed on the monitor does not disappear, disconnect the USB connection
cable after turning this unit off.
•Pictures cannot be printed using a printer that does not support PictBridge.
>Set to [PictBridge(PTP)] in [USB Mode]. (P223, 301)
•When using a printer with a Cropping or borderless printing function, cancel this function before
printing.
(For details, refer to the operating instructions for the printer.)
•When you order photo studios to print pictures, ask the photo studio if the 16:9 pictures can be
printed.
TV, PC and printer
The picture does not appear on the television.
VIERA Link does not work.
Cannot communicate with the PC.
The card is not recognised by the PC.
(SDXC memory card is used.)
The picture cannot be printed when the camera is connected to a printer.
The ends of the pictures are cut at printing.

327
12. Others
•Depending on the lens you attach, it may move inside and create a sound. This is not a
malfunction.
•This is the noise of the Dust Reduction Function working (P329); it is not a malfunction.
•It is a sound of lens movement or aperture operation when this unit is turned on or off, and it is
not a malfunction.
•The sound, which is caused by the automatic adjustment of the aperture, is heard when the
brightness has changed due to, for example, zooming or the movement of the camera. This is
not a malfunction.
•Press [MENU/SET], select the [Setup] menu icon [ ] and then select the [~] icon to set the
desired language. (P225)
•In dark places, the AF Assist Lamp (P211) lights red to make it easier to focus on a subject.
•The surface of the camera and the reverse side of the monitor may become warm during use.
This does not affect the performance or quality of the camera.
•If you do not use the camera for a long time, the clock may be reset.
>[Please set the clock] message will be displayed; please reset the clock. (P35)
Others
When I shake the camera, I hear a rattling sound from the attached lens.
The camera makes a noise when this unit is turned on.
There is a sound from lens unit.
An unreadable language was selected by mistake.
A red lamp sometimes turns on when the shutter button is pressed halfway.
The camera becomes warm.
The clock is reset.

12. Others
328
Cautions for Use
Keep this unit as far away as possible from electromagnetic equipment (such as
microwave ovens, TVs, video games etc.).
•If you use this unit on top of or near a TV, the pictures and/or sound on this unit may be
disrupted by electromagnetic wave radiation.
•Do not use this unit near cell phones because doing so may result in noise adversely affecting
the pictures and/or sound.
•Recorded data may be damaged, or pictures may be distorted, by strong magnetic fields
created by speakers or large motors.
•Electromagnetic wave radiation may adversely affect this unit, disturbing the pictures and/or
sound.
•If this unit is adversely affected by electromagnetic equipment and stops functioning properly,
turn this unit off and remove the battery or disconnect AC adaptor (supplied)/AC adaptor
(optional). Then reinsert the battery or reconnect AC adaptor and turn this unit on.
Do not use this unit near radio transmitters or high-voltage lines.
•If you record near radio transmitters or high-voltage lines, the recorded pictures and/or sound
may be adversely affected.
Always use the supplied cords and cables.
If you use optional accessories, use the cords and the cables supplied with them.
Do not extend the cords or the cables.
Do not spray the camera with insecticides or volatile chemicals.
•If the camera is sprayed with such chemicals, the body of the camera may be damaged and the
surface finish may peel off.
Do not keep rubber or plastic products in contact with the camera for a long period
of time.
Keep objects sensitive to magnetic fields (credit cards, etc.) away from the camera.
Otherwise, magnetic fields may damage their data and make them unusable.
Optimal use of the camera

329
12. Others
Before cleaning the camera, remove the battery or the DC coupler (optional), or
disconnect the power plug from the outlet. Then wipe the camera with a dry, soft
cloth.
•When the camera is soiled badly, it can be cleaned by wiping the dirt off with a wrung wet cloth,
and then with a dry cloth.
•Do not use solvents such as benzine, thinner, alcohol, kitchen detergents, etc., to clean the
camera, since it may deteriorate the external case or the coating may peel off.
•When using a chemical cloth, be sure to follow the accompanying instructions.
∫About dirt on the image sensor
This camera features an interchangeable lens system so dirt may get inside the camera
body when changing lenses. Depending on the recording conditions, dirt on the image
sensor may appear on the recorded picture.
To prevent debris or dust adhering to internal parts of the body, avoid changing the lens in
a dusty environment and always fit the body cap or a lens when storing the camera.
Remove any dirt on the body cap before attaching it.
Removing dirt on the image sensor
The image sensor is very precise and delicate, so be sure to observe the following when
you do have to clean it yourself.
•Blow off the dust on the surface of the image sensor with a commercially available blower
brush. Be careful not to blow too strongly.
•Do not put the blower brush further inside than the lens mount.
•Do not let the blower brush touch the image sensor as the image sensor may get scratched.
•Do not use any objects except a blower brush to clean the image sensor.
•If you cannot remove the dirt or dust with the blower, consult the dealer or Panasonic.
Cleaning
Dust reduction function
This unit has a dust reduction function that will blow off the debris and dust that have
affixed to the front of the imaging device.
This function will function automatically when the camera is turned on, but if you see
dust, perform the [Sensor Cleaning] (P227) in the [Setup] menu.

12. Others
330
∫For care of the viewfinder/Eyecup
•As the eye cup cannot be removed, blow away the dust on the viewfinder surface with a blower
(commercially available), gently wipe it with a dry and soft cloth, and be careful not to remove it.
•If you wipe the eye cup too hard and it is removed, consult the dealer or Panasonic.
•Do not press the monitor with excessive force. Uneven colours may appear on the monitor and
it may malfunction.
•If the camera is cold when you turn it on, the picture on the Monitor/Viewfinder will be slightly
darker than usual at first. However, the picture will return to normal brightness when the internal
temperature of the camera increases.
•Do not press the lens with excessive force.
•Do not leave the camera with the lens facing the sun as rays of light from the sun may cause it
to malfunction. Also, be careful when placing the camera outside or near a window.
•When there is dirt (water, oil, and fingerprints, etc.) on the surface of the lens, the picture may
be affected. Lightly wipe the surface of the lens with a soft, dry cloth before and after taking
pictures.
•Do not place the lens mount facing downwards. Do not allow the lens
mount contacts A to become dirty.
About the Monitor/Viewfinder
Extremely high precision technology is employed to produce the Monitor/
Viewfinder screen. However there may be some dark or bright spots (red, blue or
green) on the screen. This is not a malfunction. Though the Monitor/Viewfinder
screen parts are produced with highly controlled precision technology, some
pixels may be inactive or always lit. The spots will not be recorded on pictures
on a card.
About the Lens

331
12. Others
The battery is a rechargeable lithium ion battery. Its ability to generate power comes
from the chemical reaction that takes place inside it. This reaction is susceptible to
the surrounding temperature and humidity. If the temperature is too high or too low,
the operating time of the battery will become shorter.
Always remove the battery after use.
•Place the removed battery in a plastic bag, and store or keep away from metallic objects (clips,
etc.).
If you drop the battery accidentally, check to see if the body of the battery and the
terminals are damaged.
•Inserting a damaged battery in the camera will damage the camera.
Bring charged spare batteries when going out.
•Be aware that the operating time of the battery becomes shorter in low temperature conditions
such as at a ski resort.
•When you travel, do not forget to bring the AC adaptor (supplied) and USB connection cable
(supplied) so that you can charge the battery in the country that you are travelling in.
Dispose of unusable battery.
•The battery has a limited life.
•Do not throw the battery into fire because it may cause an explosion.
Do not allow battery terminals to come into contact with metal objects (such as
necklaces, hairpins, etc.).
•This can cause short-circuiting or heat generation and you may be badly burned if you touch a
battery.
•If you use the AC adaptor (supplied) near a radio, the radio reception may be disturbed.
Keep the AC adaptor (supplied) 1 m (3.3 feet) or further away from radios.
•The AC adaptor (supplied) may generate whirring sounds when it is being used. This is not a
malfunction.
•After use, be sure to disconnect the power supply device from the electrical outlet.
(A very small amount of current is consumed if it is left connected.)
Battery
AC adaptor (supplied)

12. Others
332
∫About 3D recording
With the 3D interchangeable lens attached, do not record a subject at less than the
minimum focus distance.
•The 3D effects may be more pronounced, and therefore cause tiredness or discomfort.
•When the 3D interchangeable lens (H-FT012: optional) is used, the minimum focus distance is
0.6 m (2.0 feet).
When recording with the 3D interchangeable lens attached, be careful not to shake
the unit.
•Tiredness or discomfort may result if the shake is pronounced, due to riding in a vehicle or
walking etc.
•We recommend using a tripod.
Do not leave the card where the temperature is high, where electromagnetic waves
or static electricity are easily generated or exposed to direct sunlight.
Do not bend or drop the card.
•The card may be damaged or the recorded content may be damaged or deleted.
•Put the card in the card case or the storage bag after use and when storing or carrying the
card.
•Do not allow dirt, dust, or water to get into the terminals on the back of the card and do not
touch the terminals with your fingers.
Notice for when transferring to another party, or disposing of the memory card
“Format” or “delete” using the camera or a PC will only modify the file management
information, it will not erase the data in the memory card completely.
It is recommended to physically destroy the memory card or use the commercially
available computer data deletion software to completely erase the data in the
memory card before transferring to another party or disposing.
Management of data in the memory card is the responsibility of the user.
About 3D
Card

333
12. Others
If a name or birthday is set for [Profile Setup]/Face Recognition function, this personal
information is kept in the camera and recorded in the image.
We recommend that you enable [Wi-Fi Password] and [Wi-Fi Function Lock] to protect
personal information. (P288 , 289)
Disclaimer
•Information including personal information may be altered or vanish due to erroneous
operation, effect of static electricity, accident, malfunction, repair, or other handlings.
Please note in advance that Panasonic is not liable in any way for any direct or indirect damage
from the alteration or vanishing of information or personal information.
When requesting a repair, transferring to another party, or disposing.
•After making a copy of personal information, always delete information such as personal
information and wireless LAN connection settings that you have saved within the camera with
[Reset Wi-Fi Settings]/[Delete account] (P226, 281).
•Reset the settings to protect the personal information. (P226)
•Remove the memory card from the camera when requesting a repair.
•Settings may return to factory default when camera is repaired.
•Please contact the dealer where you purchased the camera or Panasonic if above operations
are not possible due to malfunction.
When transferring to another party, or disposing of the memory card, please refer to
“Notice for when transferring to another party, or disposing of the memory card”.
(P332)
When uploading images on web services
•Images may contain information that can be used for identifying individuals such as titles,
recording dates, and location information. When uploading images on web services, check
carefully, and then upload.
•Store the battery in a cool and dry place with a relatively stable temperature: [Recommended
temperature: 15 oC to 25 oC (59 oF to 77 oF), Recommended humidity: 40%RH to 60%RH]
•Always remove the battery and the card from the camera.
•If the battery is left inserted in the camera, it will discharge even if the camera is turned off. If
the battery continues to be left in the camera, it will discharge excessively and may become
unusable even if charged.
•When storing the battery for a long period of time, we recommend charging it once a year.
Remove the battery from the camera and store it again after it has completely discharged.
•We recommend storing the camera with a desiccant (silica gel) when you keep it in a closet or
a cabinet.
•Check all the parts before taking pictures when you have not used the camera for a long period
of time.
About the personal information
When not using the camera for a long period of time

12. Others
334
•Recorded data may be damaged or lost if the camera breaks down due to inappropriate
handling. Panasonic will not be liable for any damage caused due to loss of recorded data.
•When you use a tripod, make sure the tripod is stable when this unit is attached to it.
•You may not be able to remove the card or the battery when using a tripod or unipod.
•Make sure that the screw on the tripod or unipod is not at an angle when attaching or detaching
the camera. You may damage the screw on the camera if you use excessive force when
turning it. Also, the camera body and the rating label may be damaged or scratched if the
camera is attached too tightly to the tripod or unipod.
•When using this unit with a large-diameter lens, the lens may come into contact with the
pedestal depending on the tripod/unipod. Tightening the screw with the lens and pedestal in
contact with each other may damage this unit or the lens. Therefore it is recommended to
attach the tripod adaptor (DMW-TA1: optional) before mounting on the tripod/unipod.
•Read the operating instructions for the tripod or unipod carefully.
•If you attach a heavy interchangeable lens (more than about 1 kg/35.3 oz) to the camera body,
do not carry the camera by the shoulder strap.
Hold the camera and the lens when carrying them.
∫Use the camera as a wireless LAN device
When using equipment or computer systems that require more reliable security than
wireless LAN devices, ensure that the appropriate measures are taken for safety designs
and defects for the systems used. Panasonic will not take any responsibility for any
damage that arises when using the camera for any purpose other than as a wireless LAN
device.
∫Use of the Wi-Fi function of this camera is presumed to be in countries where this
camera is sold
There is the risk that the camera violates the radiowave regulations if used in countries
other than those where this camera is sold, and Panasonic takes no responsibility for any
violations.
∫There is the risk that data sent and received via radio waves may be intercepted
Please note that there is the risk that data sent and received via radio waves may be
intercepted by a third party.
About the picture data
About tripods or unipods
About the shoulder strap
Wi-Fi function

335
12. Others
∫Do not use the camera in areas with magnetic fields, static electricity or
interference
•Do not use the camera in areas with magnetic fields, static electricity or interference, such as
near microwave ovens. These may cause the interruption of the radio waves.
•Using the camera near devices such as microwave ovens or cordless telephones that use the
2.4 GHz radio wave band may cause a decrease in performance in both devices.
∫Do not connect to the wireless network you are not authorised to use
When the camera utilises its Wi-Fi function, wireless networks will be searched
automatically. When this happens, wireless networks that you are not authorised to use
(SSID¢) may be displayed, however do not attempt to connect to the network as it may be
considered as unauthorised access.
¢SSID refers to the name that is used to identify a network over a wireless LAN connection. If
the SSID matches for both devices, transmission is possible.

336
12. Others
•G MICRO SYSTEM is a lens exchange type digital camera
system of LUMIX based on a Micro Four Thirds System
standard.
•Micro Four Thirds™ and Micro Four Thirds Logo marks are
trademarks or registered trademarks of Olympus Imaging
Corporation, in Japan, the United States, the European Union
and other countries.
•Four Thirds™ and Four Thirds Logo marks are trademarks or
registered trademarks of Olympus Imaging Corporation, in
Japan, the United States, the European Union and other
countries.
•SDXC Logo is a trademark of SD-3C, LLC.
•“AVCHD”, “AVCHD Progressive” and the “AVCHD Progressive”
logo are trademarks of Panasonic Corporation and Sony
Corporation.
•Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
Dolby and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby
Laboratories.
•The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition Multimedia
Interface, and the HDMI Logo are trademarks or registered
trademarks of HDMI Licensing, LLC in the United States and
other countries.
•HDAVI Control™ is a trademark of Panasonic Corporation.
•Adobe is a trademark or registered trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United
States and/or other countries.
•Pentium is a trademark of Intel Corporation in the U.S. and/or other countries.
•iMovie, Mac and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
•iPad, iPhone, iPod, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and
other countries.
•App Store is a service mark of Apple Inc.
•Windows is a registered trademark or trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United
States and/or other countries.

337
12. Others
•Android and Google Play are trademarks or registered
trademarks of Google Inc.
•The Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™ Logo is a certification mark of
Wi-Fi AllianceR.
•The Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ Identifier mark is a
certification mark of Wi-Fi AllianceR.
•“Wi-FiR” and “Wi-Fi DirectR” are registered trademarks of
Wi-Fi AllianceR.
•“Wi-Fi Protected Setup™”, “WPA™”, and “WPA2™” are
trademarks of Wi-Fi AllianceR.
•DLNA, the DLNA Logo and DLNA CERTIFIED are
trademarks, service marks, or certification marks of the
Digital Living Network Alliance.
•
This product uses “DynaFont” from DynaComware Corporation. DynaFont is a registered
trademark of DynaComware Taiwan Inc.
•QR Code is a registered trademark of DENSO WAVE INCORPORATED.
•Other names of systems and products mentioned in these instructions are usually the
registered trademarks or trademarks of the manufacturers who developed the system or
product concerned.
This product is licensed under the AVC Patent Portfolio License for the personal use of a
consumer or other uses in which it does not receive remuneration to (i) encode video in
compliance with the AVC Standard (
“
AVC Video
”
) and/or (ii) decode AVC Video that was
encoded by a consumer engaged in a personal activity and/or was obtained from a video
provider licensed to provide AVC Video. No license is granted or shall be implied for any other
use. Additional information may be obtained from MPEG LA, L.L.C.
See http://www.mpegla.com

Disposal of Old Equipment and Batteries
Only for European Union and countries with recycling systems
These symbols on the products, packaging, and/or accompanying
documents mean that used electrical and electronic products and
batteries must not be mixed with general household waste.
For proper treatment, recovery and recycling of old products and used
batteries, please take them to applicable collection points in accordance
with your national legislation.
By disposing of them correctly, you will help to save valuable resources
and prevent any potential negative effects on human health and the
environment.
For more information about collection and recycling, please contact your
local municipality.
Penalties may be applicable for incorrect disposal of this waste, in
accordance with national legislation.
Note for the battery symbol (bottom symbol):
This symbol might be used in combination with a chemical symbol. In
this case it complies with the requirement set by the Directive for the
chemical involved.